2013 Ridgeline Introduction - Hondatechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/JC1313/JC1313OM.pdf2013...
Transcript of 2013 Ridgeline Introduction - Hondatechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/JC1313/JC1313OM.pdf2013...
Several warranties protect your new vehicle. Read the warranty bookletthoroughly so you understand the coverages and are aware of your rightsand responsibilities.
As you read this manual, you willfind information that is preceded bya symbol. Thisinformation is intended to help youavoid damage to your vehicle, otherproperty, or the environment.
One of the best ways to enhance the enjoyment of your new vehicle is toread this manual. In it, you will learn how to operate its driving controls andconvenience items. Afterwards, keep this owner’s manual in your vehicle soyou can refer to it at any time.
Maintaining your vehicle according to the Maintenance Minder shown inthe instrument panel helps to keep your driving trouble-free while itpreserves your investment. When your vehicle needs maintenance, keep inmind that your dealer’s staff is specially trained in servicing the manysystems unique to your vehicle. Your dealer is dedicated to your satisfactionand will be pleased to answer any questions and concerns.
Congratulations! Your selection of a 2013 Honda Ridgeline was a wiseinvestment. It will give you years of driving pleasure.
Introduction
i
TM
12/08/09 15:58:28 31SJC670_002
Index
Book Table of Contents
Chapter Table of Contents
Navigation Key
Your Vehicle at a Glance
2013 Ridgeline
2013 Ridgeline
Event Data RecordersThis vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder (EDR).The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain crash or near crash-like situations, such as an air bag deploymentor hitting a road obstacle, data that will assist in understanding how a vehicle’s systems performed. The EDR isdesigned to record data related to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of time, typically 30 secondsor less. The EDR in this vehicle is designed to record such data as:
How various systems in your vehicle were operating;Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts were buckled/fastened;How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator and/or brake pedal; and,How fast the vehicle was traveling.
These data can help provide a better understanding of the circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur.NOTE: EDR data are recorded by your vehicle only if a non-trivial crash situation occurs; no data are recorded by theEDR under normal driving conditions and no personal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and crash location) are recorded.However, other parties, such as law enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of personally identifyingdata routinely acquired during a crash investigation.
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is required, and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed. Inaddition to the vehicle manufacturer, other parties, such as law enforcement, that have the special equipment, canread the information if they have access to the vehicle or the EDR.
The data belongs to the vehicle owner and may not be accessed by anyone else except as legally required or with thepermission of the vehicle owner.
Introduction
ii
12/08/09 15:58:35 31SJC670_003
2013 Ridgeline
-
California Proposition 65 Warning
This product contains or emits chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birthdefects or other reproductive harm.
Service Diagnostic RecordersThis vehicle is equipped with service-related devices that record information about powertrain performance. The datacan be used to verify emissions law requirements and/or help technicians diagnose and solve service problems. It mayalso be combined with data from other sources for research purposes, but it remains confidential.
California Perchlorate Contamination Prevention ActThe airbags, seat belt tensioners, and CR type batteries in this vehicle may contain perchlorate materials specialhandling may apply. See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate/
WARNING:
Introduction
iii
12/08/09 15:58:39 31SJC670_004
2013 Ridgeline
-
--
--
-
Your safety, and the safety of others,is very important. And operating thisvehicle safely is an importantresponsibility.
To help you make informeddecisions about safety, we haveprovided operating procedures andother information on labels and inthis manual. This information alertsyou to potential hazards that couldhurt you or others.
Of course, it is not practical orpossible to warn you about all thehazards associated with operating ormaintaining your vehicle. You mustuse your own good judgement.
You will find this important safety information in a variety of forms,including:
This entire book is filled with important safety information please read itcarefully.
how to use this vehicle correctly and safely.such as Driver and Passenger Safety.
These signal words mean:
on the vehicle.preceded by a safety alert symbol and one of
three signal words: , , or .
such as Important Safety Reminders or ImportantSafety Precautions.
InstructionsSafety Section
Safety LabelsSafety Messages
Safety Headings
A Few Words About Safety
DANGER WARNING CAUTION
iv
You CAN be HURT if you don’t followinstructions.
You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLYHURT if you don’t follow instructions.
You WILL be KILLED or SERIOUSLYHURT if you don’t follow instructions.
12/08/09 15:58:49 31SJC670_005
2013 Ridgeline
In addition to these characteristics, your vehicle’s pickup bed area allows you to carry more cargo and has the dual-action tailgate to handle the items easily.
These advantages come at some cost. Because your vehicle is taller and rides higher off the ground, it has a highcenter of gravity. This means your vehicle can tip or roll over if you make abrupt turns. Utility vehicles have asignificantly higher rollover rate than other types of vehicles. In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is significantlymore likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt. As a reminder, make sure you and your passengers always wearseat belts.
Overloading or improperly loading cargo could affect your handling and the vehicle’s stability, and could result in acrash. Make sure the cargo is properly loaded and all items are secured in the pickup bed area.
For information on how to reduce the risk of rollover, read ‘‘Driving Guidelines’’ on page of this manual and thesection on page . Failure to operate your vehicle correctly might result in loss of
control, a crash, or rollover.
Your vehicle has higher ground clearance than a passenger vehicle designed for use only on pavement. Higher groundclearance has many advantages for off-highway driving. It allows you to travel over bumps, obstacles, and roughterrain. It also provides good visibility so you can anticipate problems earlier. Your vehicle also has a relatively shortwheelbase, allowing it to respond quicker to the steering wheel than other vehicles with a longer wheelbase.
266304Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
Important Handling Information
v
12/08/09 15:58:55 31SJC670_006
2013 Ridgeline
(seat belts, SRS, and child protection)
(main controls)
(indicators, gauges, multi-information display, dashboard, and steering column)
( )
(fuel, vehicle break-in, and cargo loading)
(engine and transmission operation)
(minder, fluid checking, minor services, and vehicle storage)
(flat tire, jump starting, overheating, and fuses)
(vehicle specifications, tires, and emissions controls)
(warranty and contact information)
(how to order)
climate control, audio, steering wheel, security, cruise control, HomeLink , and other convenience items
Contents
................................................................................................................................................Index . I
Service Information Summary
............................................................Driver and Passenger Safety . 5
...............................................................................................Your Vehicle at a Glance . 3
.......Instruments and Controls . 59
..............Features . 145
.......................................................................Before Driving . 243
.........................................................................................Driving . 265
.................................................Maintenance . 309
........................................Taking Care of the Unexpected . 357
..............................................Technical Information . 383
..................Warranty and Customer Relations (U.S. and Canada only) . 401
..................................................................................Authorized Manuals (U.S. only) . 405
1
12/08/09 15:59:07 31SJC670_008
Owner's Identification Form
Index
Book Table of Contents
Chapter Table of Contents
Navigation Key
Your Vehicle at a Glance
00X31-SJC-6700 © 2012 American Honda Motor Co., Inc. - All Rights Reserved
2013 Ridgeline
How to operate the heating and airconditioning system, the audiosystem, and other conveniencefeatures.
A convenient reference to thesections in this manual.
A quick reference to the maincontrols in your vehicle.
Explains the purpose of eachinstrument panel indicator and gauge,and how to use the controls on thedashboard and steering column.
The proper way to start the engine,shift the transmission, and park; pluswhat you need to know if you’replanning to tow a trailer.
ID numbers, dimensions, capacities,and technical information.
How to order manuals and othertechnical literature.
A summary of the information youneed when you pull up to the fuelpump.
The Maintenance Minder showsyou when you need to take yourvehicle to the dealer for maintenanceservice. There is also a list of thingsto check and instructions on how tocheck them.
A summary of the warrantiescovering your new vehicle, and howto contact us for any reason. Refer toyour warranty manual for detailedinformation.
This section covers several problemsmotorists sometimes experience,and details how to handle them.
Important information about theproper use and care of your vehicle’sseat belts, an overview of thesupplemental restraint system, andvaluable information on how toprotect children with child restraints.
What gasoline to use, how to break-in your new vehicle, and how to loadluggage and other cargo.
Contents
Your Vehicle at a Glance
Driver and Passenger Safety
Instruments and Controls
Features
Before Driving
Driving
Maintenance
Technical Information
Warranty and CustomerRelations(U.S. and Canada only)
Authorized Manuals(U.S. only)
Index
Service Information SummaryTaking Care of the Unexpected
Overview of Contents
2
TM
12/08/09 15:59:23 31SJC670_009
2013 Ridgeline
*
*
*
CONTINUED: If equipped
Your Vehicle at a Glance
3
POWER WINDOWSWITCHES
HOOD RELEASEHANDLE
MIRROR CONTROLS
ACCESSORY POWER SOCKETS
FUEL FILL DOORRELEASE HANDLE
POWER DOOR LOCKMASTER SWITCH
(P.134)
(P.103)
(P.128)
INSTRUMENT PANEL INDICATORS
GAUGES(P.62)
(P.76)
PARKING BRAKERELEASE HANDLE(P.132)
(P.139)
Vehicle with navigation system is shown.
PARKING BRAKE PEDAL(P.132) (P.136)
CENTER CONSOLE
AUXILIARY INPUT JACK
AUDIO SYSTEM(P.159)
PASSENGER’S FRONTAIRBAG
HEATING/COOLINGCONTROLSCLIMATE CONTROLSYSTEM
GLOVE BOX(P.138)
(P.9, P.25)
(P.146)
(P.152)
(P.205)
(P.250)
(P.246)
DRIVER’S FRONTAIRBAG(P.9, P.25)
REARVIEW MIRROR WITHREARVIEW CAMERA DISPLAY (P.240)
12/09/07 16:42:47 31SJC670_010
2013 Ridgeline
*
*
*
**
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
▲
▼
*****
Only on vehicles equipped with navigation system. Refer to the navigation system manual.
To use the horn, press the center pad of the steering wheel.If equipped
On models with navigation system.On models without navigation system.
1 :2 :3 :4 :5 :
Your Vehicle at a Glance
4
Vehicle with navigation system is shown.
(P.31)REMOTE AUDIO CONTROLS
HEADLIGHT CONTROL DIAL
STEERING WHEELADJUSTMENT
SEAT HEATERS
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFFINDICATOR
SEL/RESET BUTTON
INFO ( ) BUTTONSELECT BUTTON
INTERIOR LIGHT CONTROLSWITCH
CRUISE CONTROLS
HAZARD WARNING BUTTON
MULTI-CONTROL LEVER(WINDSHIELD WIPERS/WASHERS/TURN SIGNALS/HEADLIGHT HIGH BEAMS)(P.94)
(P.95)
MOONROOF SWITCH(P.131)
FOG LIGHTS
BED LIGHT SWITCH
(P.99)
(P.126)
(P.99)
(P.76)
(P.76)
(P.76)
(P.76)TRIP/RESET BUTTON(P.76)
(P.97)
INFO ( ) BUTTON
(P.203)
(P.210)
INSTRUMENT PANELBRIGHTNESS (P.98)
VTM-4 LOCK
SHIFT LEVER
VOICE CONTROL BUTTONS
HORN(P.144)
(P.142)
BLUETOOTHHANDSFREELINKSYSTEM VOICECONTROL BUTTONS
(P.269)
(P.274)
VEHICLE STABILITY ASSIST (VSA)OFF SWITCH (P.290)
(P.217)
2
2
4
4
5
2
2
5
4
3
1
4
12/08/09 15:59:40 31SJC670_011
(P.217)
2013 Ridgeline
-
This section gives you importantinformation about how to protectyourself and your passengers. Itshows you how to use seat belts. Itexplains how your airbags work. Andit tells you how to properly restraininfants and children in your vehicle.
.........Important Safety Precautions . 6.......Your Vehicle’s Safety Features . 7
.......................................Seat Belts . 8...........................................Airbags . 9
.........Protecting Adults and Teens . 11.....1. Close and Lock the Doors . 11
...........2. Adjust the Front Seats . 13............3. Adjust the Seat-Backs . 14
...4. Adjust the Head Restraints . 155. Fasten and Position the
.............................Seat Belts . 166. Maintain a Proper Sitting
................................Position . 17.....Advice for Pregnant Women . 18...Additional Safety Precautions . 19
Additional Information About Your.................................Seat Belts . 20
..Seat Belt System Components . 20......................Lap/Shoulder Belt . 21
Automatic Seat Belt...............................Tensioners . 22
...............Seat Belt Maintenance . 22Additional Information About
...........................Your Airbags . 23......Airbag System Components . 23
How Your Front Airbags.........................................Work . 25
...How Your Side Airbags Work . 28How your Side Curtain Airbags
.........................................Work . 30..How the SRS Indicator Works . 30
How the Side Airbag Off......................Indicator Works . 31
How the Passenger Airbag Off......................Indicator Works . 31
.............................Airbag Service . 32...Additional Safety Precautions . 33
Protecting Children General................................Guidelines . 34
All Children Must Be...............................Restrained . 34
All Children Should Sit in a.................................Back Seat . 35
The Passenger’s Front Airbag.........Can Pose Serious Risks . 35
If You Must Drive with Several...................................Children . 37
If a Child Requires Close..................................Attention . 37
...Additional Safety Precautions . 38Protecting Infants and Small
...................................Children . 39.......................Protecting Infants . 39
.........Protecting Small Children . 40.....................Selecting a Child Seat . 41....................Installing a Child Seat . 42
...............................With LATCH . 43.........With a Lap/Shoulder Belt . 46
..............................With a Tether . 48...........Protecting Larger Children . 51
...............Checking Seat Belt Fit . 51..................Using a Booster Seat . 52
When Can a Larger Child Sit in.........................................Front . 53
...Additional Safety Precautions . 54.............Carbon Monoxide Hazard . 55
...................................Safety Labels . 56
Driver and Passenger Safety
5
12/08/09 15:59:44 31SJC670_012
2013 Ridgeline
-
You’ll find many safetyrecommendations throughout thissection, and throughout this manual.The recommendations on this pageare the ones we consider to be themost important.
A seat belt is your best protection inall types of collisions. Airbags aredesigned to supplement seat belts,not replace them. So even thoughyour vehicle is equipped with airbags,make sure you and your passengersalways wear your seat belts, andwear them properly (see page ).
Children age 12 and under shouldride properly restrained in a backseat, not the front seat. Infants andsmall children should be restrainedin a child seat. Larger childrenshould use a booster seat and a lap/shoulder belt until they can use thebelt properly without a booster seat(see pages ).
While airbags can save lives, theycan cause serious or fatal injuries tooccupants who sit too close to them,or are not properly restrained.Infants, young children, and shortadults are at the greatest risk. Besure to follow all instructions andwarnings in this manual.
Alcohol and driving don’t mix. Evenone drink can reduce your ability torespond to changing conditions, andyour reaction time gets worse withevery additional drink. So don’t drinkand drive, and don’t let your friendsdrink and drive, either.
Engaging in mobile phoneconversation or other activities thatkeep you from paying close attention
to the road, other vehicles andpedestrians could lead to a crash.Remember, situations can changequickly, and only you can decidewhen it is safe to divert attentionaway from driving.
Having a tire blowout or amechanical failure can be extremelyhazardous. To reduce the possibilityof such problems, check your tirepressures and condition frequently,and perform all regularly scheduledmaintenance (see page ).
Excessive speed is a major factor incrash injuries and deaths. Generally,the higher the speed, the greater therisk, but serious injuries can alsooccur at lower speeds. Never drivefaster than is safe for currentconditions, regardless of themaximum speed posted.16
34 54 311
Always Wear Your Seat Belt
Restrain All Children
Be Aware of Airbag Hazards
Don’t Drink and Drive
Pay Appropriate Attention to theTask of Driving Safely
Keep Your Vehicle in SafeCondition
Control Your Speed
Important Safety Precautions
6
12/08/09 15:59:54 31SJC670_013
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
2013 Ridgeline
Your vehicle is equipped with manyfeatures that work together toprotect you and your passengersduring a crash.
Some features do not require anyaction on your part. These include astrong steel framework that forms asafety cage around the passengercompartment, front and rear crushzones, a collapsible steering column,and tensioners that tighten the frontseat belts in a crash.
However, you and your passengerscan’t take full advantage of thesefeatures unless you remain sitting inthe correct position and
. In fact, some safetyfeatures can contribute to injuries ifthey are not used properly.
The following pages explain how youcan take an active role in protectingyourself and your passengers.
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
always wearyour seat belts
7
(7)
(10)
(5)
(11)
(10)
(2)
(6)(8) (9) (12) (3)
(8)
(7)
(4)
(9)
(2)(1)
(1) Safety Cage(2) Crush Zones(3) Seats and Seat-Backs(4) Head Restraints(5) Collapsible Steering Column(6) Seat Belts(7) Front Airbags(8) Side Airbags(9) Side Curtain Airbags(10) Door Locks(11) Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners(12) Occupant Position Detection
System (OPDS) Sensors
12/08/09 16:00:02 31SJC670_014
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
2013 Ridgeline
----
Your vehicle is equipped with seatbelts in all seating positions.
Seat belts are the single mosteffective safety device for adults andlarger children. (Infants and smallerchildren must be properly restrainedin child seats.)
Not wearing a seat belt properlyincreases the chance of seriousinjury or death in a crash, eventhough your vehicle has airbags.
The pickup bed is not equipped withseats or seat belts. Do not let anyoneride in the pickup bed as they caneasily be thrown out and be killed orseriously injured.
In addition, most states and allCanadian provinces and territoriesrequire you to wear seat belts.
Your seat belt system also includesan indicator on the instrument paneland a beeper to remind you and yourpassengers to fasten your seat belts.
Keep you connected to the vehicleso you can take advantage of thevehicle’s built-in safety features.
When properly worn, seat belts:
Help protect you in almost everytype of crash, including:
frontal impactsside impactsrear impactsrollovers
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
Seat Belts Why Wear Seat Belts
8
Not wearing a seat belt properlyincreases the chance of seriousinjury or death in a crash, eventhough your vehicle has airbags.
Be sure you and yourpassengers always wear seatbelts and wear them properly.
Allowing passengers to ride inthe pickup bed or on the tailgatecan result in death or seriousinjury in a crash.
Make sure all passengers ridein a seat and wear a seat beltproperly.
12/08/09 16:00:10 31SJC670_015
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
2013 Ridgeline
Your vehicle has a supplementalrestraint system (SRS) with frontairbags to help protect the heads andchests of the driver and a front seatpassenger during a moderate tosevere frontal collision (see page
for more information on howyour front airbags work).
Your vehicle also has side airbags tohelp protect the upper torso of thedriver or a front seat passengerduring a moderate to severe sideimpact (see page for moreinformation on how your sideairbags work).
Help keep you in a good positionshould the airbags ever deploy. Agood position reduces the risk ofinjury from an inflating airbag andallows you to get the bestadvantage from the airbag.
Of course, seat belts cannotcompletely protect you in everycrash. But in most cases, seatbelts can reduce your risk ofserious injury.
Always wearyour seat belt, and make sure youwear it properly.
Help keep you from being thrownagainst the inside of the vehicleand against other occupants.
Keep you from being thrown outof the vehicle.
25
28
CONTINUED
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
Airbags
What you should do:
9
12/08/09 16:00:18 31SJC670_016
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
2013 Ridgeline
The rest of this section gives moredetailed information about how youcan maximize your safety.
The most important things you needto know about your airbags are:
They are designed to supplementthe seat belts.
Remember, however, that no safetysystem can prevent all injuries ordeaths that can occur in a severecrash, even when seat belts areproperly worn and the airbags deploy.
Always wearyour seat belt properly, and situpright and as far back from thesteering wheel as possible whileallowing full control of the vehicle. Afront passenger should move theirseat as far back from the dashboardas possible.
To do their job, airbags mustinflate with tremendous force. So, while airbags help save lives, they can cause burns,bruises, and other minor injuries,and sometimes even fatal ones if occupants are not wearing their seat belts properlyand sitting correctly.
In addition, your vehicle has sidecurtain airbags to help protect theheads of the driver, front passenger,and passengers in the outer rearseating positions during a moderateto severe side impact or rollover (seepage for more information on howyour side curtain airbags work).
30
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
Airbags do not replace seat belts.
What you should do:
Airbags can pose serious hazards.
Airbags offer no protection in rear collisions, or minor frontal or side collisions.
10
12/08/09 16:00:25 31SJC670_017
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
2013 Ridgeline
-See pages for importantguidelines on how to properlyprotect infants, small children, andlarger children who ride in yourvehicle.
The following pages provideinstructions on how to properlyprotect the driver, adult passengers,and teenage children who are largeenough and mature enough to driveor ride in the front.
After everyone has entered thevehicle, be sure the doors are closedand locked. Before driving, be surethe tailgate is also closed.
Your vehicle has a door andtailgate open indicator on
the instrument panel to indicatewhen any door or the tailgate is nottightly closed.
Your vehicle also has anIn-Bed Trunk open
indicator to show when the In-BedTrunk lid is not tightly closed (seepage ).
Your vehicle also has a tailgate, In-Bed Trunk, and door open indicatoron the multi-information display toindicate when the tailgate, the In-Bed Trunk, or a specific door is nottightly closed. You will see theappropriate indicator(s) andmessage(s) for each condition.
You will also hear a beep when youturn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position, and each time you openany door, the tailgate, or the In-BedTrunk with the key in the ON (II)position.
Your vehicle also has atailgate and door open
indicator on the information displayto indicate when the tailgate or aspecific door is not tightly closed.You will see the appropriateindicator(s) for each condition.
34 54
75
CONTINUED
On models with navigation system
On models without navigation system
Protecting Adults and Teens
Introduction
Close and Lock the Doors1.
11
12/08/09 16:00:35 31SJC670_018
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
2013 Ridgeline
When one or more doors are open,the ‘‘DOOR OPEN’’ message willcome on.
When the In-Bed Trunk is not tightlyclosed, the ‘‘TRUNK OPEN’’message will come on.
When the tailgate is not tightlyclosed, the ‘‘TAILGATE OPEN’’message will come on.
Protecting Adults and Teens
12
12/08/09 16:00:40 31SJC670_019
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
2013 Ridgeline
Adjust the driver’s seat as far to therear as possible while allowing you tomaintain full control of the vehicle.Have a front passenger adjust theirseat as far to the rear as possible.
Locking the doors reduces thechance of someone being thrown outof the vehicle during a crash, and ithelps prevent passengers fromaccidentally opening a door andfalling out.
Locking the doors also helps preventan outsider from unexpectedlyopening a door when you come to astop.
This vehicle has auto door locking/unlocking features. See page forhow to set them.
When the In-Bed Trunk, tailgate,and one or more doors are nottightly closed, the ‘‘DOOR, TRUNK& TAILGATE OPEN’’ message willcome on.
104
CONTINUED
Protecting Adults and Teens
Adjust the Front Seats2.
13
12/08/09 16:00:47 31SJC670_020
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
2013 Ridgeline
If you sit too close to the steeringwheel or dashboard, you can beseriously injured by an inflating frontairbag, or by striking the steeringwheel or dashboard.
Adjust the driver’s seat-back to acomfortable, upright position,leaving ample space between yourchest and the airbag cover in thecenter of the steering wheel.
Passengers with adjustable seat-backs should also adjust their seat-back to a comfortable, uprightposition.
Once your seat is adjusted correctly,rock it back and forth to make sure itis locked into position. See page
for how to adjust the front seats.If you cannot get far enough awayfrom the steering wheel and stillreach the controls, we recommendthat you investigate whether sometype of adaptive equipment may help.
The National Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that driversallow at least 10 inches (25 cm)between the center of the steeringwheel and the chest. In addition toadjusting the seat, you can adjust thesteering wheel up and down (seepage ).99
119
On RT, DX, VP, and Sport models
Protecting Adults and Teens
Adjust the Seat-Backs3.
14
Sitting too close to a frontairbag can result in seriousinjury or death if the frontairbags inflate.
Always sit as far back from thefront airbags as possible.
12/08/09 16:00:54 31SJC670_021
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
2013 Ridgeline
Adjust the driver’s head restraint sothe center of the back of your headrests against the center of therestraint.
Reclining a seat-back so that theshoulder part of the belt no longerrests against the occupant’s chestreduces the protective capability ofthe belt. It also increases the chanceof sliding under the belt in a crashand being seriously injured. Thefarther a seat-back is reclined, thegreater the risk of injury.
When a passenger is seated in therear center seating position, makesure the center head restraint isadjusted to its highest position.
Properly adjusted head restraintswill help protect occupants fromwhiplash and other crash injuries.Have passengers adjust their head
restraints properly as well. Tallerpersons should adjust their restraintas high as possible.
See page for how to adjust themanual adjustable seat-back, andpage for the power adjustableseat-back.
See page for how to adjust thehead restraints and how the driver’sand front passenger’s active headrestraints work.
120
121
123
Protecting Adults and Teens
Adjust the Head Restraints4.
15
Reclining the seat-back too farcan result in serious injury ordeath in a crash.
Adjust the seat-back to anupright position, and sit wellback in the seat.
Improperly positioning headrestraints reduces theireffectiveness and you can beseriously injured in a crash.
Make sure head restraints arein place and positioned properlybefore driving.
12/08/09 16:01:03 31SJC670_022
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
2013 Ridgeline
Position the lap part of the belt aslow as possible across your hips,then pull up on the shoulder part ofthe belt so the lap part fits snugly.This lets your strong pelvic bonestake the force of a crash and reducesthe chance of internal injuries.
Insert the latch plate into the buckle,then tug on the belt to make sure thebelt is securely latched. Check thatthe belt is not twisted, because atwisted belt can cause seriousinjuries in a crash.
If necessary, pull up on the belt againto remove any slack, then check thatthe belt rests across the center ofyour chest and over your shoulder.
This spreads the forces of a crashover the strongest bones in yourupper body.
If the seat belt touches or crossesyour neck, or if it crosses your arminstead of your shoulder, you need toadjust the seat belt anchor height.
the Seat Belts5.Fasten and Position
Protecting Adults and Teens
16
Improperly positioning the seatbelts can cause serious injuryor death in a crash.
Make sure all seat belts areproperly positioned beforedriving.
12/08/09 16:01:09 31SJC670_023
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
2013 Ridgeline
CONTINUED
This could causevery serious injuries in a crash.
See page for additionalinformation about your seat beltsand how to take care of them.
The front seats have adjustable seatbelt anchors. To adjust the height ofan anchor, squeeze the two releasebuttons, and slide the anchor up ordown as needed (it has fourpositions).
After all occupants have adjustedtheir seats and head restraints, andput on their seat belts, it is veryimportant that they continue to situpright, well back in their seats, withtheir feet on the floor, until thevehicle is safely parked and theengine is off.
Using a seatbelt that is not working properly canresult in serious injury or death.Have your dealer check the belt assoon as possible.
Sitting improperly can increase thechance of injury during a crash. Forexample, if an occupant slouches,lies down, turns sideways, sitsforward, leans forward or sideways,or puts one or both feet up, thechance of injury during a crash isgreatly increased.
If a seat belt does not seem to workproperly, it may not protect theoccupant in a crash.
20
Protecting Adults and Teens
Never place the shoulder portion of alap/shoulder belt under your arm orbehind your back.
No one should sit in a seat with aninoperative seat belt.
Sitting Position6.Maintain a Proper
17
RELEASEBUTTONS
12/08/09 16:01:17 31SJC670_024
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
2013 Ridgeline
In addition, an occupant who is out ofposition in the front seat can beseriously or fatally injured in a crashby striking interior parts of thevehicle or being struck by aninflating front airbag.
If you are pregnant, the best way toprotect yourself and your unbornchild when driving or riding in avehicle is to always wear a seat belt,and keep the lap part of the belt aslow as possible across the hips.
When driving, remember to situpright and adjust the seat as farback as possible while allowing fullcontrol of the vehicle. When ridingas a front passenger, adjust the seatas far back as possible.
This will reduce the risk of injuriesto both you and your unborn childthat can be caused by a crash or aninflating front airbag.
Each time you have a checkup, askyour doctor if it’s okay for you todrive.
Advice for Pregnant Women
Protecting Adults and Teens
18
Sitting improperly or out ofposition can result in seriousinjury or death in a crash.
Always sit upright, well back inthe seat, with your feet on thefloor.
12/08/09 16:01:23 31SJC670_025
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
2013 Ridgeline
If they do, they could be veryseriously injured in a crash.
If they do, they couldbe killed or very seriously injuredin a crash.
They could bekilled or injured in a crash, orbecome ill or even die from carbonmonoxide poisoning if engineexhaust enters the cap.
A passenger who is notwearing a seat belt during a crashor emergency stop can be thrownagainst the inside of the vehicle,against other occupants, or out ofthe vehicle.
If they do, theycould be very seriously injured in acrash.
Devices intended to improveoccupant comfort or reposition theshoulder part of a seat belt canreduce the protective capability ofthe seat belt and increase thechance of serious injury in a crash.
Carrying hard or sharpobjects on your lap, or driving witha pipe or other sharp object inyour mouth, can result in injuriesif your front airbag inflates.
If yourhands or arms are close to anairbag cover, they could be injuredif the airbag inflates.
Objects onthe covers marked ‘‘SRS AIRBAG’’could interfere with the properoperation of the airbags or bepropelled inside the vehicle andhurt someone if the airbags inflate.
If a side airbag or aside curtain airbag inflates, a cupholder or other hard objectattached on or near the door couldbe propelled inside the vehicle andhurt someone.
Improperly replacingor covering front seat-back coverscan prevent your side airbags frominflating during a side impact.
Protecting Adults and Teens
Additional Safety PrecautionsNever let passengers ride in thearea in front of a folded-up rearseat.
Never let passengers ride in thepickup bed.
Never let passengers ride inside atruck cap (shell).
Passengers should not stand up orchange seats while the vehicle ismoving.
Two people should never use thesame seat belt.
Do not put any accessories on seatbelts.
Do not place hard or sharp objectsbetween yourself and a frontairbag.
Keep your hands and arms awayfrom the airbag covers.
Do not attach or place objects onthe front airbag covers.
Do not attach hard objects on ornear a door.
Do not cover or replace front seat-back covers without consultingyour dealer.
19
12/08/09 16:01:32 31SJC670_026
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
2013 Ridgeline
Your seat belt system includes lap/shoulder belts in all seating positions.The front seat belts are alsoequipped with automatic seat belttensioners.
If the indicator comes on or thebeeper sounds when the driver’s seatbelt is latched and there is no frontseat passenger and no items on thefront seat, something may beinterfering with the monitoringsystem. Look for and remove:
Any items under the frontpassenger’s seat.
Any object(s) hanging on the seator in the seat-back pocket.
Any object on the floor that istouching the rear of the seat-back.
If no obstructions are found, haveyour vehicle checked by a dealer.
The seat belt systemincludes an indicator on the
instrument panel and a beeper toremind you and your passengers tofasten your seat belts.
This system monitors the front seatbelts. If you turn the ignition switchto the ON (II) position before yourseat belt is fastened, the beeper willsound and the indicator will flash. Ifyour seat belt is not fastened beforethe beeper stops, the indicator willstop flashing but remain on.
If a front passenger does not fastentheir seat belt, the indicator willcome on about 6 seconds after theignition switch is turned to the ON(II) position.
If either the driver or a frontpassenger does not fasten their seatbelt while driving, the beeper willsound and the indicator will flashagain at regular intervals.
You will also see a ‘‘FASTEN SEATBELT’’ or ‘‘FASTEN PASSENGERSEAT BELT’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
When no one is sitting in the frontpassenger’s seat, or an infant orsmall child is riding there, theindicator may not come on and thebeeper may not sound.
90
On models with navigation system
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
Seat Belt System Components
20
12/08/09 16:01:41 31SJC670_027
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
All seat belts have an emergencylocking retractor. In normal driving,the retractor lets you move freely inyour seat while it keeps sometension on the belt. During a collisionor sudden stop, the retractorautomatically locks the belt to helprestrain your body.
The seat belts in all positions exceptthe driver’s have a lockable retractorthat must be activated to secure achild seat (see page ).
The lap/shoulder belt goes overyour shoulder, across your chest,and across your hips.
To fasten the belt, insert the latchplate into the buckle, then tug on thebelt to make sure the buckle islatched (see page for how toproperly position the belt).
To unlock the belt, press the redPRESS button on the buckle. Guidethe belt across your body so that itretracts completely. After exiting thevehicle, be sure the belt is out of theway and will not get closed in thedoor.
If the shoulder part of the belt ispulled all the way out, the lockableretractor will activate. The belt willretract, but it will not allow thepassenger to move freely.
To deactivate the lockable retractor,unlatch the buckle and let the seatbelt fully retract. To refasten theseat belt, pull it out only as far asneeded.
46
16
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
Lap/Shoulder Belt
21
Allowing a child to play with aseat belt or wrap one aroundtheir neck can result in seriousinjury or death.
Instruct children not to play withany seat belt and make sureany unused seat belt a childcan reach is buckled, fullyretracted, and locked.
12/08/09 16:01:48 31SJC670_028
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
If a seat belt is worn during a crash,you should have your dealer inspectthe belt, and replace it if necessary.A belt that has been worn during acrash may not provide the same levelof protection in a subsequent crash.
The dealer should also inspect theanchors for damage and replacethem if needed. If the automatic seatbelt tensioners activate during acrash, they must be replaced.
If the tensioner is activated, the SRSindicator comes on and the tensionermust be replaced.
For safety, you should check thecondition of your seat belts regularly.
Pull each belt out fully, and look forfrays, cuts, burns, and wear. Checkthat the latches work smoothly andthe belts retract easily. If a belt doesnot retract easily, cleaning the beltmay correct the problem (see page
). Any belt that is not in goodcondition or working properly willnot provide good protection andshould be replaced as soon aspossible.
Honda provides a limited warrantyon seat belts. See your
booklet fordetails.
For added protection, the front seatbelts are equipped with automaticseat belt tensioners. When activated,the tensioners immediately tightenthe belts to help hold the driver anda front passenger in position.
The tensioners can be activatedduring a collision in which the frontairbags . In this case, theairbags would not be needed, but theadditional restraint could be helpful.
341
HondaWarranty Information
do not deploy
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
Seat Belt Maintenance
Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
22
Not checking or maintainingseat belts can result in seriousinjury or death if the seat beltsdo not work properly whenneeded.
Check your seat belts regularlyand have any problemcorrected as soon as possible.
12/08/09 16:01:57 31SJC670_029
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
CONTINUED
Airbag System Components
Additional Information About Your Airbags
23
(1)
(3)
(5)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(10)
(13)
(9) (8) (2)
(16)
(4)
(15)
(16)
(8)
(14) (7)(12)
(14)
(11)
(1) Driver’s Front Airbag(2) Passenger’s Front Airbag(3) Control Unit(4) Front Seat Belt Tensioners(5) Side Airbags(6) Driver’s Seat Position Sensor(7) Front Passenger’s Weight Sensors
(12) Front Passenger’s Weight Sensors Control Unit/OPDS Sensors Control Unit
(13) SRS Indicator(14) Side Curtain Airbags(15) Roll Rate Sensor(16) Side Impact Sensors (Second)
(8) Front Impact Sensors(9) Passenger Airbag Off Indicator(10) Side Impact Sensors (First)(11) Occupant Position Detection System (OPDS) Sensors
12/08/09 16:02:03 31SJC670_030
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
Weight sensors that monitor theweight on the front passenger’sseat. If the weight is about 65 lbs(29 kg) or less (the weight of aninfant or small child), thepassenger’s front airbag will beturned off (see page ).
A rollover sensor that can detect ifyour vehicle is about to roll overand signal the control unit todeploy both side curtain airbags(see page ).
A sophisticated electronic systemthat continually monitors andrecords information about thesensors, the control unit, theairbag activators, the seat belttensioners, and driver and frontpassenger seat belt use when theignition switch is in the ON (II)position.
Automatic front seat belttensioners (see page ).
Sensors that can detect amoderate to severe front impact,side impact, or if your vehicle isabout to rollover.
Sensors that can detect whether achild is in the passenger’s sideairbag path and signal the controlunit to turn the airbag off (seepage ).
Sensors that can detect whetherthe driver’s seat belt and the frontpassenger’s seat belt are latchedor unlatched (see page ).
A driver’s seat position sensor thatmonitors the distance of the seatfrom the front airbag. If the seat istoo far forward, the airbag willinflate with less force (see page
).
Your airbag system includes:
Two SRS (supplemental restraintsystem) front airbags. The driver’sairbag is stored in the center ofthe steering wheel; the frontpassenger’s airbag is stored in thedashboard. Both are marked ‘‘SRSAIRBAG’’ (see page ).
Two side airbags, one for thedriver and one for a frontpassenger. The airbags are storedin the outer edges of the seat-backs. Both are marked ‘‘SIDEAIRBAG’’ (see page ).
Two side curtain airbags, one foreach side of the vehicle. Theairbags are stored in the ceiling,above the side windows. The frontand rear pillars are marked ‘‘SIDECURTAIN AIRBAG’’ (see page
).
27
30
27
20
29
25
28
30
22
Additional Information About Your Airbags
24
12/08/09 16:02:13 31SJC670_031
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
CONTINUED
During a frontal crash, your seat beltrestrains your lower body and torso,and the front airbag helps protectyour head and chest.
Although both airbags normallyinflate within a split second of eachother, it is possible for only oneairbag to deploy.
This can happen if the severity of acollision is at the margin, orthreshold, that determines whetheror not the airbags will deploy. Insuch cases, the seat belt will providesufficient protection, and thesupplemental protection offered bythe airbag would be minimal.
Only the driver’s airbag can deploy ifthere is no passenger in the frontseat, or if the advanced airbagsystem has turned the passenger’sairbag off (see page ).
If the rate of deceleration is highenough, the control unit will inflatethe driver’s and front passenger’sairbags, at the time and with theforce needed.
If you ever have a moderate tosevere frontal collision, sensors willdetect the vehicle’s rapiddeceleration.
An indicator on the instrumentpanel that alerts you to a possibleproblem with your airbag systemcomponents (see page ).
An indicator on the instrumentpanel that alerts you that thepassenger’s side airbag has beenturned off (see page ).
An indicator on the dashboard thatalerts you that the passenger’sfront airbag has been turned off(see page ).
Emergency backup power in caseyour vehicle’s electrical system isdisconnected in a crash.
27
30
31
31
Additional Information About Your Airbags
How Your Front Airbags Work
25
12/08/09 16:02:23 31SJC670_032
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
Your vehicle is equipped with dual-stage, multiple-threshold frontairbags (SRS). During a frontal crashsevere enough to cause one or bothfront airbags to deploy, the airbagscan inflate at different rates,depending on the severity of thecrash, whether or not the seat beltsare latched, and/or other factors.Front airbags are designed tosupplement the seat belts to helpreduce the likelihood of head andchest injuries in frontal crashes.
After a crash, you may see whatlooks like smoke. This is actuallypowder from the airbag’s surface.Although the powder is notharmful, people with respiratoryproblems may experience sometemporary discomfort. Ifthis occurs, get out of the vehicleas soon as it is safe to do so.
The total time for inflation anddeflation is less than a second, sofast that most occupants are notaware that the airbags deployed untilthey see them lying in their laps.
After inflating, the front airbagsimmediately deflate, so they won’tinterfere with the driver’s visibility,or the ability to steer or operateother controls.
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Dual-Stage, Multiple-ThresholdFront Airbags (SRS)
26
12/08/09 16:02:28 31SJC670_033
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
CONTINUED
Your front airbags are also advancedairbags. The main purpose of thisfeature is to help prevent airbag-caused injuries to short drivers andchildren or small-statured adults whoride in front.
The driver’s advanced front airbagsystem includes a seat positionsensor under the seat. If the seat istoo far forward, the airbag willinflate with less force, regardless ofthe severity of the impact.
The passenger’s advanced frontairbag system has weight sensorsunder the seat. Although Hondadoes not encourage carrying aninfant or small child in front, if thesensors detect the weight of aninfant or small child (up to about 65lbs or 29 kg), the system willautomatically turn the passenger’sfront airbag off.
If there is a problem with the sensor,the SRS indicator will come on, andthe airbag will inflate in the normalmanner regardless of the driver’sseating position.
Failure to follow these instructionscould damage the sensors or preventthem from working properly.
For both advanced airbags to workproperly:
Occupants must sit upright andwear their seat belts properly.
Do not spill any liquids on orunder the seats, cover the sensors,or put any objects or metal itemsunder the front seats.
Objects placed or pushed underthe front passenger’s seat maycause the sensor to malfunction,increasing the risk of injury in acrash.
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Advanced Airbags
27
DRIVER’S SEAT POSITION SENSOR PASSENGER’S SEAT WEIGHT SENSOR
12/08/09 16:02:37 31SJC670_034
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
Hanging heavy items on the frontpassenger seat, or placing heavyitems in the seat-back pocket.
Moving the front seat forciblyback against cargo on the seat orfloor behind it.
A rear passenger pushing orpulling on the back of the frontpassenger’s seat.
When the passenger airbag getsturned off by the weight sensors, a‘‘passenger airbag off’’ indicator inthe center of the dashboard comeson (see page ).
Be aware that objects placed on thepassenger’s seat can also cause theairbag to be turned off.
If you ever have a moderate tosevere side impact, sensors willdetect rapid acceleration and signalthe control unit to instantly inflateeither the driver’s or the passenger’sside airbag.
To ensure that the passenger’sadvanced front airbag system willwork properly,
This includes:
If the weight sensors detect there isno passenger in the front seat, theairbag is automatically turned off.However, the passenger airbag offindicator in this situation will notcome on.
Also, make sure the floor mat behindthe front passenger’s seat is hookedto the floor mat anchor (see page
). If it is not, the mat mayinterfere with the proper operationof the sensors and operation of theseat.
Back seat passengers should notwedge objects or intentionallyforce their feet under the frontpassenger seat.
31
342
Additional Information About Your Airbags
How Your Side Airbags Work
do not do anythingthat would increase or decrease theweight on the front passenger’s seat.
28
12/08/09 16:02:46 31SJC670_035
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
To get the best protection from theside airbags, front seat occupantsshould wear their seat belts and situpright and well back in their seats.
Your vehicle has a side airbag cutoffsystem designed primarilyto protect a child riding in the frontpassenger’s seat.
If the side airbag off indicator comeson (see page ), have thepassenger sit upright. Once thepassenger is out of the airbag’sdeployment path, the system willturn the airbag back on, and theindicator will go out.
There will be some delay betweenthe moment the passenger movesinto or out of the airbag deploymentpath and when the indicator comeson or goes off.
A front seat passenger should notuse a cushion or another object as abackrest. It may prevent the cutoffsystem from working properly.
Although Honda does notencourage children to ride in front,if the position sensors detect achild has leaned into the sideairbag’s deployment path, theairbag will shut off.
Objects placed on the frontpassenger seat can also cause theside airbag to be shut off.
The side airbag may also shut off if ashort adult leans sideways, or alarger adult slouches and leanssideways into the airbag’sdeployment path.
Only one airbag will deploy during aside impact. If the impact is on thepassenger’s side, the passenger’sside airbag will deploy even if thereis no passenger.
31
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Side Airbag Cutoff System
29
12/08/09 16:02:53 31SJC670_036
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
A rollover sensor monitors thedegree and rate your vehicle mayroll over and automatically deploythe side curtain airbags and activatethe front seat belt tensioners (seepage ).
In a rollover toward the frontpassenger’s side of the vehicle, bothside curtain airbags will inflate andthe front seat belt tensioners willactivate even if there are nooccupants on that side of the vehicle.
To get the best protection from theside curtain airbags, occupantsshould wear their seat belts and situpright and well back in their seats.
When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, this indicatorcomes on for several seconds thengoes off. This tells you the system isworking properly.
If the indicator comes on at anyother time, or does not come on at all,you should have the system checkedby your dealer. For example:
If the SRS indicator does not comeon after you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position.
If the indicator comes on orflashes on and off while you drive.
If the indicator stays on after theengine starts.
The SRS indicator alerts you to apotential problem with your airbagsystem components.
In a moderate to severe sideimpact, sensors will detectrapid acceleration and signal thecontrol unit to instantly inflate theside curtain airbag.
22
Additional Information About Your Airbags
How Your Side Curtain Airbags Work
How the SRS Indicator Works
In a Rollover
In a Side Impact
30
SIDE CURTAIN AIRBAG
12/08/09 16:03:03 31SJC670_037
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
CONTINUED
This indicator alerts you that thepassenger’s front airbag has beenshut off because weight sensorsdetect about 65 lbs (29 kg) or less(the weight of an infant or smallchild) on the front passenger’s seat.It does there is a problemwith the airbag.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKAIRBAG SYSTEM’’ message on themulti-information display (see page ).
This indicator alerts you that thepassenger’s side airbag has beenautomatically shut off. It doesmean there is a problem with yourside airbags.
When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, the indicatorshould come on for several secondsand then go off (see page ). If itdoesn’t come on, stays on, or comes on while driving without apassenger in the front seat, have the system checked.
You will also see a ‘‘PASSENGERSIDE AIRBAG OFF’’ message on themulti-information display (see page ).
If you see any of these indications,the airbag system components may not work properlywhen you need them.
90
90
64
On models with navigation system
On models with navigation system
Additional Information About Your Airbags
How the Passenger Airbag OffIndicator Works
How the SideAirbag OffIndicator Works
not mean
not
31
Canada
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF INDICATOR
U.S.
U.S. Canada
Ignoring the SRS indicator canresult in serious injury or deathif the airbag systems ortensioners do not work properly.
Have your vehicle checked by adealer as soon as possible ifthe SRS indicator alerts you toa possible problem.
12/08/09 16:03:13 31SJC670_038
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
Your airbag systems are virtuallymaintenance free, and there are noparts you can safely service.However, you must have yourvehicle serviced if:
Any airbagthat has deployed must bereplaced along with the controlunit and other related parts. Anyseat belt tensioner that activatesmust also be replaced.
Be aware that objects placed on thefront seat can cause the indicator tocome on.
If no weight is detected on the frontseat, the airbag will be automaticallyshut off. However, the indicator willnot come on.
The passenger airbag off indicatormay come on and off repeatedly ifthe total weight on the seat is nearthe airbag cutoff threshold.
If an adult or teenage passenger isriding in front, move the seat as farto the rear as possible, and have thepassenger sit upright and wear theseat belt properly.
If the indicator comes on with nofront seat passenger and no objectson the seat, or with an adult ridingthere, something may be interferingwith the weight sensors. Look forand remove:
Any items under the frontpassenger’s seat.
Any object(s) touching the rear ofthe seat-back.
If no obstructions are found, haveyour vehicle checked by a dealer assoon as possible.
Any object(s) hanging on the seator in the seat-back pocket.
We recommend against the useof salvaged airbag systemcomponents, including theairbag, tensioners, sensors,and control unit.
Do not try to remove or replaceany airbag by yourself. This mustbe done by an authorized dealer ora knowledgeable body shop.
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Airbag Service
An airbag ever inflates.
32
12/08/09 16:03:23 31SJC670_039
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
Together, airbags andseat belts provide the bestprotection.
Tampering could causethe airbags to deploy, possiblycausing very serious injury.
If water oranother liquid soaks into a seat-back, it can prevent the sideairbag cutoff system from working properly.
This could make thedriver’s seat position sensor or thefront passenger’s weight sensorsineffective. If it is necessary toremove or modify a front seat toaccommodate a person withdisabilities, first contact HondaAutomobile Customer Service at(800) 999-1009 in the US, orHonda Customer Relations at
Even if yourairbags do not inflate, your dealershould inspect the driver’s seatposition sensor, the frontpassenger’s weight sensors, thefront seat belt tensioners, and allseat belts and their anchors wornduring a crash to make sure theyare operating properly.
Take your vehicle to anauthorized dealer as soon aspossible. If you ignore thisindication, your airbags may notoperate properly.
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Additional Safety PrecautionsDo not attempt to deactivate yourairbags.
Do not tamper with airbagcomponents or wiring for anyreason.
Do not expose the front passenger’sseat-back to liquid.
Do not remove or modify a frontseat without consulting yourdealer.
If your vehicle has a moderate tosevere impact.
The SRS indicator alerts you to aproblem.
33
12/08/09 16:03:29 31SJC670_040
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
1-888-9-HONDA-9 in Canada.
-
--
If you have children, or everneed to drive with a child in yourvehicle, be sure to read this section. It begins with importantgeneral guidelines, then presents special information for infants,small children, and larger children.
To reduce the number of childdeaths and injuries, every state,Canadian province and territoryrequires that infants and children beproperly restrained when they ride ina vehicle.
(see pages ).(see pages ).
Children depend on adults to protectthem. However, despite their bestintentions, many adults do not knowhow to protect childpassengers.
Each year, many children are injured or killed in vehicle crashes becausethey are either unrestrained or not properly restrained. In fact,traffic collisions are the number one cause of death of children age12 and under.
39 5051 54
properly
Protecting Children General Guidelines
All Children Must Be Restrained
Infants and small children must berestrained in an approved child seatthat is properly secured to thevehicle
Larger children must be restrainedwith a lap/shoulder belt and ride ona booster seat until the seat belt f itsthem properly
34
Children who are unrestrainedor improperly restrained can beseriously injured or killed in acrash.
Any child too small for a seatbelt should be properlyrestrained in a child seat. Alarger child should be properlyrestrained with a seat belt anduse a booster seat if necessary.
12/08/09 16:03:36 31SJC670_041
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
-
Front airbags have been designed tohelp protect adults in a moderate tosevere frontal collision. To do this,the passenger’s front airbag is quitelarge, and it can inflate with enoughforce to cause very serious injuries.
If the vehicle seat istoo far forward, or the child’s head isthrown forward during a collision, aninflating front airbag can strike thechild with enough force to kill orvery seriously injure a small child.
Whenever possible,larger children should sit in the backseat, on a booster seat if needed, andbe properly restrained with a seatbelt (see page for importantinformation about protecting largerchildren).
Even though your vehicle has anadvanced front airbag system thatautomatically turns the passenger’sfront airbag off under certaincircumstances (see page ), pleasefollow these guidelines:
Ifthe airbag inflates, it can hit the backof the child seat with enough forceto kill or very seriously injure aninfant.
According to crash statistics,children of all ages and sizes aresafer when they are restrained in aback seat.
The National Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that all childrenaged 12 and under be properlyrestrained in a back seat. Somestates have laws restricting wherechildren may ride.
Children who ride in the back areless likely to be injured by strikinginterior vehicle parts during acollision or hard braking. Also,children cannot be injured by aninflating front airbag when they ridein the back.
51
31
CONTINUED
Protecting Children General Guidelines
Small ChildrenPlacing a forward-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s front airbag canbe hazardous.
Larger ChildrenChildren who have outgrown childseats are also at risk of being injuredor killed by an inflating passenger’sfront airbag.
Never put a rear-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s front airbag.
Infants
All Children Should Sitin a Back Seat
The Passenger’s Front AirbagCan Pose Serious Risks
35
12/08/09 16:03:46 31SJC670_042
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
-
To remind you of the passenger’sfront airbag hazards, and thatchildren must be properly restrainedin a back seat, your vehicle haswarning labels on the dashboard(U.S. models) and on the front visors.Please read and follow theinstructions on these labels.
Protecting Children General Guidelines
Canadian Models
U.S. Models
36
SUN VISORS DASHBOARD
SUN VISORS
12/08/09 16:03:56 31SJC670_043
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
-
Many parents say they prefer to putan infant or a small child in the frontpassenger seat so they can watch thechild, or because the child requiresattention.
Placing a child in the front seatexposes the child to hazards in afrontal collision, and paying closeattention to a child distracts thedriver from the important tasks ofdriving, placing both of you at risk.
Your vehicle has a back seatwhere children can be properlyrestrained. If you ever haveto carry a group of children, and achild must ride in front:
Place the largest child in the frontseat, provided the child is largeenough to wear the lap/shoulderbelt properly (see page ).
If a child requires close physicalattention or frequent visual contact,we strongly recommend that anotheradult ride with the child in the backseat. The back seat is far safer for achild than the front.
Move the vehicle seat as far to therear as possible (see page ).
Have the child sit upright and wellback in the seat (see page ).
Make sure the seat belt is properlypositioned and secured (see page ).
17
16
51
119
If You Must Drive with Several Children
If a Child Requires
Protecting Children General Guidelines
37
12/08/09 16:04:04 31SJC670_044
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
Close Attention
-
During a crash, thebelt could press deep into the childand cause serious or fatal injuries.
If they do, theycould be very seriously injured in
Children who play in vehiclescan accidentally get trapped inside.Teach your children not to play inor around vehicles. Know how tooperate the emergency In-BedTrunk opener and decide if yourchildren should be shown how touse this feature (see page ).
Opening orclosing the tailgate could causeaccidental injuries.
Even very youngchildren learn how to unlockvehicle doors, turn on the ignitionswitch, and open the windows,which can lead to accidental injuryor death.
If you are not wearing aseat belt in a crash, you could bethrown forward and crush thechild against the dashboard or aseat-back. If you are wearing aseat belt, the child can be tornfrom your arms and be seriouslyhurt or killed.
If a child wraps a loose
seat belt around their neck, theycan be seriously or fatally injured.(See pages and for how toactivate and deactivate thelockable retractor.)
Leaving children withoutadult supervision is illegal in moststates, Canadian provinces andterritories, and can be veryhazardous.
This can preventchildren from accidentally fallingout (see page ).
For example, infants and smallchildren left in a vehicle on a hotday can die from heatstroke. Achild left alone with the key in theignition switch can accidentally setthe vehicle in motion, possiblyinjuring themselves or others.
46 47
104117
Additional Safety Precautions
Protecting Children General Guidelines
Never put a seat belt over yourselfand a child.
Never let two children use thesame seat belt.
Lock all doors and the In-BedTrunk when your vehicle is not inuse.
Teach your children not to play onthe pickup bed.
Keep vehicle keys/remotetransmitters out of the reach ofchildren.
Never hold an infant or child onyour lap.
Make sure any unused seat beltthat a child can reach is buckled,the lockable retractor is activated,and the belt is fully retracted andlocked.
Do not leave children alone in avehicle.
Use the childproof door locks toprevent children from opening therear doors.
38
12/08/09 16:04:12 31SJC670_045
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
a crash.
CONTINUED
An infant must be properlyrestrained in a rear-facing, recliningchild seat until the child reaches theseat maker’s weight or height limitfor the seat, and the child is at leastone year old.
Only a rear-facing child seat providesproper support for a baby’s head,neck, and back.
Two types of seats may be used: aseat designed exclusively for infants,or a convertible seat used in the rear-facing, reclining mode.
If placedfacing forward, an infant could bevery seriously injured during afrontal collision.
A rear-facing child seat can be placedin any seating position in the backseat, but not in the front.
If the passenger’s front airbaginflates, it can hit the back of thechild seat with enough force to kill orseriously injure an infant.
When properly installed, a rear-facing child seat may prevent thedriver or a front passenger frommoving their seat as far back asrecommended, or from locking theirseat-back in the desired position.
It could also interfere with properoperation of the passenger’sadvanced front airbag system.
Protecting Infants
Child Seat Type
Do not put a rear-facing child seat ina forward-facing position.
Never put arear-facing child seat in the frontseat.
Rear-facing Child Seat Placement
Protecting Infants and Small Children
39
12/08/09 16:04:21 31SJC670_046
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
In any of these situations, westrongly recommend that you installthe child seat directly behind thefront passenger’s seat, move the seatas far forward as needed, and leave itunoccupied. Or, you may wish to geta smaller rear-facing child seat.
Many states, Canadian provinces andterritories allow a child one year ofage or older who also meets theminimum size and weightrequirements to transition from arear-facing child seat to a forwardfacing seat. Know the requirementswhere you are driving and follow thechild seat instructions. Many expertsrecommend use of a rear-facing seatup to age two, if the child’s height
and weight are appropriate for arear-facing seat.
If the vehicle seat is toofar forward, or the child’s head isthrown forward during a collision, aninflating airbag can strike the childwith enough force to cause veryserious or fatal injuries.
We strongly recommend placing aforward-facing child seat in a backseat, not the front.
We also recommend that a smallchild use the child seat until the childreaches the weight or height limitfor the seat.
Of the different seats available, werecommend those that have a five-point harness system as shown.
Protecting Infants and Small Children
Protecting Small Children
Child Seat Type
Placing a forward-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s airbag can behazardous.
Child Seat Placement
40
Placing a rear-facing child seatin the front seat can result inserious injury or death during acrash.
Always place a rear-facing childseat in the back seat, not thefront.
12/08/09 16:04:30 31SJC670_047
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
If it is necessary to put a forward-facing child seat in the front, movethe vehicle seat as far to the rear aspossible, and be sure the child seat isfirmly secured to the vehicle and thechild is properly strapped in the seat.
Even with advanced front airbagsthat automatically turn thepassenger’s front airbag off (seepage ), a back seat is the safestplace for a small child.
Most child seats are LATCH-compatible (Lower Anchors andTethers for CHildren). Some have arigid-type connector, while othershave a flexible-type connector. Bothare equally easy to use. Someexisting and previously owned childseats can only be installed using theseat belt. Whichever type youchoose, follow the child seatmanufacturer’s use and careinstructions as well as theinstructions in this manual. Properinstallation is key to maximizing yourchild’s safety.
In seating positions and vehicles notequipped with LATCH, a LATCH-compatible child seat can be installedusing the seat belt and a top tetherfor added security. This is becauseall child seats are required to bedesigned so that they can be securedwith a lap belt or the lap part of alap/shoulder belt.
In addition, the child seatmanufacturer may advise that a seatbelt be used to attach a LATCH-compatible seat once a child reachesa specified weight. Please read thechild seat owner’s manual for properinstallation instructions.
31
Protecting Infants and Small Children, Selecting a Child Seat
Selecting a Child Seat
41
Placing a forward-facing childseat in the front seat can resultin serious injury or death if thefront airbag inflates.
If you must place a forward-facing child seat in front, movethe vehicle seat as far back aspossible, and properly restrainthe child.
12/08/09 16:04:36 31SJC670_048
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
After selecting a proper child seatand a good place to install the seat,there are three main steps ininstalling the seat:
All child seats must besecured to the vehicle with the lappart of a lap/shoulder belt or withthe LATCH (Lower Anchors andTethers for CHildren) system. Achild whose seat is not properlysecured to the vehicle can beendangered in a crash.
After installing a childseat, push and pull the seatforward and from side-to-side toverify that it is secure.
A child seat secured with a seat beltshould be installed as firmly aspossible. However, it does not needto be ‘‘rock solid.’’ Some side-to-side
movement can be expected andshould not reduce the child seat’seffectiveness.
If the child seat is not secure, tryinstalling it in a different seatingposition, or use a different style ofchild seat that can be firmly secured.
Make sure the child is properlystrapped in the child seataccording to the child seat maker’sinstructions. A child who is notproperly secured in a child seatcan be seriously injured in a crash.
The following pages provideguidelines on how to properly installa child seat. A forward-facing childseat is used in all examples, but theinstructions are the same for rear-facing child seats.
Make sure the child seat meets thefollowing three requirements:
The child seat is the correct typeand size for the child.
The child seat is the correct typefor the seating position.
The child seat is compliant withFederal Motor Vehicle SafetyStandard 213 or Canadian MotorVehicle Safety Standard 213.
Selecting a Child Seat, Installing a Child Seat
Installing a Child SeatImportant considerations whenselecting a child seat
Properly secure the child seat tothe vehicle.
Make sure the child seat is firmlysecured.
Secure the child in the child seat.
1.
2.
3.
42
12/08/09 16:04:45 31SJC670_049
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
To install a LATCH-compatiblechild seat:
Make sure there are no objectsnear the anchors that couldprevent a secure connectionbetween the child seat and theanchors.
When using the tether strap onthe child seat, attach the tetherstrap hook to the center tetheranchor before installing the childseat to the lower anchors for theLATCH system, because thecenter tether anchor is positionedbehind the child seat.
If needed, move the seat beltbuckle or tongue away from thelower anchors.
Whenever using the center tetheranchor point, make sure to pushdown the head restraint to the lowestposition, route the strap over theseat-back, then around the upperguide before attaching the tetherstrap hook to the center tetheranchor (see page ).
The location of each lower anchor isindicated by a small button above theanchor point.
The lower anchors are locatedbetween the seat-back and seatbottom, and are to be used onlywith a child seat designed for usewith LATCH.
Your vehicle is equipped withLATCH (Lower Anchors andTethers for CHildren) at therear seats.
1.
2.
3.
49CONTINUED
On the center seating position
Installing a Child Seat
Installing a Child Seat with LATCH
43
BUTTON
CENTER TETHER ANCHOR
LATCHANCHORPOINTS
UPPER GUIDE
12/08/09 16:04:55 31SJC670_050
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
Make sure the head restraint is inthe lowest position. Lift the cover,then route the tether strap aroundthe upper guide. Route the tetherstrap downward properly, makingsure the strap is not twisted, thenattach the strap hook to the centertether anchor.
Place the child seat on the vehicleseat, then attach the seat to thelower anchors according to thechild seat maker’s instructions.
Some LATCH-compatible seatshave a rigid-type connector asshown above.
Other LATCH-compatible seatshave a flexible-type connector asshown above.
Whatever type you have, followthe child seat maker’s instructionsfor adjusting or tightening the fit.
5.
4.
Installing a Child Seat
44
Flexible typeRigid type
12/08/09 16:05:00 31SJC670_051
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
Lift the head restraint (see page), then route the tether strap
over the seat-back and throughthe head restraint legs.Lift the cover, then route thetether strap around the upperguide. Route the tether strapdownward properly, making surethe strap is not twisted, thenattach the strap hook to the tetheranchor on the outside of the seatbottom (see page ).
Push and pull the child seatforward and from side-to-side toverify that it is secure.
Tighten the strap according to theseat maker’s instructions.
6. 7.
8.
48
123
On the outer seating position
Installing a Child Seat
45
Outer Position Center Position TETHER ANCHORTETHER ANCHOR
UPPER GUIDE UPPER GUIDE
12/08/09 16:05:07 31SJC670_052
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
When not using the LATCH system,all child seats must be secured to thevehicle with the lap part of a lap/shoulder belt.
With the child seat in the desiredseating position, route the beltthrough the child seat accordingto the seat maker’s instructions,then insert the latch plate into thebuckle and remove any slack fromthe lap portion of the belt.
To activate the lockable retractor,slowly pull the shoulder part of thebelt all the way out until it stops,then let the belt feed back into theretractor.
After the belt has retracted, tug onit. If the belt is locked, you will notbe able to pull it out. If you can pullthe belt out, it is not locked, andyou will need to repeat these steps.
In addition, the lap/shoulder belts inall seating positions except thedriver’s have a lockable retractorthat must be activated to secure achild seat.
If you intend to install thechild seat in the rear centerseating position and use thetether strap for additional security, make sure topush down the head restraintto the lowest position and hookthe tether strap hook to theanchor before securing thechild seat with the lap/ shoulderbelt. Refer to page for howto route the tether strap properly.
1. 2.
3.
48
Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Belt
Installing a Child Seat
46
12/08/09 16:05:15 31SJC670_053
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
After confirming that the belt islocked, grab the shoulder part ofthe belt near the buckle, and pullup to remove any slack from thelap part of the belt. Remember, ifthe lap part of the belt is not tight,the child seat will not be secure.
Push and pull the child seatforward and from side-to-side toverify that it is secure enough tostay upright during normal driving maneuvers. If thechild seat is not secure,unlatch the belt, allow it to retractfully, then repeat these steps.
To remove slack, it may help toput weight on the child seat, orpush on the back of the seat whilepulling up on the belt.
To deactivate the lockable retractorand remove a child seat, unlatch thebuckle, unroute the seat belt, and letthe belt fully retract.
4. 5.
Installing a Child Seat
47
12/08/09 16:05:21 31SJC670_054
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
When using a tether anchor, alwayshook the tether strap through theupper guide to route it properly.
Since a tether can provide additionalsecurity to the lap/shoulder beltinstallation, we recommend using atether whenever one is required oravailable.
Each outer seating position has atether anchor at the outside of theseat bottom. The center seatingposition has a tether anchor betweenthe lower anchors for the LATCH-compatible child seat. Each anchorpoint is shown above.
Lift the cover, then hook thetether strap through the upperguide as shown.
After properly securing the childseat (see page ), lift the headrestraint, then route the tetherstrap over the seat-back andthrough the head restraint legs.
A child seat with a tether can beinstalled in any seating position inthe back seat.
1.
2.
46
Installing a Child Seat
Installing a Child Seatwith a Tether
Using an Outer Tether Anchor
48
COVER CENTERTETHERANCHOR
OUTERTETHERANCHOR
OUTER TETHER ANCHOR
UPPER GUIDE
UPPER GUIDE
12/08/09 16:05:29 31SJC670_055
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
Route the tether strap downwardproperly, making sure the strap isnot twisted.
Attach the tether strap hook to theouter tether anchor on the outsideof the seat bottom.
Make sure to attach the tetherstrap hook to the anchor beforeinstalling the child seat, becausethe tether anchor is positioned behind the child seat.
Place the child seat on the rearseat.
Push down the rear center headrestraint to the lowest position.
Route the tether strap over theseat-back, lift the cover, then hookthe tether strap through the upperguide as shown.
Route the tether strap downwardproperly along the seat- back, making sure the strap is not twisted.
Tighten the strap according to theseat maker’s instructions.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
3.
4.
CONTINUED
Installing a Child Seat
Using the Center Tether Anchor
49
UPPER GUIDE
CENTER TETHER ANCHOR
12/08/09 16:05:38 31SJC670_056
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
Attach the tether strap hook to thecenter tether anchor between thelower anchors for the LATCH-compatible child seat.
Properly secure the child seat (seepage ), then tighten the tetherstrap according to the seat maker’sinstructions.
Whenever using the tether strap,make sure to route the strap throughthe upper guide before attaching thetether strap hook to the tetheranchor. If the tether strap is notrouted properly and secured, thechild seat may not be secured. Thiscould lead to serious injury or death.
5.
6.46
Installing a Child Seat
50
CENTER TETHER ANCHOR
UPPER GUIDE
12/08/09 16:05:43 31SJC670_057
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
The following pages giveinstructions on how to check properseat belt fit, what kind of boosterseat to use if one is needed, andimportant precautions for a childwho must sit in front.
To determine if a lap/shoulderbelt properly fits a child, have thechild put on the seat belt,then ask yourself:
Does the child sit all the way backagainst the seat?
Do the child’s knees bendcomfortably over the edge ofthe seat?
When a child reaches therecommended weight or height limitfor a forward-facing child seat, thechild should sit in a back seat on abooster seat and wear the lap/shoulder belt.
1.
2.
CONTINUED
Protecting Larger Children
Checking Seat Belt Fit
51
Allowing a child age 12 or underto sit in front can result in injuryor death if the passenger’s frontairbag inflates.
If a child must ride in front,move the vehicle seat as farback as possible, use a boosterseat if needed, have the childsit up properly and wear theseat belt properly.
12/08/09 16:05:50 31SJC670_058
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
Does the shoulder belt crossbetween the child’s neck and arm?
Is the lap part of the belt as low aspossible, touching the child’sthighs?
Will the child be able to stayseated like this for the whole trip?
If you answer yes to all thesequestions, the child is ready to wearthe lap/shoulder belt correctly. Ifyou answer no to any question, thechild needs to ride on a booster seat. A child who has outgrown a forward-
facing child seat should ride in aback seat and use a booster seatuntil the lap/shoulder belt fits themproperly without the booster.
Some states, Canadian provinces andterritories also require children touse a booster seat until they reach agiven age or weight (e.g., 6 years or60 lbs). Be sure to check current
territories where you intend to drive.
A child may continue using a boosterseat until the tops of their ears areeven with the top of the vehicle’s orbooster’s seat-back. A child of thisheight should be tall enough to usethe lap/shoulder belt without abooster seat.
If a child who uses a booster seatmust ride in front, move the vehicleseat as far back as possible and besure the child is wearing the seatbelt properly.
Booster seats can be high-back orlow-back. Whichever style you select,make sure the booster seat meetsfederal safety standards (see page
) and that you follow the boosterseat maker’s instructions.
3.
4.
5. 42
Protecting Larger Children
Using a Booster Seat
52
12/08/09 16:05:59 31SJC670_059
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
laws in the states, provinces and
If you decide that a child can safelyride up front, be sure to:
Carefully read the owner’s manual,and make sure you understand allseat belt instructions and all safetyinformation.
Move the vehicle seat to the rear-most position.
Have the child sit up straight, backagainst the seat, and feet on ornear the floor.
Check that the child’s seat belt isproperly and securely positioned.
Physically, a child must be largeenough for the lap/shoulder belt toproperly fit (see pages and ). Ifthe seat belt does not fit properly,with or without the child sitting on abooster seat, the child should not sitin front.
To safely ride in front, a child mustbe able to follow the rules, includingsitting properly, and wearing the seatbelt properly throughout a ride.
A side airbag also poses risks. Ifany part of a larger child’s bodyis in the path of a deploying sideairbag, the child could receivepossibly serious injuries.
If the passenger’s front airbaginflates in a moderate to severefrontal collision, the airbag can causeserious injuries to a child who isunrestrained, improperly restrained,sitting too close to the airbag, or outof position.
The National Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that all childrenage 12 and under be properlyrestrained in the back seat.
Of course, children vary widely. Andwhile age may be one indicator ofwhen a child can safely ride in front,there are other important factors youshould consider.
Supervise the child. Even a maturechild sometimes needs to bereminded to fasten the seat belt orsit properly.
16 51
Physical Size
Maturity
When Can a Larger Child Sit in Front
Protecting Larger Children
53
12/08/09 16:06:09 31SJC670_060
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
This could resultin serious neck injuries during
This couldcause very serious injuries duringa crash. It also increases thechance that the child will slideunder the belt in a crash and
If they do, theycould be very seriously injured in
Devices intended toimprove a child’s comfort orreposition the shoulder part of aseat belt can make the belt lesseffective and increase the chanceof serious injury in a crash.
Protecting Larger Children
Additional Safety PrecautionsDo not let a child wear a seat beltacross the neck.
Do not let a child put the shoulderpart of a seat belt behind the backor under the arm.
Two children should never use thesame seat belt.
Do not put any accessories on aseat belt.
54
12/08/09 16:06:15 31SJC670_061
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
a crash.
be injured.
a crash.
Your vehicle’s exhaust containscarbon monoxide gas. Carbonmonoxide should not enter thevehicle in normal driving if youmaintain your vehicle properly andfollow the information on this page.
High levels of carbon monoxide cancollect rapidly in enclosed areas,such as a garage. Do not run theengine with the garage door closed.Even with the door open, run theengine only long enough to move thevehicle out of the garage.
Have the exhaust system inspectedfor leaks whenever:
With a truck cap installed and theback window open, engine exhaustmay enter the vehicle and cause ahazardous condition. Keep the backwindow tightly closed whenever youdrive with a truck cap installed.
If you must sit in your parked vehiclewith the engine running, even in anunconfined area, adjust the heatingand cooling system/climate controlsystem as follows:
Select the fresh air mode.Select the mode.Turn the fan on high speed.Set the temperature control to acomfortable setting.
The vehicle is raised for an oilchange.
You notice a change in the soundof the exhaust.
The vehicle was in a collision thatmay have damaged the underside.
1.2.3.4.
Carbon Monoxide Hazard
55
Carbon monoxide gas is toxic.Breathing it can causeunconsciousness and even killyou.
Avoid any enclosed areas oractivities that expose you tocarbon monoxide.
12/08/09 16:06:21 31SJC670_062
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
These labels are in the locationsshown. They warn you of potentialhazards that could cause seriousinjury or death. Read these labels carefully.
If a label comes off or becomes hardto read (except for the U.S.dashboard label which may beremoved by the owner), contact yourdealer for a replacement.
U.S. models
Canadian models
U.S. models only
U.S. models only
Safety Labels
56
RADIATOR CAP
DASHBOARD
SUN VISOR
SUN VISORS
12/08/09 16:06:35 31SJC670_063
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
U.S. models U.S. models Canadian modelsCanadian models
Safety Labels
57
PICKUP BEDDOORJAMBS
12/08/09 16:06:52 31SJC670_064
2013 Ridgeline
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
58
12/08/09 16:06:54 31SJC670_065
2013 Ridgeline
This section gives information aboutthe controls and displays thatcontribute to the daily operation ofyour vehicle. All the essentialcontrols are within easy reach.
...........................Control Locations . 60............................Instrument Panel . 61
..........Instrument Panel Indicators . 62.............................................Gauges . 76
..............Multi-Information Display .82Controls Near the Steering
...........................................Wheel . 93........................Multi-Control Lever . 94
........................................Headlights . 95...............Headlight Control Dial . 95
........................................Fog Lights . 97........Instrument Panel Brightness . 98
.................Hazard Warning Button . 99..........Steering Wheel Adjustment . 99
................................................Keys . 100......................Immobilizer System . 101
..............................Ignition Switch . 102....................................Door Locks . 103
............Childproof Door Locks . 104Auto Door Locking/
..............................Unlocking . 104.....................Remote Transmitter . 110.....................Dual-Action Tailgate . 113
...............................In-Bed Trunk . 116...............................................Seats . 119
..................................Seat Heaters . 126
............................Power Windows . 128.......................................Moonroof . 131
...............................Parking Brake . 132...........................................Mirrors . 133
.........Interior Convenience Items . 135.........................Center Console . 136
.......Console Compartments . 136.........................Cargo Hooks . 137
.....................Beverage Holders . 137..................................Glove Box . 138................................Coat Hooks . 138
....................Sunglasses Holder . 138........Accessory Power Sockets . 139
...................................Sun Visor . 140............................Vanity Mirror . 140
........................AC Power Outlet .141...............................Interior Lights . 142
.....................................Bed Lights . 144
Instruments and Controls
59
12/08/09 16:06:58 31SJC670_066
2013 Ridgeline
*
*
*
: If equipped
Control Locations
60
Vehicle with navigation system is shown.
(P.103)
POWER DOOR LOCKMASTER SWITCH
MIRROR CONTROLS
ACCESSORY POWER SOCKETS
(P.134)
(P.139)
(P.132)
PARKING BRAKERELEASE HANDLE
INSTRUMENT PANEL INDICATORSGAUGES (P.76)
(P.62)
POWER WINDOWSWITCHES(P.128)
PARKING BRAKE PEDAL(P.132) (P.136)
CENTER CONSOLE
HOOD RELEASE HANDLE
FUEL FILL DOOR RELEASEHANDLE
AUXILIARY INPUT JACK(P.205)
AUDIO SYSTEM
HEATING/COOLINGCONTROLSCLIMATE CONTROLSYSTEM
GLOVE BOX(P.138)
(P.146)
(P.152)
(P.159)
(P.250)
(P.246)
REARVIEW MIRROR WITH REARVIEW CAMERA DISPLAY (P.240)
12/09/07 16:42:53 31SJC670_067
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
***
*
*
**
*
On models without navigation system.On models with navigation system.
The U.S. instrument panel is shown. Differences for the Canadian models are noted in the text.1 :2 :3 : On RTS, RTL, and Touring models.
Instrument Panel
Instruments
andC
ontrols
61
CRUISE CONTROLINDICATOR
(P.72)
(P.70)
(P.75)
(P.65)
(P.63)
(P.63)
(P.63)
(P.69)
(P.75)
(P.82)/INFORMATIONDISPLAY
MULTI-INFORMATIONDISPLAY
(P.77)
(P.67)
(P.62)
SIDE AIRBAG OFF INDICATOR
(P.74)
(P.67)
(P.66)
SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR (P.68)
HIGH BEAMINDICATOR
(P.73)
(P.68)
ANTI-LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM(ABS) INDICATOR
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHTSINDICATOR
WASHER LEVEL INDICATOR(P.67)
SEAT BELT REMINDERINDICATOR
LOW FUEL INDICATOR
(P.71)
(P.69)
DOOR AND TAILGATE OPEN INDICATOR
IN-BED TRUNK OPEN INDICATOR
A/T TEMPERATURE INDICATOR
BED LIGHTS ON INDICATOR(P.74)
MALFUNCTION INDICATORLAMP
LOW OIL PRESSUREINDICATOR
CHARGING SYSTEMINDICATOR
PARKING BRAKE AND BRAKESYSTEM INDICATOR
BACK WINDOW OPENINDICATOR
VTM-4 INDICATOR
LOW TIRE PRESSURE INDICATOR/TPMS INDICATOR
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM(TPMS) INDICATOR
LIGHTS ON INDICATOR
(P.75)
VEHICLE STABILITY ASSIST (VSA)SYSTEM INDICATOR (P.70)
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEMINDICATOR (P.66)
MESSAGE INDICATOR
(P.64)CRUISE MAININDICATOR(P.67)
(P.67)
MAINTENANCE MINDER INDICATOR
VSA OFF INDICATOR (P.71)
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINTSYSTEM (SRS) INDICATOR(P.64)
2
1
32
1
12/08/09 16:07:15 31SJC670_068
2013 Ridgeline
The instrument panel has manyindicators to give you importantinformation about your vehicle. This indicator comes on when you
turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position. It reminds you and yourpassengers to fasten your seat belts.A beeper also sounds if you have notfastened your seat belt.
If you turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position before fasteningyour seat belts, the beeper sounds,and the indicator flashes. If you donot fasten your seat belts before thebeeper stops, the indicator stopsflashing but remains on.
If your front passenger does notfasten their seat belt, the indicatorcomes on about 6 seconds after theignition switch is turned to the ON(II) position.
If either of you do not fasten yourseat belt while driving, the beeperwill sound and the indicator will flashagain at regular intervals. For moreinformation, see page .
You will also see a ‘‘FASTEN SEATBELT’’ or ‘‘FASTEN PASSENGERSEAT BELT’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
For more information, see page .20
20
90
On models with navigation system
Seat Belt Reminder Indicator
Instrument Panel Indicators
62
12/08/09 16:07:23 31SJC670_069
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
If this indicator comes on when theengine is running, the battery is notbeing charged. For more information,see page .
The engine can be severely damagedif this indicator flashes or stays onwhen the engine is running. Formore information, see page .
For more information, see page .
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKEMISSION SYSTEM’’ message onthe multi-information display (seepage ). For more information, seepage . You will also see a ‘‘CHECK
CHARGING SYSTEM’’ message onthe multi-information display (seepage ).
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKENGINE OIL LEVEL’’ message onthe multi-information display (seepage ).
90
91 90
373
373
372 372On models with navigation system
On models with navigation system On models with navigation system
Malfunction ChargingLow Oil
Instrument Panel Indicators
63
12/08/09 16:07:31 31SJC670_070
2013 Ridgeline
Indicator Lamp Pressure Indicator System Indicator
Instruments
andC
ontrols
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKAIRBAG SYSTEM’’ message on themulti-information display (see page ).
You will also see a ‘‘PASSENGERSIDE AIRBAG OFF’’ message on themulti-information display (see page ).
This indicator comes on for severalseconds when you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position. If itcomes on at any other time, itindicates that the passenger’s sideairbag has automatically shut off.For more information, see page .
This indicator comes on for severalseconds when you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position. If itcomes on at any other time, itindicates a potential problem withyour front airbags. This indicator willalso alert you to a potential problemwith your airbag system components.For more information, see page .
90
31
90
30
On models with navigation system
On models with navigation system
Side Airbag OffIndicator
Supplemental RestraintSystem (SRS) Indicator
Instrument Panel Indicators
64
U.S. Canada
12/08/09 16:07:39 31SJC670_071
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
This indicator has two functions:
It comes on when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. It is a reminder to checkthe parking brake. A beepersounds if you drive with theparking brake not fully released.Driving with the parking brake notfully released can damage thebrakes and tires.
You will also see a ‘‘RELEASEPARKING BRAKE’’ message on themulti-information display (see page ).
If it stays on after you have fullyreleased the parking brake whilethe engine is running, or if itcomes on while driving, therecould be a problem with the brakesystem. For more information, seepage .
You will also see a ‘‘BRAKE FLUIDLOW’’ or ‘‘CHECK BRAKESYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
1.
2.
90
90
374
On models with navigation system
On models with navigation system
Parking Brakeand BrakeSystemIndicator
Instrument Panel Indicators
65
U.S. Canada
12/08/09 16:07:45 31SJC670_072
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
This indicator comes on for a fewseconds when you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position. It willgo off if you have inserted a properlycoded ignition key. If it is not aproperly coded key, the indicator willblink and the engine will not start(see page ).
This indicator also blinks severaltimes when you turn the ignitionswitch from the ON (II) position tothe ACCESSORY (I) or LOCK (0)position.
The left or right turn signal indicatorblinks when you signal a lane changeor turn. If an indicator does not blinkor blinks rapidly, it usually meansone of the turn signal bulbs isburned out (see pages and ).Replace the bulb as soon as possible,since other drivers cannot see thatyou are signaling.
When you press the hazard warningbutton, both turn signal indicatorsand all turn signals on the outside ofthe vehicle flash.
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. If it comes on at any othertime, there is a problem with theABS. If this happens, have yourvehicle checked at a dealer. Withthis indicator on, your vehicle stillhas normal braking ability but noanti-lock function. For moreinformation, see page .
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK ABSSYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
101335 337
287
91
On models with navigation system
Anti-lock Brake System(ABS) Indicator
Immobilizer Turn Signal andHazard WarningIndicators
Instrument Panel Indicators
66
12/08/09 16:07:53 31SJC670_073
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
System Indicator
This indicator comes on with thehigh beam headlights. For moreinformation, see page .
If this indicator comes on when theignition switch is turned to the ON(II) position and the parking brake isreleased, it means there is a problemwith a circuit. Have your vehiclechecked by your dealer.
If you see a ‘‘CHECK DRLSYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display, there is aproblem with the daytime runninglight circuit. Take your vehicle to adealer to have it checked.
This indicator comes on when thewasher fluid level is low. Add washerfluid when you see this indicator(see page ).
This indicator comes on when youset the cruise control. See page
for information on operating thecruise control.
This indicator comes on when youturn on the cruise control system bypressing the CRUISE button (seepage ).
You will see a ‘‘WASHER FLUIDLOW’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
95
91
210
210
328
On models with navigation system
On models with navigation system
High Beam Indicator Washer Level Indicator
Cruise Control Indicator
Cruise Main Indicator
Daytime RunningLights Indicator
Instrument Panel Indicators
67
12/08/09 16:08:04 31SJC670_074
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
This indicator comes on as areminder that you must refuel soon.
When the indicator comes on, thereare about 3.3 U.S. gal (12.5 ) of fuelremaining in the tank.
When the needle reaches E, thereis a very small amount offuel in the tank.
You will also see a ‘‘FUEL LOW’’message on the multi-informationdisplay.
This indicator comes on when thesecurity system is set. See page
for more information on thesecurity system.208
On models with navigation systemOn RTS, RTL, and Touring models
Low Fuel Indicator Security System Indicator
Instrument Panel Indicators
68
LOW FUEL INDICATOR
SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR
12/08/09 16:08:12 31SJC670_075
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
This indicator monitors thetemperature of the automatictransmission fluid. It should come onfor a few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. If it comes on while driving,it means the transmission fluidtemperature is too high. Pull to theside of the road when it is safe, shiftto Park, and let the engine idle untilthe indicator goes out.
This indicator reminds you that theexterior lights are on. It comes onwhen you turn the headlight controldial to either the or
position.
If you turn the ignition switch to theACCESSORY (I) or LOCK (0)position without turning off theheadlight control dial, this indicatorremains on. A reminder chime willalso sound when you open thedriver’s door.
You will also see an ‘‘A/T TEMPHIGH’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).91
On models with navigation system
Lights On IndicatorA/T TemperatureIndicator
Instrument Panel Indicators
69
Continuing to drive with the A/Ttemperature indicator on may causeserious damage to the transmission.
12/08/09 16:08:18 31SJC670_076
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
This indicator normallycomes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK VSASYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).This indicator normally comes on for
a few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. If it comes on at any othertime, there is a problem in the 4WDsystem. Take the vehicle to yourdealer to have it checked.
If the indicator blinks while driving,the VTM-4 fluid temperature is toohigh. Pull to the side of the roadwhen it is safe, shift to Park, and letthe engine idle until the indicatorgoes out.
This indicator has two functions:
It flashes when VSA is active (seepage ).
If it comes on and stays on at anyother time, there is a problem withthe VSA system. Take your vehicleto a dealer to have it checked.Without VSA, your vehiclestill has normal driving ability, butwill not have VSAtraction and stability enhancement.For more information, see page .
91
1.
2.
289
288
On models with navigation system
Instrument Panel Indicators
Vehicle Stability Assist(VSA) System IndicatorVTM-4 Indicator
70
Continuing to drive with the VTM-4indicator blinking may cause seriousdamage to the system.
12/08/09 16:08:27 31SJC670_077
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
This indicator comes on for a fewseconds when you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position. Itreminds you that it is time to takeyour vehicle in for scheduledmaintenance. The maintenance mainitems and sub items will be displayedin the information display. See page
for more information on theMaintenance Minder .
This indicator goes off when yourdealer resets it after completing therequired maintenance service.
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. For more information, seepage .
It comes on as a reminder that youhave turned off the vehicle stabilityassist (VSA) system. 289
311
Maintenance MinderIndicatorVSA OFF Indicator
Instrument Panel Indicators
71
TM
12/08/09 16:08:35 31SJC670_078
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
If it comes on while driving, itindicates that one or more of yourvehicle’s tires are significantly lowon pressure.
This indicator normally comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position.
If this happens, pull to the side of theroad when it is safe, check which tirehas lost pressure on the tire pressuremonitor, and determine the cause. Ifit is because of a flat tire, replace theflat tire with the compact spare (seepage ), and have the flat tirerepaired as soon as possible. If twoor more tires are underinflated, call aprofessional towing service (seepage ). Refer to page formore information.
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position.This indicator has two functions:
Check the tire pressure monitoron the multi-information displayand determine the cause (see page ).
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK TIREPRESSURE’’ message on themulti-information display (seepage ).
If it comes on while driving, itindicates that one or more of yourvehicle’s tires are significantly lowon pressure.
1.
91
359
381 276
280
On models without navigation system On models with navigation system
Low Tire PressureIndicator
Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator
Instrument Panel Indicators
72
12/08/09 16:08:44 31SJC670_079
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
This indicator normally comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position.
If this happens, pull to the side of theroad when it is safe, check which tirehas lost pressure on the multi-information display, and determinethe cause. If it is because of a flat tire,have the flat tire repaired as soon aspossible. If two or more tires areunderinflated, call a professionaltowing service. For moreinformation, see page .
If this indicator begins to flash,there is a problem with the tirepressure monitoring system(TPMS). You will also see a‘‘CHECK TPMS SYSTEM’’message on the multi-informationdisplay. The indicator continues toflash for a while (approximately 1minute), then stays on. If thishappens, have your dealer checkthe system as soon as possible.For more information, see page .
If this indicator comes on and stayson at any other time, or if it does notcome on when you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position, thereis a problem with the TPMS. Withthis indicator on, the low tirepressure indicator will not come onwhen a tire loses pressure. Take thevehicle to your dealer to have thesystem checked. For moreinformation, see page .
2.
381
282
277
On models without navigation system
Tire Pressure MonitoringSystem (TPMS) Indicator
Instrument Panel Indicators
73
12/08/09 16:08:51 31SJC670_080
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
This indicator reminds you that thebed lights are on. With the shift leverin the Park position, they come onwhen you push the light switch onthe dashboard, swing open thetailgate, or open the In-Bed Trunk.
If you turn the ignition switch to theACCESSORY (I) or LOCK (0)position without turning off the bedlights, this indicator will remain on,and then go off after 20 minutes. Seepage for more information.
Most of the time, this indicatorcomes on along with other indicatorsin the instrument panel such as theseat belt reminder indicator, SRSindicator, VSA system indicator, etc.
This indicator comes on when thereis a system message on the multi-information display. Press the INFObutton on the dashboard (see page82 ) to see the message (see page 90 ).
144
On models with navigation system
Bed Lights On IndicatorMessage Indicator
Instrument Panel Indicators
74
12/08/09 16:08:57 31SJC670_081
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
This indicator reminds you that theback window is not completelyclosed when you turn the ignitionswitch from the ON (II) position tothe ACCESSORY (I) or LOCK (0)position. With the ignition switch inthe ACCESSORY (I) position, it goesoff after about 30 seconds. With theignition switch in the LOCK (0)position, it goes off after about 3minutes.
If you remove the ignition key, turnoff the lights, and open the driver’sdoor without closing the backwindow, you will hear five beeps andsee the indicator blink. If you do notclose the back window before thebeeper stops, the indicator stopsblinking but remains on. It will go offafter about 3 minutes. See page
for more information.
This indicator reminds you that theIn-Bed Trunk is open. If you do notclose it, the indicator stays on forabout 3 minutes. See page formore information.
This indicator comes on if any dooror the tailgate is not closed tightly.
116
129
Back Window Open Indicator
In-Bed Trunk Open Indicator
Door and Tailgate
Instrument Panel Indicators
75
12/08/09 16:09:04 31SJC670_082
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
Open Indicator
▲
▼
This shows the temperature of theengine’s coolant. During normaloperation, the pointer should rise toabout the middle of the gauge. Insevere driving conditions, the pointermay rise to the upper zone. If itreaches the red (hot) mark, pullsafely to the side of the road. Forinstructions and precautions onchecking the engine’s coolingsystem, see page .
This shows how much fuel youhave. It may show slightly moreor less than the actual amount.
370
Gauges
Temperature Gauge
Fuel Gauge
76
U.S. model is shown.
On models with navigation system
SPEEDOMETERTACHOMETER TEMPERATURE GAUGE
SPEEDOMETERTACHOMETER TEMPERATURE GAUGE
On models without navigation system
FUEL GAUGE
FUEL GAUGEINFORMATION DISPLAY
MULTI-INFORMATION DISPLAY
INFO ( ) BUTTON
INFO ( ) BUTTON
TRIP/RESETBUTTON
SELECTBUTTON
SEL/RESETBUTTON Avoid driving with an extremely low
f uel level. Running out of f uel couldcause the engine to misf ire, damagingthe catalytic converter.
12/08/09 16:09:15 31SJC670_083
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
With the ignition switch in the ON(II) position, the information displaychanges as shown on the next pageeach time you press the SELECTbutton or TRIP/RESET button.
The information display shows theodometer, trip meter, engine oil life,outside temperature (if equipped),instant fuel economy, average fueleconomy, range (estimated distance),and maintenance item code(s).
For information about the multi-information display, see page .
When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, your lastselection is displayed.
82
CONTINUED
On models without navigation systemOn models with navigation system
Gauges
Information Display
77
TRIP/RESET BUTTON
SELECT BUTTON
12/08/09 16:09:21 31SJC670_084
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
Gauges
78
U.S. model is shown.
INFORMATION DISPLAY OUTSIDE TEMPERATURE INDICATOR
ODOMETERODOMETER
RANGE
ENGINE OIL LIFE
TRIP METER A
TRIP METER B
RANGE
TRIP METER B
TRIP METER A
TRIP METER A
AVERAGE FUELECONOMY A
AVERAGE FUELECONOMY B
INSTANT FUELECONOMY
INSTANT FUELECONOMY
TRIP/RESET button
SELECT button
TRIP METER B
12/08/09 16:09:27 31SJC670_085
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
± ±
- -- - -- - -
The odometer shows the totaldistance your vehicle has beendriven. It measures miles in U.S.models and kilometers in Canadianmodels. It is illegal under U.S.federal law and Canadian provincial/territorial regulations to disconnect,reset, or alter the odometer with theintent to change the number of milesor kilometers indicated.
Both trip meters will reset if thevehicle’s battery goes dead or isdisconnected.
In certain weather conditions,temperature readings near freezing
(32°F, 0°C) could mean that ice isforming on the road surface.
The temperature sensor is in thefront bumper. The temperaturereading can be affected by heatreflection from the road surface,engine heat, and the exhaust fromsurrounding traffic. This can causean incorrect temperature readingwhen your vehicle speed is under19 mph (30 km/h). When you startyour trip, the sensor is not fullyacclimatized, therefore it may takeseveral minutes until the propertemperature is displayed.
This shows the outside temperaturein Fahrenheit (U.S. models), or inCelsius (Canadian models).
If the outside temperature isincorrectly displayed, you can adjustit up to 5°F in U.S. models ( 3°Cin Canadian models) warmer orcooler.
The temperature must bestabilized before doing thisprocedure.
To adjust the outside temperatureindicator, press and hold the TRIP/RESET button for 10 seconds. Thefollowing sequence will appear for 1second each: 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 5, 4,
3, 2, 1, 0 (U.S.) or 0, 1, 2, 3,3, 2, 1, 0 (Canada).
When the temperature reaches thedesired value, release the TRIP/RESET button. You should see thenew outside temperature displayed.
Each trip meter works independently,so you can keep track of twodifferent distances. To reset a tripmeter, display it, and then press andhold the TRIP/RESET button untilthe number resets to ‘‘0.0’’.
There are two trip meters: Trip Aand Trip B. Switch between thesedisplays by pressing the TRIP/RESET button repeatedly.
This meter shows the number ofmiles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada)driven since you last reset it.
CONTINUED
Except RT and U.S. Sport models
Odometer
Outside Temperature Indicator
Trip Meter
Gauges
79
NOTE:
12/08/09 16:09:38 31SJC670_086
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
This display shows the estimateddistance you can travel on the fuelremaining in the tank.
This distance is estimated from thefuel economy you have achievedover the last few miles (kilometers),so it will vary with changes in speed,traffic condition, etc.
This display shows the instant fueleconomy you are getting.
It shows the number of mpg (U.S.)or l/100 km (Canada).
When either of the trip meters (tripA or B) is displayed, your vehicle’saverage fuel economy since you lastreset that trip meter can be shownon the information display (mpg onU.S. models and l/100 km onCanadian models). This number isupdated once per 10 seconds. To seethe average fuel economy, press andrelease the TRIP/RESET buttonrepeatedly.
The average fuel economy will bereset when you reset the trip meter,or if the vehicle’s battery goes deador is disconnected.This indicator is displayed as the
system message on the multi-information display (see page ).
The appropriate tire indicator willcome on along with the low tirepressure indicator if a tire issignificantly underinflated or hassuddenly lost pressure. See
for what todo if this indicator comes on.
280
On models with navigation system
Gauges
Range (Estimated Distance)Tire Pressure Monitor
Average Fuel Economy
Instant Fuel Economy
LowTire Pressure Indicator
80
TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR
12/08/09 16:09:48 31SJC670_087
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
The information display in theinstrument panel shows you theengine oil life and maintenanceservice items when the ignitionswitch is in the ON (II) position. Thisinformation helps to keep you awareof the periodic maintenance yourvehicle needs for continued trouble-free driving. Refer to page formore information.
Your vehicle’s onboard diagnosticsystem will detect a loose or missingfuel fill cap as an evaporative systemleak. The first time a leak is detecteda ‘‘CHECK FUEL CAP’’ messageappears on the information display.
If the system still detects a leak inyour vehicle’s evaporative emissionssystem, the malfunction indicatorlamp (MIL) comes on. If the fuel fillcap was not already tightened, turnthe engine off, and check orretighten the fuel fill cap until itclicks at least once. The MIL shouldgo off after several days of normaldriving once the cap is tightened orreplaced. If the MIL does not go off,have your vehicle inspected by adealer. For more information, seepage .
Turn the engine off, and confirm thefuel fill cap is installed. If it is, loosenit, then retighten it until it clicks atleast once. The message should gooff after several days of normaldriving once you tighten or replacethe fuel fill cap. To scroll to anotherdisplay, press the SELECT button orTRIP/RESET button.
The ‘‘CHECK FUEL CAP’’ messagewill appear each time you restart theengine until the system turns themessage off.
311
373
Maintenance Minder Check Fuel Cap Message
Gauges
81
TM
12/08/09 16:09:54 31SJC670_088
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
▲
▼
With the ignition switch in the ON(II) position, the multi-informationdisplay changes as shown on thenext page each time you press theINFO ( / ) button or the SEL/RESET button.
When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, your lastselection is displayed.
The multi-information display in theinstrument panel displays variousinformation and messages when theignition switch is in the ON (II)position. Some of the messages helpyou operate your vehicle morecomfortably. Others help to keepyou aware of the periodicmaintenance your vehicle needs forcontinued trouble-free driving.
To change the display, press theINFO ( / ) button on thedashboard repeatedly until the mainmenu appears (see page ).
When you open the driver’s door, a‘‘Welcome’’ message is shown on themulti-information display.
In the multi-information display, thesystem message is also displayed(see page ).
83
90
On models with navigation system
Multi-Information Display
82
SEL/RESETBUTTON
INFO ( ) BUTTON
INFO ( ) BUTTON
12/08/09 16:10:01 31SJC670_089
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
▲ ▼
Multi-Information Display
83
INFO ( / ) button
SEL/RESET buttonU.S. model is shown.
Trip Computer (See page 87)
(See page 84)
Tire Pressure for each tire (See page 86)
Go to Language Selection Menu (See page 92)
Go to HandsFreeLink Menu (See page 86)
12/08/09 16:10:06 31SJC670_090
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
The odometer shows the totaldistance your vehicle has beendriven. It measures miles in U.S.models and kilometers in Canadianmodels. It is illegal under U.S.federal law and Canadian provincial/territorial regulations to disconnect,reset, or alter the odometer with theintent to change the number of milesor kilometers indicated.
This meter shows the number ofmiles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada)driven since you last reset it. Thereare two trip meters: Trip A and TripB. Each trip meter worksindependently, so you can keep trackof two different distances.
To reset a trip meter, display it, andthen press and hold the SEL/RESET button until the numberresets to ‘‘0.0.’’
When you reset Trip A, AVERAGEFUEL A, AVERAGE SPEED A, andELAPSED TIME A are reset at thesame time. When you reset Trip B,AVERAGE FUEL B, AVERAGESPEED B, and ELAPSED TIME Bare reset.
Multi-Information Display
Odometer Trip Meter
84
TRIP METERODOMETER
U.S. model is shown.U.S. model is shown.
12/08/09 16:10:12 31SJC670_091
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
± ±
- -- - -- - -
If the outside temperature isincorrectly displayed, you can adjustit up to 5°F in U.S. models ( 3°Cin Canadian models) warmer orcooler.
The temperature must bestabilized before doing thisprocedure.
To adjust the outside temperatureindicator, press and hold the SEL/RESET button for 10 seconds. Thefollowing sequence will appear for 1second each: 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 5, 4,
3, 2, 1, 0 (U.S.) or 0, 1, 2, 3,3, 2, 1, 0 (Canada).
When the temperature reaches thedesired value, release the SEL/RESET button. You should see thenew outside temperature displayed.
The temperature sensor is in thefront bumper. The temperaturereading can be affected by heatreflection from the road surface,engine heat, and the exhaust fromsurrounding traffic. This can causean incorrect temperature readingwhen your vehicle speed is under19 mph (30 km/h). When you startyour trip, the sensor is not fullyacclimatized, therefore it may takeseveral minutes until the propertemperature is displayed.
In certain weather conditions,temperature readings near freezing(32°F, 0°C) could mean that ice isforming on the road surface.
This shows the outside temperaturein Fahrenheit (U.S. models), or inCelsius (Canadian models).
Outside Temperature
Multi-Information Display
85
NOTE:
OUTSIDE TEMPERATURE
U.S. model is shown.
12/08/09 16:10:20 31SJC670_092
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
This shows the remaining life of theengine oil. It shows 100% after theengine oil is replaced and the displayis reset. The engine oil life iscalculated based on engine operatingconditions and accumulated enginerevolutions. For more information,see page .
When the tire pressure monitor isshown on the multi-information display, press the SEL/RESETbutton. The display changes as shown.You can see the pressure of each tirein this monitor. If one or more tiresare low, inflate them to the correctpressure. For more information, seepage .
You can receive or make phone callsfrom your cell phone through yourvehicle’s HandsFreeLink(HFL) system without touching yourcell phone.
311
280
Bluetooth
Engine Oil Life Tire Pressure Monitor HandsFreeLinkBluetooth
Multi-Information Display
86
ENGINE OIL LIFE
U.S.
Canada
12/08/09 16:10:28 31SJC670_093
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
▲ ▼
To use the system, your cell phoneand the HFL system must be linked.Not all cell phones are compatiblewith this system. Refer to page
for instructions on how to linkyour cell phone to HFL and how toreceive or make phone calls, or visitthe handsfreelink.com website. InCanada, visit , orcall (888) 528-7876.
217
www.handsfreelink.ca
CONTINUED
Multi-Information Display
Trip Computer
87
Average Fuel Economy/Range
Average Vehicle Speed/Elapsed Time
SEL/RESET button
INFO ( / ) button
U.S. model is shown.
Instant Fuel Economy
12/08/09 16:10:34 31SJC670_094
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
This shows the accumulatedtraveling time since you last reset it.When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, ELAPSEDTIME is reset.
This shows your vehicle’s averagefuel economy in mpg (U.S. models)or liter/100 km (Canadian models)since you last reset Trip A or Trip B.
This shows the estimated distanceyou can travel on the fuel remainingin the fuel tank. This distance isestimated from the fuel economyyou received over the last severalmiles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada),so it will vary with changes in speed,traffic, etc.
This shows the average speed youare traveling in miles per hour (mph)for U.S. models or kilometers perhour (km/h) for Canadian models.
Along with the trip meter, the tripcomputer calculates these values:
Average Fuel EconomyRangeAverage Vehicle SpeedElapsed Time
This shows your instant fueleconomy.
Instant Fuel Economy
ELAPSED TIME A/BAVERAGE FUEL A/B
RANGE
AVERAGE SPEED A/B
INSTANT FUEL MPG (U.S. models)/INSTANT FUELL/100 km (Canadian models)
Multi-Information Display
88
12/08/09 16:10:45 31SJC670_095
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
If there is a problem with yourvehicle, for example the engine oillevel is low or a door is not fullyclosed, the multi-information displaywill show you the problem. It doesthis by interrupting the currentdisplay with one or more messages.
The system message(s) triggers theappropriate indicator(s) on theinstrument panel, including thesystem message indicator, to comeon. The system message indicatordoes not go off until the problem(s)is corrected.
You will also hear a beep when thesystem message comes on for thefirst time.
When there are several messages tobe shown, the system switches themessages every 5 seconds.The message is shown until youpush the INFO ( or ) button.To see the message again, press theINFO ( or ) button, 5 secondsafter the display disappears.
Here is a list of messages shown onthe multi-information display:
CONTINUED
System Messages
Multi-Information Display
89
SYSTEM MESSAGE INDICATOR
12/08/09 16:10:52 31SJC670_096
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
See page11
See page20
See page20
See page30
See page31
See page132
See page374
See page374
See page372
See page373
Multi-Information Display
90
U.S.
Canada
U.S.
Canada
U.S.
Canada
U.S.
Canada
12/08/09 16:11:03 31SJC670_097
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
See page69
See page68
See page97
See page372
See page287
See page288
See page269
See page328
See page315
See page281
See page282
See page247
Multi-Information Display
91
12/08/09 16:11:13 31SJC670_098
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
▲ ▼
Press the SEL/RESET button to seethe selections.There are three language selections
you can make: English, Spanish, andFrench. To choose the language youwant, follow these instructions:
Select the desired language bypressing the SEL/RESET button,then enter your selection by pressingand holding the SEL/RESET button.
When your selection is successfullycompleted, the display returns to the‘‘LANGUAGE SELECTION’’ display.
Press and release the INFO ( / )button repeatedly to select the‘‘LANGUAGE SELECTION’’ display.
Multi-Information Display
Language Selection
92
12/08/09 16:11:20 31SJC670_099
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
*
*
*
***
*
*
*
*
*
*
▲
▼
*****
Only on vehicles equipped with navigation system. Refer to the navigation system manual.
To use the horn, press the center pad of the steering wheel.If equipped
On models with navigation system.On models without navigation system.
1 :2 :3 :4 :5 :
Controls Near the Steering Wheel
93
MOONROOF SWITCH
REMOTE AUDIO CONTROLS
HEADLIGHT CONTROL DIAL
STEERING WHEELADJUSTMENT
SEL/RESET BUTTON
INFO ( ) BUTTONSELECT BUTTONTRIP/RESET BUTTON
Vehicle with navigation system is shown.
CRUISE CONTROLS
HAZARD WARNING BUTTON
MULTI-CONTROL LEVER(WINDSHIELD WIPERS/WASHERS/TURN SIGNALS/HEADLIGHT HIGH BEAMS)
(P.131)
(P.94)
(P.95)
FOG LIGHTS
(P.99)
(P.76)
(P.76)
(P.76)
(P.76)(P.76)
(P.203)
INSTRUMENT PANELBRIGHTNESS (P.98)
SHIFT LEVER
VTM-4 LOCK
BED LIGHT SWITCH (P.144)
(P.97)
(P.210)
(P.142)
SEAT HEATERS
INTERIOR LIGHT CONTROLSWITCH
(P.126)HORN
(P.99)VOICE CONTROL BUTTONS
INFO ( ) BUTTON
BLUETOOTHHANDSFREELINKSYSTEM VOICE CONTROLBUTTONS
VEHICLE STABILITY ASSIST (VSA)OFF SWITCH
(P.269)
(P.274)
(P.290)
(P.217)
2
2
4
4
55
2
2
1
3
4
4
12/08/09 16:11:31 31SJC670_100
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
-
-
OFFINT: IntermittentINT TIME ringLO: Low speedHI: High speedMISTWindshield washersTurn signalHigh beamsFlash high beams
The multi-control lever has manyfunctions, including windshieldwipers and washers, turn signals,headlight high beams, and headlighthigh beam flashing.
To select a position, turn the rotaryswitch, push the button on the end ofthe lever, or push the lever up, down,forward, or backward.
The wipers are not activated.
The wipers run at low speed.
The wipers run at high speed.
The length of the wiperinterval is varied automaticallyaccording to the vehicle’s speed.
Vary the delay by turning the INTTIME ring. If you turn it to theshortest delay, the wipers changeto low speed when the vehiclespeed exceeds 12 mph (20 km/h).
The wipers run at high speeduntil you release the lever.
Push thebutton on the end of the multi-control lever. The washers sprayuntil you release the button. Thewipers run at low speed, thencomplete one more sweep afteryou release the button.1.
2.3.4.5.6.7.8.9.
10.
OFF:
LO
HI
INT:
MIST:
Windshield Washer:
Multi-Control Lever
94
12/08/09 16:11:40 31SJC670_101
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
-
-
OFFParking and indicator lightsHeadlights
Push down on themulti-control lever to signal a leftturn and up to signal a right turn. Tosignal a lane change, push lightly onthe lever and hold it. The lever willreturn to center when you release itor complete a turn.
To turn on the highbeams, push the multi-control leverforward until you hear a click. Theblue high beam indicator will comeon (see page ). Pull the lever backto return to the low beams.
To flash the high beams, pull thelever back lightly, then release it.The high beams will stay on as longas you hold the lever back.
Your vehicle has heating wires at thebottom of the windshield to helpheat the wiper blades and thewindshield. If the outsidetemperature is near freezing, theheater turns on automatically whenyou turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position. The heater turnsoff automatically when the outsidetemperature is above freezing.
This function helps to increase wiperperformance when the wiper armssit in the parked position in snowy oricy conditions.
1.2.3.
67
CONTINUED
Headlight Control DialTurn Signal
High Beams
Automatic Heated Wiper Zone
Multi-Control Lever, Headlights
95
12/08/09 16:11:48 31SJC670_102
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
- If you remove the key from theignition switch with the headlightcontrol dial on, but do not open thedoor, the lights will turn off after 10minutes.
Turning the dial tothe ‘‘ ’’ position turns on theparking lights, taillights, instrumentpanel lights, and license plate lights.
Turning the dial to the ‘‘ ’’position turns on the headlights. Ifyou leave the lights on and removethe key from the ignition switch, youwill hear a reminder chime when youopen the driver’s door.
When the dial is in the ‘‘ ’’ or‘‘ ’’ position, the lights onindicator comes on as a reminder.This indicator stays on if you leavethe lights on and turn the ignitionswitch to the ACCESSORY (I) orLOCK (0) position.
The automatic lighting off featureturns off the headlights, all otherexterior lights, and the instrumentpanel lights within 15 seconds ofremoving the key from the ignitionswitch and closing the driver’s door. The lights will turn on again when
you unlock or open the driver’s door. If you unlock the door, butThis feature activates if you leave
the headlight control dial in the‘‘ ’’ or ‘‘ ’’ position, removethe key, then open and close thedriver’s door.
do not open it within 15 seconds,the lights go off. With thedriver’s door open, you will hear alights-on reminder chime.
Automatic Lighting Off FeatureHeadlights
Headlights
96
12/08/09 16:11:56 31SJC670_103
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
With the headlight control dial off,the daytime running lights come onwhen you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position and release theparking brake. They remain on untilyou turn the ignition switch off, evenif you set the parking brake.
The headlights revert to normaloperation when you turn them onwith the headlight control dial.
If you see a ‘‘CHECK DRLSYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display, there is aproblem with the daytime runninglight circuit. Take your vehicle to adealer to have it checked.
You can use the fog lights only whenthe headlights are on low beam.They will go off when you turn theheadlights off or onto high beam.
Turn the fog lights on and off bypressing the button. The indicator inthe button lights to show the foglights are on.
If equippedOn models with navigation systemDaytime Running Lights Fog Lights
Headlights, Fog Lights
97
12/08/09 16:12:02 31SJC670_104
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
The dial on the instrument panelcontrols the brightness of theinstrument panel lights and theconsole compartment light. Turn thedial to adjust the brightness.
The instrument panel will illuminatewhen you unlock and open thedriver’s door. The brightness willincrease when you insert the key inthe ignition switch.
If you do not insert the key in theignition switch after opening thedriver’s door, the illumination turnsoff about 30 seconds after you closethe door.
If you insert the key but do not turnthe ignition switch to the ON (II)position, the illumination turns off inabout 10 seconds.
The instrument panel brightness isdimmed when you turn the headlightcontrol dial to the ‘‘ ’’ or‘‘ ’’ position to reduce glare atnight. To cancel it, turn theinstrument panel brightness controldial upward fully until you hear
Instrument Panel Brightness
98
INSTRUMENT PANELBRIGHTNESS CONTROL DIAL
12/08/09 16:12:08 31SJC670_105
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
a click.
Push the lever up to lock thesteering wheel in position.
Make sure you have securelylocked the steering wheel in placeby trying to move it up and down.
Make any steering wheel adjustmentbefore you start driving.
Move the steering wheel so itpoints toward your chest, nottoward your face. Make sure youcan see the instrument panelgauges and indicators.
Push the lever on the left sideof the steering column all theway down.
Push the button to turn on thehazard warning lights (four-wayflashers). This causes all fouroutside turn signals and both turnindicators in the instrument panel toflash. Use the hazard warning lightsif you need to park in a dangerousarea near heavy traffic, or if yourvehicle is disabled.
3.
4.1.
2.
Steering Wheel AdjustmentHazard Warning Button
Hazard Warning Button, Steering Wheel Adjustment
99
Adjusting the steering wheelposition while driving maycause you to lose control of thevehicle and be seriously injuredin a crash.
Adjust the steering wheel onlywhen the vehicle is stopped.
12/08/09 16:12:17 31SJC670_106
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
These keys contain electroniccircuits that are activated by theimmobilizer system. They will notwork to start the engine if thecircuits are damaged.
Protect the keys from directsunlight, high temperature, andhigh humidity.
Do not drop the keys or set heavyobjects on them.
The master key fits all the locks onyour vehicle. The valet key worksonly in the ignition and the driver’sdoor lock. You can keep the glovebox locked when you leave yourvehicle and the valet key at aparking facility.
You can also keep the In-Bed Trunklocked by using the main switch inthe glove box (see page ).
You should have received a keynumber tag with your keys. You willneed this key number if you everhave to get a lost key replaced. Useonly Honda-approved key blanks.
Keep the keys away from liquids.If they get wet, dry themimmediately with a soft cloth.
The valet key does not contain abattery. Do not try to take it apart.
118
Keys
100
VALET KEY(LIGHT GRAY)
MASTER KEYWITH REMOTETRANSMITTER
KEYNUMBERTAG
12/08/09 16:12:24 31SJC670_107
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, the immobilizersystem indicator should come on fora few seconds, then go off. If theindicator starts to blink, it means thesystem does not recognize thecoding of the key. Turn the ignitionswitch to the LOCK (0) position,remove the key, reinsert it, and turnthe ignition switch to the ON (II)position again.
Do not attempt to alter this systemor add other devices to it. Electricalproblems could result that may makeyour vehicle inoperable.
If the system repeatedly does notrecognize the coding of your key,contact your dealer.
The immobilizer system protectsyour vehicle from theft. If animproperly coded key (or otherdevice) is used, the engine’s fuelsystem is disabled.
If you have lost your key and cannotstart the engine, contact your dealer.
The system may not recognize yourkey’s coding if another immobilizerkey or other metal object (i.e. keychain) is near the ignition switchwhen you insert the key.
This device complies with theappropriate requirements or therequired standards. See page formore information.
400
Immobilizer System
101
Always take the ignition key with youwhenever you leave the vehicle alone.
12/08/09 16:12:31 31SJC670_108
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
-
-
-
-
The ignition switch has fourpositions: LOCK (0), ACCESSORY(I), ON (II), and START (III).
You can insert orremove the key only in this position.To turn the key, the shift lever mustbe in Park, and you must push thekey in slightly.
If the front wheels are turned, theanti-theft lock may make it difficultto turn the key. Firmly turn thesteering wheel to the left or right asyou turn the key.
You canoperate the audio system and theaccessory power sockets in thisposition.
This is the normal keyposition when driving. Several of theindicators on the instrument panelcome on as a test when you turn theignition switch from theACCESSORY (I) to the ON (II)position.
Use this positiononly to start the engine. The switchreturns to the ON (II) position whenyou let go of the key.
You will hear a reminder beeper ifyou leave the key in the ignitionswitch in the LOCK (0) or theACCESSORY (I) position and openthe driver’s door. Remove the key toturn off the beeper.
The shift lever must be in Parkbefore you can remove the key fromthe ignition switch.
LOCK (0)
ACCESSORY (I)
ON (II)
START (III)
Ignition Switch
102
12/08/09 16:12:39 31SJC670_109
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
To lock any passenger’s door whengetting out of the vehicle, push thelock tab down, and close the door.To lock the driver’s door, remove thekey from the ignition switch, andpush the lock tab down, or push thefront of the master switch, thenclose the door.
With the driver’s door open and thekey in the ignition, both master doorlock switches will not lock, but theywill unlock. The lock feature is notdisabled if the driver’s door is closed.Pushing the front of the switch onthe open passenger’s door will lockall doors and the In-Bed Trunk.
The lock tab on each door locks andunlocks that door. Pulling up on thedriver’s door lock tab only unlocksthe driver’s door. To unlock thedriver’s door and the In-Bed Trunkfrom the outside, turn the key andrelease it. If you turn it again, all thedoors unlock.
You can open or close the sidewindows by using the key in thedriver’s door (see page ).
To lock all doors and the In-BedTrunk, push the front of the masterdoor lock switch on either front door,press the lock tab down on thedriver’s door, or use the key on theoutside lock on the driver’s door. This vehicle has auto door locking/
unlocking features. See page forhow to set them.Pushing the rear of either master
door lock switch will unlock all of thedoors and the In-Bed Trunk.
130
104
Lockout Prevention
Power Door Locks
Door Locks
103
MASTER DOOR LOCK SWITCH
LOCK TAB
12/08/09 16:12:47 31SJC670_110
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
The childproof door locks aredesigned to prevent children seatedin the rear from accidentally openingthe rear doors. Each rear door has alock lever near the edge. With thelever in the LOCK position, the doorcannot be opened from insideregardless of the position of the
The auto door locking feature hasthree possible settings:
The auto door locking isdeactivated all the time.
The doors lock whenever youmove the shift lever out of thePark (P) position.
The doors lock when the vehiclespeed reaches 10 mph (15 km/h).This is the default setting.
Your vehicle has customizablesettings for the doors toautomatically lock and unlock. Thereare default settings for each of thesefeatures. You can turn off or changethe settings for these features asdescribed on the following pages.When you customize the setting,make sure your vehicle is parkedsafely, the engine is off, and theparking brake is applied. Make allsettings before you start driving.
With the auto door locking andunlocking, the In-Bed Trunk alsolocks and unlocks.
Auto Door Locking/UnlockingChildproof Door Locks Auto Door Locking
Door Locks
104
LOCK LEVER
12/08/09 16:12:57 31SJC670_111
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
lock tab. To open the door, pull thelock tab up, and use the outsidedoor handle.
Locks all doors when the shift lever ismoved out of the Park (P) position.
Push and hold the front of themaster door lock switch on thedriver’s door until you hear a click(after about 5 seconds).
Make sure the shift lever is in thePark (P) position.
Turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position, and open thedriver’s door.
Make sure the shift lever is in thePark (P) position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position, and make sure toclose the driver’s door.
Release the switch, and within 5seconds, turn the ignition switchto the LOCK (0) position.
1.
2.
1.
2.
3.
4.
CONTINUED
Door Locks
To turn off the Auto DoorLock modes:
To program the Park Lock mode:
105
12/08/09 16:13:07 31SJC670_112
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
Push and hold the brake pedal,and move the shift lever out of thePark (P) position.
Push and hold the front of themaster door lock switch on thedriver’s door. You will hear aclick. Keep holding theswitch until you hear anotherclick (after about 5 seconds).
Push and hold the front of themaster door lock switch on thedriver’s door. You will hear aclick. Keep holding theswitch until you hear anotherclick (after about 5 seconds).
Turn the ignition switch to theLOCK (0) position.
Make sure the shift lever is in thePark (P) position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position, and make sure toclose the driver’s door.
Release the switch, and within 5seconds, turn the ignition switchto the LOCK (0) position.
Release the switch and, within 5seconds, turn the ignition switchto the ACCESSORY (I) position.Move the shift lever to the Park(P) position.
1.
2.
3.
5.
4.
6.
3.
4.
Locks all doors when the vehicle’s speedreaches about 10 mph (15 km/h).
To program the Drive Lock mode:
Door Locks
106
12/08/09 16:13:16 31SJC670_113
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
CONTINUED
Push and hold the rear of themaster door lock switch on thedriver’s door. You will hear a click,and after about 5 seconds, you willhear another click.
The auto door unlocking feature hasfive possible settings:
The driver’s door unlocks whenyou move the shift lever to thePark (P) position with the brakepedal depressed. This is the
The auto door unlocking isdeactivated all the time.
Make sure the shift lever is in thePark (P) position.
Turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position, and open thedriver’s door.
All doors unlock whenever youturn the ignition switch to theACCESSORY (I) position.
The driver’s door unlockswhenever you turn theignition switch to theACCESSORY (I) position.
All doors unlock when you move the shift lever to the Park(P) position with the brakepedal depressed.
default setting.
Release the switch, and within 5seconds, turn the ignition switchto the LOCK (0) position.
1.
2.
3.
4.
To turn off the Auto DoorUnlock modes:
Door Locks
Auto Door Unlocking
107
12/08/09 16:13:26 31SJC670_114
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
-
-
Push and hold the rear of themaster door lock switch on thedriver’s door. You will hear a click.Continue to hold down the switch:
Or, until you hear two moreclicks (after about 10seconds) to activate theall doors unlock feature.
Until you hear another click(after about 5 seconds) toactivate
Make sure the shift lever is in thePark (P) position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position, and make sure toclose the driver’s door.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position, and make sure toclose the driver’s door.
Make sure the shift lever is in thePark (P) position.
Release the switch, and within 5seconds, turn the ignition switchto the LOCK (0) position.
1.
2.
4.
3.
1.
2.
Unlocks the driver’s door or all doorswhen the shift lever is moved into thePark (P) position with the brake pedal depressed.
driver’s door
Unlocks the driver’s door or all doorswhen the ignition switch is moved out ofthe ON (II) position.
Door Locks
To program the Park Unlock mode: To program the IgnitionSwitch Unlock mode:
108
12/08/09 16:13:37 31SJC670_115
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
unlock feature.
-
-Or, until you hear two moreclicks (after about 10seconds) to activate theall doors unlock feature.
Until you hear another click(after about 5 seconds) toactivate the driver’s doorunlock feature.
Push and hold the rear of themaster door lock switch on thedriver’s door. You will hear a click.Continue to hold the switch:
Turn the ignition switch to theLOCK (0) position.
If your vehicle’s battery is removedor goes dead, the auto door lock/unlock setting is reset to thedeactivated mode.
Push and hold the brake pedal,then move the shift lever out ofthe Park (P) position.
Release the switch and, within 5seconds, turn the ignition switchto the ACCESSORY (I) position.Move the shift lever to the Park(P) position.
5.
4.
6.
3.
Door Locks
109
12/08/09 16:13:43 31SJC670_116
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
-
-
-
Press this button onceto unlock the driver’s door and theIn-Bed Trunk. Push it twice tounlock the remaining doors.Some exterior and interior lights
When you press the UNLOCKbutton, the front and rear individualmap lights, depending on the interiorlight control switch position, willcome on (see page ). If you donot open any door, the lights stay onfor about 30 seconds, then go out. Ifyou relock the doors and the In-BedTrunk with the remote transmitterbefore 30 seconds have elapsed, thelights will go off immediately.
Press this button once tolock all doors and the In-Bed Trunk.Some exterior and interior lights willflash once.When you push LOCK twice within 5seconds, you will hear a beep toverify that the doors and In-BedTrunk are locked and the securitysystem (if equipped) has set. Thisbutton does not work if any door isnot fully closed or the key is in theignition switch.
Press and hold thisbutton for about 1 second to attractattention; the horn will sound, andthe exterior lights will flash for about30 seconds. To cancel panic mode,press any other button on the remotetransmitter, or turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position. Panicmode does not work when the key isin the ignition switch.
If you do not open any door within 30seconds, the doors automaticallyrelock, and the security system sets(if equipped). The UNLOCK buttondoes not work when the key is in theignition switch.
You can also open all side windowsfrom outside the vehicle with theremote transmitter (see page ).
142
130
UNLOCK
LOCK
PANIC
Remote Transmitter
110
LED
UNLOCKBUTTON
PANICBUTTON
LOCKBUTTON
12/08/09 16:13:50 31SJC670_117
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
the button.will flash twice each time you push
Avoid dropping or throwing thetransmitter.
Protect the transmitter fromextreme temperatures.
Do not immerse the transmitter inany liquid.
If you lose a transmitter, thereplacement needs to bereprogrammed by your dealer.
To replace the battery:
Remove the screw at the base ofthe transmitter with a smallPhillips-head screwdriver.
If it takes several pushes on thebutton to lock or unlock the doors,replace the battery as soon aspossible.
Battery type: CR1616
Be careful when removingthis screw as the head of the screwcan strip out.
1.
CONTINUED
Remote Transmitter Care Replacing theTransmitter Battery
Remote Transmitter
111
NOTE:
SCREW
12/08/09 16:14:00 31SJC670_118
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
+
Remove the old battery from theback of the inner cover, and inserta new battery into the back of thecover with the side facing down.
An improperly disposed of batterycan hurt the environment.Always confirm local regulationsfor battery disposal.
Install the parts in reverse order.
Separate the transmitter byprying its middleseam with your fingernail.
Inside the transmitter, separatethe inner cover from thekeypad by releasing thetwo tabs on the cover.
This device complies with theappropriate requirements or therequired standards. See page formore information.
4.
5.
2.
3.
400
Remote Transmitter
112
BATTERY
12/08/09 16:14:07 31SJC670_119
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
You can open the tailgate twodifferent ways:
Drop it open by using the upperhandle.
Swing it open by using the rightlower handle.
To drop open the tailgate, pull up theupper handle, then pull down thetailgate. To close the tailgate, pushfirmly up until it latches.
Before you open the tailgate adifferent way (dropped open, andthen swung open), make sure it isfully closed.
Make sure all passengers andobjects are clear of the tailgatebefore opening and closing it, andmake sure the tailgate is closedsecurely before driving.
As a safety feature, the upper handleis disabled if you do not fully closethe tailgate after it is swung open.And the lower handle is disabled ifyou do not fully close the tailgateafter it is dropped open.
CONTINUED
To Drop Open the Tailgate
Dual-Action Tailgate
113
NOTE:
UPPER HANDLE
12/08/09 16:14:14 31SJC670_120
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
To swing open the tailgate, firstmake sure it is fully closed, then pullup the right lower handle, and swingthe tailgate to the left.To close, swing the tailgate back,and push it firmly until it is latched.
The dropped open tailgate can beused as an extended pickup bed.Make sure to secure the items in thepickup bed, and do not exceed themaximum allowable weight on thetailgate (see page ).
To turn the bed lights on or off, usethe bed light switch on thedashboard (see page ).
Before opening or closing thetailgate, check that passengers,especially children, are not in thetailgate’s path.
144
261
To Swing Open the Tailgate
Dual-Action Tailgate
114
HANDLESwinging the tailgate open orclosed while anyone is in itspath can cause serious injury.
Make sure all passengers areclear of the tailgate’s pathbefore opening or closing it.
Do not drive with the tailgate swungopen. This could damage the tailgate.
12/08/09 16:14:21 31SJC670_121
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
See page for information oncargo loading and weight limits.
You can also store and lock items inthe In-Bed Trunk (see page ).
If you do not fasten the seat belt, youfirst hear the seat belt reminderalarm, then the tailgate reminderbeeper sounds.
The indicator does not monitor thetailgate when it is dropped open.
Do not allow anyone to hang on theswung open tailgate. This coulddamage the tailgate.
Do not leave the tailgate swung open.The tailgate may swing and shutaccidentally. This could causeserious injuries.
The bed lights come on when youswing open the tailgate. You can alsoturn the bed lights on or off bypushing the bed light switch on thedashboard (see page ).
If the tailgate is swung open or notclosed tightly when the ignitionswitch is in the ON (II) position,you will hear six beeps and see theindicator blinking. The indicatorstays on until you close the tailgate.The beeper also sounds and theindicator blinks when you move theshift lever out of the Park orneutral position.
This indicator is in the door andtailgate open monitor on theinstrument panel. It comes on whenthe tailgate is swung open or it is notcompletely closed. This indicatorworks even if the key is not in theignition switch.
The tailgate open indicator appearson the multi-information display (seepage ).11
144
116
257
On models without navigation system
On models with navigation system
Loading Cargo
Tailgate Open Indicator
Dual-Action Tailgate
115
12/08/09 16:14:31 31SJC670_122
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
You can open the In-Bed Trunk twodifferent ways:
Push the release button on thelower right side of the In-BedTrunk lid when the driver’s dooris unlocked.
To close the In-Bed Trunk, lowerthe lid, then press down on theback edge.
If your vehicle’s battery isdisconnected or goes dead, therelease button on the In-Bed Trunklid is disabled. To open the In-BedTrunk, use the master key.
Use the master key to open theIn-Bed Trunk when the driver’sdoor is locked.
The bed lights come on when youopen the In-Bed Trunk. You can alsoturn the bed lights on or off bypushing the bed light switch on thedashboard (see page ).
You can store items in the In-BedTrunk up to 300 lbs (136 kg). Do notexceed this weight limit, or you maydamage the In-Bed Trunk. See page
for information on loading cargoand weight limits.
To store items separately in theIn-Bed Trunk, optional dividerguides are available from your dealer.
When the In-Bed Trunk is closedsecurely, it can be locked orunlocked along with the power doorlocks (see page ).
144
103
261
In-Bed Trunk
116
RELEASEBUTTON
12/08/09 16:14:40 31SJC670_123
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
To avoid damaging the key and keycylinder of the In-Bed Trunk lid, donot close the tailgate when the key isin the lid.
As a safety feature, your vehicle hasa release lever on the latch of theIn-Bed Trunk lid so it can be openedfrom the inside. To open the In-BedTrunk, push the release lever in thedirection of the arrow.
Parents should decide if theirchildren should be shown how to usethis feature. For more informationabout child safety, see page .
To avoid damaging the seal on theIn-Bed Trunk lid, remove any debrisfrom the lid’s mating surface beforeyou close it.
To avoid damaging the bottom of theIn-Bed Trunk, do not drive over largeobstacles, and do not use it as ajacking point to raise the vehicle.
To avoid damaging the In-Bed Trunklid, and to prevent items from beingthrown about the vehicle andpossibly hurting someone in a crashor sudden stop, be sure the In-BedTrunk lid is securely closed beforedriving away.
This indicator on the instrumentpanel reminds you that the In-BedTrunk is open (see page ).
38
75
Emergency Opener
In-Bed Trunk OpenIndicator
In-Bed Trunk
117
RELEASE LEVER
12/08/09 16:14:48 31SJC670_124
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
There are two cargo hooks forplastic grocery bags at the back ofthe In-Bed Trunk. They are designedto hold light items. Heavy objectsmay damage the hooks.
To protect items in the In-Bed Trunk,you can disable its release button byturning off the main switch in theglove box and locking the glove boxwith the master key.
Even if the main switch is in the OFFposition, you can open the In-BedTrunk with the master key.
When you are finished washing theIn-Bed Trunk, dry it with a soft cloth,and reinstall the drain plug.
You can wash the inside of theIn-Bed Trunk with a water and milddetergent solution, and a soft brushor cloth.
To drain water from the In-BedTrunk, remove the drain plug byturning it counterclockwise.
Cargo HooksWashing the In-Bed TrunkIn-Bed Trunk Main Switch
In-Bed Trunk
118
DRAIN PLUG
MAIN SWITCH CARGO HOOKS
12/08/09 16:14:57 31SJC670_125
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
-
The front passenger’s seat in allmodels adjusts manually.
To adjust the seat forward orbackward, pull up on the bar underthe seat cushion’s front edge. Movethe seat to the desired position, andrelease the bar. Try to move the seatto make sure it is locked in position.
Make all seat adjustments beforeyou start driving.
See pages for important safetyinformation and warnings about how toproperly position the seats and seat-backs.
13 15On RT, DX, VP, and Sport models
CONTINUED
Manual Seat Adjustments
Seats
119
12/08/09 16:15:03 31SJC670_126
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
Make sure to pull the lever upwardor downward to its full range.
Make all seat adjustments beforeyou start driving.
To change the seat-back angle of thefront seat, pull up the lever on theoutside of the seat bottom.
Once a seat is adjusted correctly,rock it back and forth to make sure itis locked in position.
The height of your driver’s seat isadjustable. To raise the seat,repeatedly pull up the lever on theoutside of the seat cushion.To lower the seat, push the leverdown repeatedly.
Seats
Driver’s Seat ManualHeight Adjustment
120
12/08/09 16:15:09 31SJC670_127
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
-
Moves the seat forwardand backward.
Moves the whole seat upand forward, or downand backward. The frontof the seat also tilts up ordown at the same time.
Moves the front of theseat up or down.
Raises or lowers the seat.
Adjusts the seat-backangle forward orbackward.
The controls for the poweradjustable driver’s seat are on theoutside edge of the seat bottom. Youcan adjust the seat with the ignitionswitch in any position. Make all seatadjustments before you start driving. Increases or decreases
the lumbar support.
See pages for important safetyinformation and warnings about how toproperly position the seats and seat-backs.
15On RTS, RTL, and Touring models
13
Power Seat Adjustments
Seats
121
12/08/09 16:15:20 31SJC670_128
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
To use the console lid as an armrest,slide it to the desired position.
The rear seat armrest is in thecenter of the rear seats. Pivot itdown to use it.
Your vehicle is equipped with headrestraints in all seating positions tohelp protect you and yourpassengers from the likelihood ofwhiplash and other injuries.
Make sure your passenger’s handsand fingers are away from thearmrest before moving it.
See page for important safetyinformation and a warning aboutimproperly positioning head restraints.
15Armrests Head Restraints
Seats
122
FRONT
REAR
12/08/09 16:15:28 31SJC670_129
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
When a passenger is seated in therear center seating position, makesure the center head restraint isproperly positioned.
They are most effective when youadjust them so the center of the backof the occupant’s head rests againstthe center of the restraint.
The head restraints adjust for height.You need both hands to adjust therestraint. Do not attempt to adjust itwhile driving. To raise it, pull upward.To lower the restraint, push therelease button sideways, and pushthe restraint down.
CONTINUED
Seats
Adjusting the Head Restraint
123
Rear Center Position
RELEASE BUTTON
CUSHION
LEGS
SEAT-BACK
RELEASE BUTTONLEGS
CUSHION
12/08/09 16:15:36 31SJC670_130
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
The driver’s and front passenger’sseats have active head restraints. Ifthe vehicle is struck severely fromthe rear, the occupant properlysecured with the seat belt will bepushed against the seat-back and thehead restraint will automaticallymove forward.
This reduces the distance betweenthe restraint and the occupant’s head. It also helps protect theoccupants against the likelihood ofwhiplash and injuries to the neckand upper spine.
To remove a head restraint forcleaning or repair, pull it up as far asit will go. Push the release button,then pull the restraint out of theseat-back.
If the restraints do not return to theirnormal position, or in the event of asevere collision, have the vehicleinspected by a Honda dealer.
After a collision, the activatedrestraint should return to its normal position.
Make sure the head restraint locksin position when you reinstall it.
When reinstalling a head restraint,put the legs back in place. Thenadjust it to the appropriate heightwhile pressing the release button.
Seats
Active Head RestraintsRemoving the Head Restraint
124
Failure to reinstall, or correctlyreinstall, the head restraints canresult in severe injury during acrash.
Always replace the headrestraints before driving.
12/08/09 16:15:44 31SJC670_131
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
CONTINUED
For a head restraint system to workproperly:
Do not hang any items on the headrestraints, or from the restraintlegs.
Do not place any object betweenan occupant and the seat-back.
Install each restraint in its properlocation.
Only use genuine Hondareplacement head restraints.
The left and right rear seat cushionscan be lifted up separately to makeroom for cargo.
To fold a rear seat cushion, pull upthe lever on the outside of thecushion. The seat cushion pops up,and the seat legs store underneath it.Push the cushion firmly against theseat-back to lock it in place.
Remove any items from the seatbefore you fold up the seat cushion.
Folding the Rear Seats
Seats
125
12/08/09 16:15:52 31SJC670_132
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
If equipped
Make sure all items in the cargo areaare secured. Loose items can flyforward and cause injury if you haveto brake hard (Seeon page ).
You can also store small items underthe rear seats. Make sure to securethe items so they will not shift whileyou are driving.
To return the seat cushion to itsoriginal position, pull the leveroutward, then push down the seatcushion slowly.
Make sure the seat cushion is lockedsecurely and the seat legs arepositioned properly in the floor guide.
Both front seats are equipped withseat heaters. Because of thesensors for the side airbag cutoffsystem, there is no heater in thepassenger’s seat-back. Theignition switch must be in the ON(II) position to use the heaters.
257
Seat Heaters
Carrying Cargo
Seats, Seat Heaters
126
Passenger’sSeat
Driver’sSeat
LEGS
FLOOR GUIDE
HEATERS
12/08/09 16:16:00 31SJC670_133
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
Follow these precautions when usingthe seat heaters:
Do not use the seat heater in theHI setting for an extended period,because it draws large amounts ofcurrent from the battery.
If the engine is left idling for anextended period, do not use theseat heaters, even on the LOsetting. It can weaken the battery,causing hard starting.
Push the top of the switch, HI, torapidly heat up the seat. After theseat reaches a comfortabletemperature, select LO by pushingthe bottom of the switch. This willkeep the seat warm.
In the HI setting, the heaterturns off when the seat gets warm,and turns back on after theseat’s temperature drops.
In the LO setting, the heater runscontinuously. It does not cycle withtemperature changes.
Seat Heaters
127
SEAT HEATER SWITCHES
Heat induced burns arepossible when using seatheaters.
Persons with a diminishedability to sense temperature(e.g., persons with diabetes,lower-limb nerve damage, orparalysis) or with sensitive skinshould not use seat heaters.
12/08/09 16:16:07 31SJC670_134
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
-
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position to raise or lower anyside window, or open and close theback window. To open the window,push the switch down and hold it.Release the switch when you wantthe window to stop. Pull back on theswitch and hold it to close thewindow.
The windows operate for up to 10minutes after you turn off theignition switch. Opening either frontdoor cancels this function.
To open or close thedriver’s window, push or pull thewindow switch firmly down or up tothe second detent, and release it.The window will automatically go upor down all the way. To stop thewindow, pull or push the windowswitch briefly.
When you push the MAIN switch in,the passenger windows and the backwindow cannot be raised or lowered.
To cancel this feature, push on theswitch again. Keep the MAIN switchoff when you have children in thevehicle so they do not injurethemselves by operating thewindows unintentionally.
AUTO
Power Windows
128
DRIVER’S WINDOWSWITCH
MAIN SWITCH
BACK WINDOW SWITCH
Closing a power window onsomeone’s hands or fingers cancause serious injury.
Make sure your passengers areaway from the windows beforeclosing them.
12/08/09 16:16:13 31SJC670_135
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
- If the driver’swindow senses any obstacle while itis closing automatically, it willreverse direction, and then stop. Toclose the window, remove theobstacle, then use the windowswitch again.
Auto reverse stops sensing when thewindow is almost closed. You shouldalways check that all passengers andobjects are away from the windowbefore closing it.
Your vehicle has a power backwindow.
This indicator comes on when youturn the ignition switch from the ON(II) position to the ACCESSORY (I)or LOCK (0) position without closingthe back window. With the ignitionswitch in the ACCESSORY (I)position, the indicator goes offafter about 30 seconds. With theignition switch in the LOCK (0)position, the indicator goes offafter about 3 minutes.
If your vehicle’s battery isdisconnected or goes dead, or thedriver’s window fuse is removed, theAUTO function may be disabled. Ifthe AUTO function is disabled, thepower window system will need to bereset after reconnecting the batteryor installing the fuse.
If the power windows do not operateproperly after resetting, have yourvehicle checked by your dealer.
Pull and hold the driver’s windowswitch to close the windowcompletely, then hold the switchfor about 2 seconds.
Start the engine. Push down andhold the driver’s window switchuntil the window is fully open.
1.
2.
CONTINUED
AUTO REVERSE Back Window
Back WindowOpen Indicator
Power Windows
129
12/08/09 16:16:22 31SJC670_136
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
To open:Insert the key in the driver’s
Turn the key clockwise, thenrelease it.
You can open all of the sidewindows from the outside with theremote transmitter.
Press the UNLOCK button onceto unlock the driver’s door.
Press the UNLOCK button asecond time, and hold it. Thepassenger’s doors unlock,and all four side windows startto open. To stop the windows,release the button.
You can open and close the sidewindows with the key in the driver’sdoor lock.
The back window is not designed tocarry long items through it. Do notuse the opened back window as acargo area pass-through.
If you remove the ignition key andopen the driver’s door withoutclosing the back window, you hearfive beeps and see the indicator blink.If you do not close the back windowbefore the beeper stops, theindicator stops blinking but remainson. It will go off after about 3minutes (see page ).
To open the windows further,press the button again, withinabout 3 seconds.
You cannot close the windows withthe remote transmitter.
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
75
Opening the Side Windows withthe Remote Transmitter
Opening/Closing the SideWindows with the Key
Power Windows
130
Open
Close
UNLOCK BUTTON
12/08/09 16:16:32 31SJC670_137
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
door lock.
Turn the key clockwise again, andhold it. All four side windows startto open. To stop the windows,release the key.
To open the windows further, turnand hold the key again (within10 seconds).
The moonroof has two positions: itcan be tilted up in the back forventilation, or it can slide back intothe roof. Use the switch near the leftdashboard vent to operate themoonroof. The ignition switch mustbe in the ON (II) position.
If the windows stop beforethe desired position, repeat steps 2and 3.
To close the windows further, turnand hold the key again (within10 seconds).
To close:
If the windows stop beforethe desired position, repeat steps 2and 3.
Insert the key in the driver’s
Turn the key counterclockwise,then release it.
Turn the key counterclockwiseagain, and hold it. All four sidewindows start to close. To stop thewindows, release the key.
1.
2.
3.
4.3.
4.
If equipped
CONTINUED
Moonroof
Power Windows, Moonroof
131
NOTE:
NOTE:
MOONROOF SWITCH
12/08/09 16:16:43 31SJC670_138
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
door lock.
You can open and close themoonroof for up to 10 minutes afteryou turn off the ignition switch.Opening either front door cancelsthis function.
To apply the parking brake, push thepedal down with your foot. Torelease it, pull the release handlefully. The parking brake indicator onthe instrument panel should go outwhen the parking brake is fullyreleased (see page ).
To tilt up the back of the moonroof,press and hold the center part of theswitch ( ). To close themoonroof, press and hold the upperpart of the switch ( ). To openthe moonroof, press and hold thelower part of the switch ( ).Release the switch when
Make sure everyone’s hands areaway from the moonroof beforeopening or closing it.
65
Parking Brake
Moonroof, Parking Brake
132
RELEASE HANDLE
PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
Opening or closing themoonroof on someone’s handsor fingers can cause seriousinjury.
Make sure all hands and fingersare clear of the moonroofbefore opening or closing it.
If you try to open the moonroof inbelow-f reezing temperatures, orwhen it is covered with snow or ice,you can damage the moonroof panelor its motor.
12/08/09 16:16:52 31SJC670_139
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
the moonroof gets to thedesired position.
You will also see a ‘‘RELEASEPARKING BRAKE’’ message on themulti-information display (see page ).
When driving after dark, theautomatic dimming rearview mirroralways reduces the glare fromheadlights behind you, based ininputs from the mirror sensor. Thisfeature is always active.
However, it will turn off when youshift into reverse.
90
CONTINUED
On models with navigation system
Parking Brake, Mirrors
On models withoutnavigation systemOn models with navigation system
Mirrors
133
SENSOR SENSOR
Driving the vehicle with the parkingbrake applied can damage the rearbrakes and hubs. A beeper will sound ifthe vehicle is driven with the parkingbrake on.
12/09/07 18:08:00 31SJC670_140
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
The outside mirrors are heated toremove fog and frost. With theignition switch in the ON (II)position, turn on the heaters bypressing the button. The indicator inthe button comes on as a reminder.Press the button again to turn theheaters off.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position.
When you finish, move theselector switch to the center (off)position. This turns theadjustment switch offto keep your settings.
Push the appropriate edge of theadjustment switch to move themirror right, left, up, or down.
Move the selector switch to L(driver’s side) or R (passenger’sside).
1.
2.
3.
4.
If equipped
Heated Mirrors
Adjusting the Power Mirrors
Mirrors
134
SELECTOR SWITCH
ADJUSTMENT SWITCH
HEATED MIRROR BUTTONThere is also a sensor on the backof the mirror. Items hung on themirror may block this sensor andaf f ect its perf ormance.
12/08/09 16:17:09 31SJC670_141
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
*
*
Interior Convenience Items
135
GLOVE BOX
ACCESSORY POWERSOCKETCENTER UPPER
CENTER POCKET
CENTER LOWER POCKET BEVERAGE HOLDERS
: On vehicle without navigation system
CONSOLE COMPARTMENT
ACCESSORYPOWER SOCKETS
SUN VISOR VANITY MIRROR
BEVERAGE HOLDERCOAT HOOKCENTER CONSOLESUNGLASSESHOLDER
12/08/09 16:17:14 31SJC670_142
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
The center console maincompartment is under the tray andthe beverage holder. You can accessthe main compartment in two ways(front or rear).
To open the front of thecompartment, squeeze the knob, andpush it forward while sliding thebeverage holder. To close, squeezethe knob and pull the compartmentbackward until the beverage holder latches.
To open the rear of the compartment,push the button at the end of thetray, then slide the tray forward. Toclose, slide the tray back in place.
The console compartment lightcomes on when the instrument panellights are on.
There are two removable partitionsin the main compartment. Thepartitions can be used to divide themain compartment, or can be storedat the front of the compartment.
Your vehicle has a multi-functioncenter console. It includes beverageholders, storage compartments, anarmrest, and a storage tray.
Center Console Console Compartments
Interior Convenience Items
136
12/08/09 16:17:22 31SJC670_143
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
You can put small items in the upperconsole compartment. To use it, pullup on the lever and lift up thearmrest. Spilled liquids can damage the
upholstery, carpeting, and electricalcomponents in the interior.
There are two cargo hooks forplastic grocery bags at the back ofthe center console. They aredesigned to hold light items. Heavyobjects may damage the hooks.
Be careful when you are using thebeverage holders. A spilled liquidthat is very hot can scald you or yourpassengers. Liquid can also spillfrom the door panel beverageholders when you close the doors.Use only resealable containers in thedoor beverage holders.
The center console has two beverage holders on the front. Yourvehicle also has beverageholders in the rear seat armrestand the rear door panels.
Beverage HoldersCargo Hooks
Interior Convenience Items
137
CARGO HOOKS
12/08/09 16:17:30 31SJC670_144
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
The glove box light comes on whenthe parking lights are on.
Some larger styles of sunglassesmay not fit in the holder.
These hooks are not designed forlarge or heavy items.
To open the sunglasses holder, pushon the rear edge. Make sure theholder is closed while you are driving.
Open the glove box by pulling up onthe handle. Close it with a firm push.Lock or unlock the glove box withthe master key.
Glove Box Sunglasses HolderCoat Hooks
Interior Convenience Items
138
SUNGLASSES HOLDER
An open glove box can causeserious injury to your passengerin a crash, even if thepassenger is wearing the seatbelt.
Always keep the glove boxclosed while driving.
12/08/09 16:17:38 31SJC670_145
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
There are three accessory powersockets in your vehicle. Twoaccessory power sockets are abovethe center pocket on the dashboard,and another is on the back of thecenter console.
These sockets are intended to supply power for 12 voltDC accessories that are rated 120watts or less (10 amps).
To use an accessory power socket,the ignition switch must be in theACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position.
None of the sockets will power anautomotive type cigarette lighterelement. When both sockets arebeing used, the combined powerrating of the accessories should be120 watts or less (10 amps).
Accessory Power Sockets
Interior Convenience Items
139
FRONT
REAR
12/08/09 16:17:44 31SJC670_146
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
Pull up the vanity mirror coverto use it.
The light comes on when you pull upthe cover.
The light will not come on if the sunvisor is slid outward.
Make sure you put the sun visorback in place when you are gettinginto or out of the vehicle.
In this position, the sun visor can beadjusted by moving it on its slider.Do not use the extended sun visorover the inside mirror.
To use the sun visor, pull it down.When using the sun visor for theside window, remove the support rodfrom the clip, and swing it out.
Sun Visor Vanity Mirror
Interior Convenience Items
140
SUN VISOR
Slide
12/08/09 16:17:51 31SJC670_147
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
Always run the engine when you usethe AC power outlet.
The maximum capacity for thispower outlet is 115 volt AC at 100watts or less. If you use an appliancewhich requires more than 100 watts,it automatically stops supplying thepower. If this happens, turn theignition switch off and turn it on again.
The AC power outlet is notdesigned for electric applianceswhich require high initial peakwattage such as cathode-ray tubetype televisions, refrigerators,electric pumps, etc. It is also notsuitable for devices that processprecise data such as medicalequipment or measuring instruments.Any appliances that require anextremely stable power supply suchas microcomputer-controlled electricblankets, touch sensor lamps, etc.,should not be connected to this outlet.
There is a 115 volt AC power outletinside the front consolecompartment. To use the AC poweroutlet, open the lids and open theoutlet cover. Insert the plug into thereceptacle slightly, turn it 90°clockwise, then push in the plug allthe way.
On RTL and Touring models
Interior Convenience Items
AC Power Outlet
141
NOTE:
12/08/09 16:17:57 31SJC670_148
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
When the interior light control switch isin the ON position:
When the switch is in the OFF position:When the switch is in the door position:
None of the lights come on when adoor is opened.
The map lights in the front can beturned on and off by pushing eachlens. The rear map lights cannotbe used.
All the individual map lights andthe rear console light come on andstay on as long as the switchremains in the ON position.
The individual map lights and therear console light come on whenany door is opened, or when theremote transmitter or the key isused to unlock the doors. Whenthe doors are closed, eachindividual map light can be turnedon and off by pushing the lens.
The lights fade out about 30seconds after all thedoors are closed.
With any door left open and thekey removed from the ignitionswitch, the lights stay on about 3minutes, then go out.
Interior Light Control Switch
Interior Lights
142
ON
OFF
DOOR POSITION
12/08/09 16:18:05 31SJC670_149
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
Turn on a front individual map lightby pushing the lens. Push the lensagain to turn it off. With the interiorlight control switch in the doorposition, a rear map light can beturned on by pushing the lens. Pushthe lens again to turn it off.
The courtesy light in each doorcomes on when you open that door.The light around the ignition switchonly comes on when you open thedriver’s door. After you close thedoor, the ignition switch light fadesout in about 30 seconds.
The courtesy light in the back of thecenter console comes on when youopen any door with the interior lightcontrol switch in the door position.After you close the doors, the lightfades out.
The map lights stay on when theinterior light control switch is in thedoor position and the map lightswitch is on.
The courtesy light between the frontmap lights comes on when you turnthe parking lights on. To adjust itsbrightness, turn the instrumentpanel brightness control dial on thedashboard (see page ).98
If equipped
Individual Map Lights Individual Interior Lights Courtesy Light
Interior Lights
143
12/08/09 16:18:13 31SJC670_150
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
If you turn the ignition switch toACCESSORY (I) or LOCK (0)without turning off the bed lights,the lights and the indicator willremain on, then go off after 20minutes (see page ).
Your vehicle has bed lights in thepickup bed: a light on each frontupper and rear bottom side. With theshift lever in the Park position, thebed lights come on when you pushthe bed light switch on thedashboard, swing open the tailgate,or open the In-Bed Trunk. Theindicator on the instrument panelalso comes on to remind you that thebed lights are on.
To turn off the lights, push the lightswitch again, or close the tailgateand the In-Bed Trunk.
When you move the shift lever out ofthe Park position, the bed lights gooff and cannot be used.
74
Bed Lights
144
BED LIGHT SWITCH
12/08/09 16:18:19 31SJC670_151
2013 Ridgeline
Instruments
andC
ontrols
The heating and air conditioningsystem in your vehicle provides acomfortable driving environment inall weather conditions.
The standard audio system hasmany features. This sectiondescribes those features and how touse them.
Your vehicle has an anti-theft audiosystem that requires a code numberto enable it.
The security system helps to discourage vandalism and theftof your vehicle.
The climate control system and theaudio system have a voice controlfeature. Refer to the navigationsystem manual for more information.
.............Vents, Heating, and A/C . 146...............Climate Control System . 152
..........Playing the AM/FM Radio . 159............AM/FM Radio Reception . 165
................Playing the XM Radio . 167...................................Playing CDs . 174
.......................................CD Player . 175CD Changer
(Models without navigation..................................system) . 181
CD Changer(Models with navigation
..................................system) . 189....................Protecting Your CDs . 198
CD Player/Changer Error...................................Messages . 202
................Remote Audio Controls . 203......................Auxiliary Input Jack . 205
.................Radio Theft Protection . 205..........................Setting the Clock . 207
............................Security System . 208...............................Cruise Control . 210
HomeLink Universal................................Transceiver . 213
........HandsFreeLink . 217
Rearview Mirror with Rearview.........................Camera Display . 240
Bluetooth
On models with navigation system
On RTS, RTL, and Touring models
Features
145
12/09/07 16:43:06 31SJC670_152
2013 Ridgeline
See page for automatic climatecontrol and semi-automatic operationinformation.
152On RTS, RTL, and Touring models
Vents, Heating, and A/C
146
FAN CONTROL DIAL MAX A/C BUTTON
RECIRCULATION BUTTON
WINDSHIELD DEFROSTER BUTTON
TEMPERATURECONTROL DIAL
MODE BUTTONS
MODE BUTTONS
AIR CONDITIONING BUTTON
RT, DX, VP, and Sport models
12/08/09 16:18:30 31SJC670_153
2013 Ridgeline
Features
This button turns the airconditioning on and off. You will seeA/C ON or A/C OFF in the display.
When the indicator in the button ison, air from the vehicle’s interior issent throughout the system again.When the indicator is off, air isbrought in from the outside of thevehicle (fresh air mode).
The system should be left in freshair mode under almost all conditions.Keeping the system in recirculationmode, particularly with the A/C off,can cause the windows to fog up.
Switch to recirculation modewhen driving through dusty orsmoky conditions,then return to fresh air mode.
The outside air intakes for theheating and cooling system are atthe base of the windshield. Keep thisarea clear of leaves and other debris.
Turn this dial to increase or decreasethe fan speed and airflow.
Turning this dial clockwise increasesthe temperature of the airflow.
Vents, Heating, and A/C
Air Conditioning (A/C) Button Recirculation ButtonFan Control Dial
Temperature Control Dial
Features
147
12/08/09 16:18:38 31SJC670_154
2013 Ridgeline
Use the mode control buttons toselect the vents air flows from. Someair will flow from the dashboardcorner vents in all modes.
Air flows from the center,corner, and rear vents in thedashboard.
Airflow is divided betweenthe vents in the dashboard, rear andthe floor vents.
Air flows from the floorvents. When you select , thesystem automatically switches tofresh air mode.
Airflow is divided betweenthe floor vents and defroster vents atthe base of the windshield.
Air flows from the defrostervents at the base of the windshield.
When you select , the systemautomatically switches to fresh airmode and turns on the A/C.
When you switch to from, the A/C stays on, and you
can turn it on and off manually.
The system automaticallyturns on the A/C and switches toRecirculation mode. Air flows fromthe center and side vents in thedashboard.
Vents, Heating, and A/C
Mode Control Windshield Defroster Button MAX A/C Button
148
12/08/09 16:18:51 31SJC670_155
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Air conditioning places an extra loadon the engine. Watch the enginecoolant temperature gauge (see page
). If it moves near the red mark,turn off the A/C until the gaugereads normally.
The heater uses engine coolant towarm the air. If the engine is cold,it will be several minutes beforeyou feel warm air coming from the system.
Select .When you select , the systemautomatically switches to the freshair mode.Set the fan to the desired speed.Adjust the warmth of the air withthe temperature control dial.
Set the temperature to thelower limit.Make sure the A/C is off.Select and fresh air mode.Set the fan to the desired speed.
If the outside air is humid, selectrecirculation mode. If the outsideair is dry, select fresh air mode.
Select .
Make sure the temperature is setto the lower limit.
Turn on the A/C by pressing thebutton. You will see A/C ON inthe display.
Set the fan to the desired speed.
The ventilation system draws inoutside air, circulates it through theinterior, then exhausts it throughvents near the back window.
1.2.
3.
4.5.
1.
2.3.
1.
2.3.4.
76
CONTINUED
Vents, Heating, and A/C
Using the A/CVentilation Using the Heater
149
12/08/09 16:19:03 31SJC670_156
2013 Ridgeline
Features
To remove fog from the inside ofthe windows:
Air conditioning, as it cools, removesmoisture from the air. When used incombination with the heater, itmakes the interior warm and dry.
This setting is suitable for all drivingconditions whenever the outsidetemperature is above 32°F (0°C).
Turn the fan on.Press the A/C button.Select and fresh air mode.Adjust the temperature to yourpreference.
Set the fan to the desired speed, orhigh for faster defrosting.Select . The systemautomatically switches to fresh airmode and turns on the A/C. TheA/C ON indicator will not bedisplayed if it was off to start with.Adjust the temperature so theairflow feels warm.To increase airflow to thewindshield, close the corner vents.
When you switch to another modefrom , the A/C turns off. Butif it was on to start with, it stays on.
This function helps to increase wiperperformance when the wiper armssit in the parked position in snowy oricy conditions.
Your vehicle has heating wires at thebottom of the windshield to helpheat the wiper blades and thewindshield. If the outsidetemperature is near freezing, theheater turns on automatically whenyou turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position. The heater turnsoff automatically when the outsidetemperature is above freezing.
If the interior is very warm, you cancool it down more rapidly by partiallyopening the windows, turning on theA/C, and setting the fan tomaximum speed in fresh air mode.
1.2.3.4.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Vents, Heating, and A/C
To Defog and Defrost
Dehumidify the Interior
Automatic Heated Wiper Zone
150
12/08/09 16:19:13 31SJC670_157
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Set the fan and temperaturecontrols to maximum level.Select . The systemautomatically switches to fresh airmode and turns on the A/C.The A/C ON indicator will not bedisplayed if it was off to start with.Select .
Turning the fan speed control dial all the way to the left shuts thesystem off.
Keep the system off for shortperiods only.
To keep stale air and mustinessfrom collecting, you should havethe fan running at all times.
You can adjust the direction of theair coming from the rear vents in theback of the center console bymoving the tab in the center of eachvent up-and-down and side-to-side.
You can also adjust the amount ofairflow by turning the dial betweenthe vents.
To clear the windows faster, you canclose the dashboard corner vents byrotating the wheel next to(passenger’s side) or below it(driver’s side). This will send morewarm air to the windshield defrostervents. Once the windshield is clear,select fresh air mode to avoidfogging the windows.
For your safety, make sure you havea clear view through all the windowsbefore driving.
1.
2.
3.
To Remove Exterior Frost or IceFrom the Windows
To Turn Everything Off Rear Ventilation
Vents, Heating, and A/C
151
DIAL
TABS
12/08/09 16:19:26 31SJC670_158
2013 Ridgeline
Features
The climate control system can alsobe operated by voice control.See the navigation system manualfor complete details.
On models with navigation systemVoice Control System
Climate Control System
152
DRIVER’S SIDETEMPERATUREDISPLAY
ON/OFF BUTTON
MODE BUTTON
PASSENGER’S SIDETEMPERATURE DISPLAY
AIR CONDITIONING BUTTON
AUTO BUTTON
DRIVER’S SIDETEMPERATURECONTROL DIAL
RECIRCULATION BUTTON
WINDSHIELDDEFROSTER BUTTON
FAN CONTROLBUTTONS
PASSENGER’S SIDETEMPERATURECONTROL DIAL
RTS, RTL, and Touring models
12/08/09 16:19:32 31SJC670_159
2013 Ridgeline
Features
The automatic climate controlsystem in your vehicle maintains theinterior temperature you select. Thesystem also adjusts the fan speedand airflow levels.
The system automatically selects theproper mix of conditioned and/orheated air that will, as quickly aspossible, raise or lower the interiortemperature to your preference.
When you set either sidetemperature to its lower limit( ) or its upper limit ( ),the system runs at full cooling orheating only. It does not regulate theinterior temperature.
When you press a fan control button,the fan is taken out of AUTO mode.
The driver’s and passenger’s sidetemperatures should always be setseparately. Turn the desired dialclockwise to increase the airflowtemperature of that side, andcounterclockwise to decrease it.
Press the Auto button on the frontcontrol panel. You will see AUTOin the system display.
Adjust the temperature for thedriver’s and passenger’s sideseparately, using the desiredtemperature control dial.
The passenger’s side temperaturesetting does not synchronize to thedriver’s side at any time except whenthe system is in the defroster mode(see page ).
1.
2.
155
CONTINUED
Using Automatic Climate Control
Temperature Control
Climate Control System
153
12/08/09 16:19:41 31SJC670_160
2013 Ridgeline
Features
▲
▼
To turn the system completely off,press the ON/OFF button.
Keep the system completely offfor short periods only.
To keep stale air and mustinessfrom collecting, you should havethe fan running at all times.
You can manually select variousfunctions of the climate controlsystem when it is in fully automaticmode. All other features remainautomatically controlled. Making anymanual selection causes the wordAUTO in the display to go out.
Press the button to increasethe fan speed and airflow. Press the
button to decrease it.
This button turns the airconditioning on and off. You will seeA/C ON or A/C OFF in the display.
When you turn the A/C off, thesystem cannot regulate the insidetemperature if you set thetemperature control below theoutside temperature.
In AUTO mode, the vehicle’stemperature is independentlyregulated, based on the driver’s andpassenger’s side setting. The systemalso regulates each temperaturebased on the information of the sunlight sensor and the sun’s positionwhich is updated automatically bythe navigation’s global positioningsystem (GPS). For example, if thedriver’s side of the vehicle is gettingtoo much sun, the system will adjustto a lower temperature.
On models with navigation system To Turn Everything Off Semi-automatic Operation
Fan Control
Air Conditioning (A/C) Button
Climate Control System
154
12/08/09 16:19:51 31SJC670_161
2013 Ridgeline
Features
CONTINUED
This button directs the main airflowto the windshield for fasterdefrosting. It also overrides anymode selection you may have made.
When you select , the systemautomatically switches to fresh airmode and turns on the A/C. Forfaster defrosting, manually set thefan speed to high. You can alsoincrease airflow to the windshield byclosing the corner vents on thedashboard. To close the vents, rotatethe wheel under each corner vent.
When you turn off bypressing the button again, thesystem returns to its former settings.
Use the mode control button toselect the vents the air flows from.Some air will flow from thedashboard vents in all modes.
Air flows from the center,corner, and rear vents in thedashboard.
Airflow is divided betweenthe vents in the dashboard, rear andthe floor vents.
Air flows from the floorvents.
Airflow is divided betweenthe floor and corner vents and thedefroster vents at the base of thewindshield.
When the indicator in the button ison, air from the vehicle’s interior issent through the system again.When the indicator is off, air isbrought in from the outside of thevehicle (fresh air mode).
The outside air intakes for theclimate control system are at thebase of the windshield. Keep thisarea clear of leaves and other debris.
The system should be left in freshair mode under almost all conditions.Keeping the system in recirculationmode, particularly with the A/C off,can cause the windows to fog up.
Switch to recirculation modewhen driving through dusty orsmoky conditions, then return to fresh air mode.
Climate Control System
Windshield Defroster ButtonMode ControlRecirculation Button
155
12/08/09 16:20:03 31SJC670_162
2013 Ridgeline
Features
You can adjust the direction of theair coming from the rear vents in theback of the center console bymoving the tab in the center of eachvent up-and-down and side-to-side.
You can also adjust the amount ofairflow by turning the dial betweenthe vents.
For your safety, make sure you havea clear view through all the windowsbefore driving.
When the indicator in the button ison, the passenger’s side temperatureautomatically adjusts to the driver’sside temperature.
Your vehicle has heating wires at thebottom of the windshield to helpheat the wiper blades and thewindshield. If the outsidetemperature is near freezing, theheater turns on automatically whenyou turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position. The heater turnsoff automatically when the outsidetemperature is above freezing.
This function helps to increase wiperperformance when the wiper armssit in the parked position in snowy oricy conditions.
Rear VentilationAutomatic Heated Wiper Zone
Climate Control System
156
TABS
DIAL
12/08/09 16:20:10 31SJC670_163
2013 Ridgeline
Features
The temperatures of the driver’s sideand the front passenger’s side arecontrolled independently.
To adjust each temperature, turneither of the temperature controldials on the climate control panel.
When you set each temperature toits lower limit or its upper limit, it willbe displayed as ‘‘ ’’ or ‘‘ .’’
Climate Control System
Dual Temperature Control
157
Driver’s Side Passenger’s Side
12/08/09 16:20:16 31SJC670_164
2013 Ridgeline
Features
The climate control system has twosensors. A sunlight sensor is in thetop of the dashboard, and atemperature sensor is under thesteering column. Do not cover thesensors or spill any liquid on them.
Sunlight and Temperature Sensors
Climate Control System
158
SUNLIGHT SENSOR
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
12/08/09 16:20:21 31SJC670_165
2013 Ridgeline
Features
CONTINUED
Playing the AM/FM Radio
159
AM/FMBUTTON
SCANBUTTON
SEEK/SKIP BAR
SOUND BUTTON
VOLUME KNOB
STEREO INDICATOR
TUNE BAR PRESET BARS TUNE BAR
A.SEL(AUTOSELECT)BUTTON
SOUNDBUTTON
RTS model
VOLUME KNOB
STEREO INDICATOR
SCANBUTTON
AM/FMBUTTON
A.SEL(AUTOSELECT)BUTTON
PRESET BARSSEEK/SKIP BAR
PWRBUTTON
PWRBUTTON
RT, DX, VP, and Sport models
12/08/09 16:20:28 31SJC670_166
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Playing the AM/FM Radio
160
SCANBUTTON
TUNE BARPRESET BARS
SEEK/SKIP BAR
SOUNDBUTTON
STEREO INDICATOR
TUNE BAR
VOLUME KNOB
STEREO INDICATOR
AM/FM BUTTON
A.SEL (AUTO SELECT) BUTTON
SEEK/SKIP BAR
SOUNDBUTTON
AM/FMBUTTON
VOLUME KNOB
A.SEL(AUTOSELECT)BUTTON
SCANBUTTON
PRESET BARS
RTL and Touring models without navigation system RTL and Touring models with navigation system
PWR BUTTON PWR BUTTON
12/08/09 16:20:34 31SJC670_167
2013 Ridgeline
Features
-
-
-
- -
-
You can use any of five methods tofind radio stations on the selectedband: tune, seek, scan, the presetbars, and auto select.
Use the TUNE bar to tunethe radio to a desired frequency.Press the side of the bar to tuneto a higher frequency, and press the
side to tune to a lowerfrequency.
The scan function samplesall stations with strong signals on theselected band. To activate it, pressthe SCAN button, then release it.You will see SCAN in the display.When the system finds a strong
signal, it will stop and play thatstation for about 10 seconds.The ignition switch must be in the
ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position.Turn the system on by pushing thePWR button or the AM/FM button.Adjust the volume by turning thevolume knob.
Pushing the AUDIO button will alsoturn on the system (see page ).
The band and frequency that theradio was last tuned to are displayed.To change bands, press the AM/FMbutton. On the FM band, ST will bedisplayed if the station isbroadcasting in stereo. Stereoreproduction in AM is not available.
On the AM band, AM noisereduction turns on automatically.
The SEEK functionsearches up and down from thecurrent frequency to find a stationwith a strong signal. To activate it,press the or side of theSEEK/SKIP bar, then release it.
If you do nothing, the system willscan for the next strong station andplay it for 10 seconds. When it playsa station that you want to listen to,press the SCAN button again.
Each side of the bars (16) can store one frequency on AMand two frequencies on FM.
Use the tune, seek, or scanfunction to tune the radio to adesired station.
Select the desired band, AM orFM. FM1 and FM2 let you storesix stations each.
Pick a preset number (1 6),then press and hold ituntil you hear a beep.Repeat steps 1 through 3 to store atotal of six stations on AM andtwelve stations on FM.
1.
2.
3.
4.
163
CONTINUED
On models with navigation system
To Play the AM/FM Radio To Select a Station
TUNE
SCAN
SEEK
Preset
Playing the AM/FM Radio
161
12/08/09 16:20:45 31SJC670_168
2013 Ridgeline
Features
-
-
-
-
-
-
If you do not like the stations autoselect has stored, you can storeother frequencies on the preset barsas previously described.
, press theA. SEL (auto select) button. Thisrestores the presets youoriginally set.
If you aretraveling far from home and can nolonger receive your preset stations,you can use the auto select feature tofind stations in the local area.
Press the A.SEL button. ‘‘A.SEL’’flashes in the display, and the systemgoes into scan mode for severalseconds. It stores the frequencies ofsix AM, and twelve FM stations inthe preset bars.
You will see a ‘‘0’’ displayed afterpressing a preset bar if auto selectcannot find a strong station for everypreset bar.
Adjusts thestrength of sound from thesubwoofer speaker.
Adjusts the bass.
Adjusts the treble.
Adjusts the front-to-backstrength of the sound.
Adjusts the side-to-side strength of the sound.
For information on FM/AM radiofrequencies and reception, seepage .
Press the SOUND button repeatedlyto display the SUBWOOFER (ifequipped), BASS, TREBLE, FADER,and BALANCE settings.
Each mode is shown in the display asit changes. Turn the VOLUME knobto adjust the setting to your liking.When the level reaches the center,you will see ‘‘ ’’ in the display.The system will automatically returnthe display to the selected audiomode about 10 seconds after youstop adjusting a mode.
165
To turn off auto select
If equipped
AUTO SELECT
SUBWOOFER
BASS
TREBLE
FADER
BALANCE
Adjusting the Sound
Playing the AM/FM Radio
162
12/08/09 16:20:56 31SJC670_169
2013 Ridgeline
Features
-
-In addition to the knobs, buttons,and bars on the radio control panel, you can operate some of theradio controls on the navigation system screen.
To adjust the sound, push theAUDIO button, then enter the soundgrid by touching the SOUND icon onthe display.
While you are listening to the radio,you can change to another band bypressing the AUDIO button next tothe navigation system screen, andthen touching the desired band icon(FM1, FM2, or AM).
AUTO SELECT, SCAN, and SOUNDare adjustable from the navigationscreen. For an explanation of thesefunctions, see pages and .
Touch theA.SEL icon to activate the auto selectfunction. You will see A.SEL flashingon the display.
Touch the SCAN icon toactivate the scan function. You willsee SCAN on the display. Touch theicon again to deactivate it.
161 162
CONTINUED
On models with navigation system
Operating the Radio on theNavigation System Screen
AUTO SELECT
SCAN
Adjusting the Sound
Playing the AM/FM Radio
163
AUDIO BUTTON
12/08/09 16:21:04 31SJC670_170
2013 Ridgeline
Features
-
--
+ -
These modes adjustthe strength of the sound comingfrom each speaker. Left/Rightbalance adjusts the side-to-sidestrength, while Front/Rear faderadjusts the front-to-back strength.To adjust the left/right balance,touch the ‘‘L’’ or ‘‘R’’ icon. To adjustthe front/rear fader, touch the ‘‘FR’’or ‘‘RR’’ icon.
The audio system can also beoperated by voice control. See thenavigation system manual forcomplete details.
To adjust the trebleand bass, touch or on eachside of the treble or bass adjustmentbar. The adjustment bar shows youthe current setting.
Adjusts thestrength of sound from thesubwoofer speaker.
To see the audio display when youare finished adjusting the sound,wait 5 seconds.
You can use the instrument panelbrightness control dial to adjust theillumination of the audio system (seepage ). The audio systemilluminates when the parking lightsare on, even if the radio is off.
98
On models with navigation systemLeft/Right Balance and Front/Rear Fader
Voice Control System
Treble/BassSUBWOOFER
Audio System Lighting
Playing the AM/FM Radio
164
12/08/09 16:21:11 31SJC670_171
2013 Ridgeline
Features
The radio can receive the completeAM and FM bands.Those bands cover thesefrequencies:
AM band: 530 to 1,710 kHzFM band: 87.7 to 107.9 MHz
Radio stations on the AM band areassigned frequencies at least 10 kHzapart (530, 540, 550). Stations on theFM band are assigned frequencies atleast 0.2 MHz apart (87.9, 88.1, 88.3). Driving very near the transmitter of
a station that is broadcasting on afrequency close to the frequency ofthe station you are listening to canalso affect your radio’s reception.You may temporarily hear bothstations, or hear only the station youare close to.
How well the radio receives stationsis dependent on many factors, suchas the distance from the station’stransmitter, nearby large objects,atmospheric conditions, and evenitems stored on the roof rack.
A radio station’s signal gets weakeras you get farther away from itstransmitter. If you are listening to anAM station, you will notice the soundvolume becoming weaker, and thestation drifting in and out. If you arelistening to an FM station, you willsee the stereo indicator flickering offand on as the signal weakens.Eventually, the stereo indicator willgo off and the sound will fadecompletely as you get out of range ofthe station’s signal.
Stations must use these exactfrequencies. It is fairly common forstations to round-off the frequency intheir advertising, so your radio coulddisplay a frequency of 100.9 eventhough the announcer may identifythe station as ‘‘FM101.’’
CONTINUED
Radio Frequencies Radio Reception
AM/FM Radio Reception
165
12/08/09 16:21:19 31SJC670_172
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Radio signals, especially on the FMband, are deflected by large objectssuch as buildings and hills. Yourradio then receives both the directsignal from the station’s transmitter,and the deflected signal. This causesthe sound to distort or flutter. This isa main cause of poor radio receptionin city driving.
Radio reception can be affected byatmospheric conditions such asthunderstorms, high humidity, andeven sunspots. You may be able toreceive a distant radio station oneday and not receive it the next daybecause of a change in conditions.
Electrical interference from passingvehicles and stationary sources cancause temporary reception problems.
This device complies with theappropriate requirements or therequired standards. See page formore information.
400
AM/FM Radio Reception
166
12/08/09 16:21:25 31SJC670_173
2013 Ridgeline
Features
CONTINUED
Playing the XM Radio
167
TUNE BARCATEGORY BAR
CATEGORY BAR PRESET BARS
SCANBUTTON
TUNE BAR
PRESET BARS
XM BUTTON
XM BUTTON
VOLUME KNOB
VOLUME KNOB
SCAN BUTTON
RTL and Touring models without navigation system RTL and Touring models with navigation system
PWR BUTTON
DISP/MODE BUTTON PWR BUTTON
DISP/MODE BUTTON
12/08/09 16:21:31 31SJC670_174
2013 Ridgeline
Features
-On the audio display, you will see theselected CHANNEL (number),CATEGORY, NAME (artist name),and TITLE (music title).
You may experience periods whenXM Radio does not transmit theartist’s name and song titleinformation. If this happens, there isnothing wrong with your system.
XM Radio receives signals from twosatellites to produce clear, high-quality digital reception. It offersmany channels in several categories.Along with a large selection ofdifferent types of music, XM Radioallows you to view channel andcategory selections in the display.The navigation system screen alsoshows all XM information when theAUDIO button is pressed.
To listen to XM radio, turn theignition switch to the ACCESSORY(I) or ON (II) position. Push thePWR button to turn on the audio
system, and press the XM button.Adjust the volume by turning thevolume knob. The last channel youlistened to will show in the display.
Each time you press and release theDISP/MODE button, the displaychanges in the following sequence:Channel name, channel number,category, artist name, and music title.
In channel mode, you can select allof the available channels. In categorymode, such as Jazz, Rock, Classical,etc., you can select all of thechannels within that category.
To switch betweenchannel mode and category mode,press and hold the DISP/MODEbutton until the mode changes.
You can also change to the XMRadio while you are listening to anFM station, AM station, CD, etc. bytouching the XM1 or XM2 icon onthe audio display (navigation system screen).
Your vehicle is capable of receivingXM Radio anywhere in the UnitedStates and Canada, except Hawaii,Alaska, and Puerto Rico. XM is aregistered trademark of Sirius XMRadio , Inc. and XM CANADA is aregistered business name ofCanadian Satellite Radio Inc.
On RTL and Touring models
Playing the XM Radio
Operating the XM Radio
MODE
168
On vehicles with navigation system
12/08/09 16:21:39 31SJC670_175
2013 Ridgeline
Features
-
-
-
-Press the TUNE bar tochange channel selections. Press
for higher numbered channelsand for lower numberedchannels. In the category mode,
Press either side of the CATEGORYbar ( or ) to select
The scan function gives
mode, only the channels within thatcategory are scanned. To activatescan, press the SCAN button ortouch the SCAN icon on the screen.The system plays each channel innumerical order for a few seconds,then selects the next channel. Whenyou hear a channel you wantto listen to, press the button ortouch the icon again.
You can store up to 12preset channels using each side ofthe preset bar or preset icons on thescreen. Each side of the bar storesone channel from the XM1 band andone channel from the XM2 band.
Pick a preset number (icon) youwant for that channel. Press andhold the bar (icon) until you heara beep.
Repeat steps 2 and 3 to store thefirst six channels.
Once a channel is stored, press andrelease the proper side of the presetbar (icon) to tune to it.
To store a channel:Press the XM button. Either XM1or XM2 will show in the display.
Use the tune, seek, or scanfunction to tune to a desiredchannel.
Press the XM button again ortouch the other XM icon (XM1 orXM2) on the audio display. Storethe next six channels using steps 2and 3.
In category mode, only channelswithin that category can beselected. In channel mode,all channels can be selected.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
TUNE
SEEK/SKIP (CATEGORY)
SCAN
Preset
Playing the XM Radio
169
12/08/09 16:21:49 31SJC670_176
2013 Ridgeline
Features
that category.you can only select channels within
another category.
you a sampling of all channels whilein the channel mode. In the category
-
-
-
-
-
-
XM is loading theaudio or program information.
The signal iscurrently too weak. Move the vehicleto an area away from tall buildings,and with an unobstructed view of thesouthern horizon.
The channelcurrently selected is no
The encryptioncode is being updated. Wait until theencryption code is fully updated.Channels 0 and 1 should still
The selected channelnumber does not exist, or is not partof your subscription, or this channelhas no artist or title information atthis time.
There is a problemwith the XM antenna. Please consultyour dealer.
XM Radio Display Messages
‘‘LOADING’’
‘‘NO SIGNAL’’
‘‘OFF AIR’’
‘‘UPDATING’’
‘‘ - - - - ’’
‘‘ANTENNA’’
Playing the XM Radio
170
12/08/09 16:21:54 31SJC670_177
2013 Ridgeline
Features
longer broadcasting.
work normally.
The XM satellites are in orbit overthe equator; therefore, objects southof the vehicle may cause satellitereception interruptions. To helpcompensate for this, ground-basedrepeaters are placed in majormetropolitan areas.
Satellite signals are more likely to beblocked by tall buildings andmountains the farther north youtravel from the equator. Carryinglarge items on a roof rack can alsoblock the signal.
CONTINUED
Playing the XM Radio
171
Signal may be blocked bymountains or large obstacles tothe south.
Signal weaker inthese areas.
SATELLITE
GROUND REPEATER
12/08/09 16:21:59 31SJC670_178
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Depending on where you drive, youmay experience reception problems.Interference can be caused by any ofthese conditions:
Driving on the north side of alarge commercial truck on aneast/west road.Driving in tunnels.Driving on a road beside a verticalwall, steep cliff, or hill to the southof you.Driving on the lower level of amulti-tiered road.Driving on a single lane roadalongside dense trees taller than50 ft. (15 m) to the south of you.
Driving on the north side of aneast/west mountain road.
Large items carried on a roof rack.
If your XM Radio service has expiredor you purchased your vehicle froma previous owner, you can listen to asampling of the broadcasts availableon XM Radio. With the ignitionswitch in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON(II) position, push the PWR button toturn on the audio system and pressthe XM button. A variety of musictypes and styles will play.
There may be other geographicsituations that could affect XM Radioreception.
This device complies with theappropriate requirements or therequired standards. See page formore information.
400
Playing the XM Radio
Receiving XM Radio Service
172
12/08/09 16:22:07 31SJC670_179
2013 Ridgeline
Features
If you decide to purchase XM Radioservice, contact XM Radio at
, or at1-800-852-9696. In Canada, contactXM CANADA at , orat 1-877-209-0079. You will need togive them your radio I.D. numberand your credit card number. To getyour radio I.D. number, press theTUNE bar until ‘‘0’’ appears in thedisplay. Your I.D. will appear in
After you’ve registered with XMRadio, keep your audio system in theXM radio mode while you wait foractivation. This should take about
While waiting for activation, makesure your vehicle remains in an openarea with good reception. Once youraudio system is activated, you’ll beable to listen to XM Radio broadcasts.XM Radio will continue to send anactivation signal to your vehicle forat least 12 hours from the activationrequest. If the service has not beenactivated after 36 hours, contactXM Radio. In Canada, contact
.
www.siriusxm.com
www.xmradio.ca
Playing the XM Radio
173
12/08/09 20:40:36 31SJC670_180
2013 Ridgeline
Features
the display.
30 minutes.
XM CANADA
You operate the CD player with thesame controls used for the radio. See
This audio system can also playCD-Rs and CD-RWs compressed inMP3 or WMA formats. Whenplaying a disc in MP3, you will see‘‘MP3’’ in the display. In WMAformat, ‘‘WMA’’ will appear in the display.
You can select up to 999 tracks/files.If the number of tracks/files is 1,000 or more, the system can notaccess them.When there are more than 99 foldersin a disc, the display only shows two digits.
You can select up to 400 tracks/filesin a disc.A disc can support a maximumnumber of 100 folders, and eachfolder can hold 255 playable files.
If you have a disc that is acombination of CD-DA tracks andMP3/WMA files, you can choose theformat to listen by pressing andholding CD/AUX or CD button untilyou hear a beep.
If a file on an MP3 or WMA disc isprotected by digital rightsmanagement (DRM), the audio unitdisplays UNSUPPORTED(UNSUPPORT on models withnavigation system), and then skips tothe next file.
Video CDs and DVDs do not work inthis unit.
Depending on the software the fileswere made with, it may not bepossible to play some files, or displaysome text data.
You operate the CD changer withthe same controls used for the radio.
For models without navigationsystem, see pages through .
For models with navigation system,see pages through .
175
188
197189
181
On models without navigation system
On models with navigation system
On RTS, RTL, and Touring models
On RT, DX, VP, and Sport models
Playing CDs
174
NOTE:
12/08/09 20:40:45 31SJC670_181
2013 Ridgeline
Features
operation information.See page for the CD player
You operate the disc playerwith the same controls used for theradio. To select the disc player,press the CD button. You will see‘‘CD’’ in the display.
To load or play a disc, the ignitionswitch must be in the ACCESSORY(I) or ON (II) position.
CONTINUED
On RT, DX, VP, and Sport modelsTo Play a Disc
CD Player
175
CD SLOT EJECT BUTTON
TUNE/FOLDER BAR
AM/FMBUTTON
CD BUTTON
PWR BUTTON
SCAN BUTTON
SEEK/SKIP BAR PRESET BARS
DISPBUTTON
RPTBUTTON
RDMBUTTON
RT, DX, VP, and Sport models
Do not use discs with adhesive labels.The label can curl up and cause thedisc to jam in the unit.
12/08/09 16:22:27 31SJC670_182
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Each time you press the DISP button,the display shows you the text dataon a disc, if the disc was recordedwith text data.
You can see the album, artist, andtrack name in the display. If a disc isrecorded in MP3 or WMA, you cansee the folder and file name, and theartist, album, and track tag.
When you press and release theDISP button while a disc without textdata is playing, you will see ‘‘NOINFO’’ on the display.
The display shows up to about 16characters of selected text data (thefolder name, file name, etc.). If thetext data has more than 17characters, you will see the first 15characters and the indicator inthe display. Press and hold the DISPbutton until the next 16 charactersare shown. You can see up to 31characters of the text data.
If you press and hold the DISPbutton again, the display shows thefirst 15 characters again.
Insert a disc about halfway into thedisc slot. The drive will pull the discin the rest of the way to play it. Youoperate the disc player with thesame controls used for the radio.The number of the current track isshown in the display. When playing adisc in MP3 or WMA, the numbersof the current folder and file areshown. The system will continuouslyplay a disc until you change modes.
If any letter is not available, it isreplaced with ‘‘ . ’’ (dot) in the display.When the disc has no text data, youwill see ‘‘NO INFO’’ on the display.
For information on how to handleand protect compact discs, see
To Load a Disc Text Data Display Function
CD Player
176
12/08/09 16:22:35 31SJC670_183
2013 Ridgeline
Features
page 198 .
-
-You will also see some text dataunder these conditions:
When a new folder, file, or track isselected.
When you change the audio modeto play a disc with text data or inMP3 or WMA.
When you insert a disc, and thesystem begins to play.
When playing a CD-DA with textdata, the album and track name areshown in the display. With a disc inMP3 or WMA, the display shows thefolder and file name.
You can use the SEEK/SKIP barwhile a disc is playing to selectpassages and change tracks (files inMP3/WMA mode).
Each time you press andrelease the side of the SEEK/SKIP bar, the player skips forward tothe beginning of the next track (filein MP3 or WMA mode). Press andrelease the side, to skipbackward to the beginning of thecurrent track. Press it again to skipto the beginning of the previoustrack.
To move rapidly within a track, pressand hold the or side of theSEEK/SKIP bar.
Toselect a different folder, press eitherside of the TUNE/FOLDER bar.Press the side of the bar to skipto the next folder, and the sideof the bar to skip to the beginning ofthe previous folder.
In MP3 or WMA mode
CONTINUED
To Change or Select Tracks/Files
SKIP
FOLDER SELECTION
CD Player
177
12/08/09 16:22:44 31SJC670_184
2013 Ridgeline
Features
- - -In MP3 or WMA mode
To continuously replaya track (files in MP3 or WMA mode),press and release the RPT button.You will see ‘‘RPT’’ in the display.Press and hold the RPT button for 2seconds to turn it off.
This feature,when activated, replays all files onthe selected folder in the order theyare compressed. To activate folderrepeat, press the RPT button twice.You will see ‘‘ RPT’’ in thedisplay. The system continuouslyreplays the current folder. Press theRPT button again to turn it off.Pressing the RDM button, orselecting a different folder with theTUNE/FOLDER bar also turns offthe repeat feature.
Each time you press and release theRPT button, the mode changes fromfile repeat to folder repeat, then tonormal play.
This feature plays thetracks within a disc (the files in MP3or WMA mode) in random order. Toactivate random play, press andrelease the RDM button. In MP3 orWMA mode, press the RDM buttonrepeatedly to select RDM (within adisc random play). You will see‘‘RDM’’ in the display. Press theRDM button for 2 seconds to returnto normal play.
REPEAT (TRACK/FILEREPEAT) FOLDER-REPEAT
RANDOM (Random within adisc)
CD Player
178
12/08/09 16:22:49 31SJC670_185
2013 Ridgeline
Features
-- -
In MP3 or WMA modeIn MP3 or WMA mode
The system plays the first file in thefirst folder for about 10 seconds. Ifyou do nothing, the system will thenplay the first files in the next foldersfor 10 seconds. After playing the firstfile in the last folder, the systemplays normally.
The scan function samples all tracks(files in MP3 or WMA) on the disc inthe order they are recorded on thedisc. To activate scan, press andrelease the SCAN button. You willsee SCAN in the display. You will geta 10 second sampling of each track/file on the disc. Press and hold theSCAN button until you hear a beepto get out of scan mode and play thelast track/file sampled.
Thisfeature, when activated, plays allfiles on the selected folder in randomorder. To activate folder random,press the RDM button. You will see‘‘ RDM’’ in the display. Thesystem will then select and play filesrandomly. This continues until youdeactivate folder random by pressingand holding the RDM button again,or by selecting a different folder withthe FOLDER bar.
Each time you press and release theRDM button, the mode changesfrom folder random play to randomplay (within a disc random play),then to normal play.
Pressing either side of the SEEK/SKIP bar also turns off the scanfeature.
This feature,when activated, samples the first fileof each folder on the disc. Toactivate folder scan, press the SCANbutton twice. You will see‘‘ SCAN’’ in the display.
Pressing either side of the SEEK/SKIP bar, selecting a different folderwith the TUNE/FOLDER bar, orpressing the SCAN button, also turnsoff the folder scan.
Each time you press and release theSCAN button, the mode changesfrom file scan to folder scan, then tonormal play.
SCAN (TRACK/FILE SCAN)FOLDER-RANDOM FOLDER SCAN
CD Player
179
12/08/09 16:22:56 31SJC670_186
2013 Ridgeline
Features
-+
You can also eject the disc when theignition switch is off.
Press the eject button ( ) toremove the disc. If you eject the disc,but do not remove it from the slot,the system will automatically reloadthe disc after 10 seconds. To beginplaying, press the CD button.
To play the radio when a disc isplaying, press the AM/FM button.Press the CD button again to switchback to the CD player.
If you turn the system off while adisc is playing, either with the PWRbutton or by turning off the ignitionswitch, the disc will stay in the drive.When you turn the system back on,the disc will begin playing where itleft off.
To select the CD changer, press theAUX button. The disc and tracknumbers will be displayed. To selecta different disc, use the preset 5(DISC ) side for a previous disc orthe preset 6 (DISC ) side to selectthe next disc in sequence.
If you select an empty slot in themagazine, the changer will searchfor the next available CD to load andplay.
For information on how to handleand protect compact discs, seepage 198.
To Stop Playing a Disc
Protecting Discs
CD Player
180
12/08/09 16:23:04 31SJC670_187
2013 Ridgeline
Features
CONTINUED
CD Changer (Models without navigation system)
181
AM/FMBUTTON
PRESET BARS
SCANBUTTON
TUNE/FOLDER BAR
CD SLOT
CD BUTTON
SEEK/SKIP BAR
CD/AUX BUTTON
TUNE/FOLDER BAR
AM/FMBUTTON
LOAD BUTTON LOAD BUTTON
PWR BUTTON
SCANBUTTON
PWR BUTTONEJECT BUTTON EJECT BUTTON
SEEK/SKIP BAR PRESET BARS
CD SLOT
RTS model RTL and Touring models without navigation system
DISPBUTTON
RPTBUTTON
RDM BUTTON RDM BUTTON
RPTBUTTON
DISPBUTTON
12/08/09 16:23:12 31SJC670_188
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Your vehicle’s in-dash disc changerholds up to six discs.
To load or play discs, the ignitionswitch must be in the ACCESSORY(I) or ON (II) position.
You operate the disc changer withthe same controls used for the radio.To select the disc changer, press theCD or CD/AUX button. You will see‘‘CD’’ in the display. The disc andtrack numbers, and the elapsed timeare shown in the display. You canalso select the displayed informationwith the DISP button (see page ).The system will continuously play adisc until you change modes.
When ‘‘LOAD’’ appears again onthe display, insert the next CD intothe CD slot.
Do not try to insert a disc until‘‘LOAD’’ appears. You coulddamage the audio unit.
Repeat this until all six positionsare loaded. The system will thenbegin playing the last CD loaded.
Insert a CD into the CD slot.Insert it only about halfway; thedrive will pull it in the rest of theway. You will see ‘‘BUSY’’ in thedisplay. The CD load indicatorturns red and blinks as the CD
You cannot load and play 3-inch(8-cm) discs in this system.
On the upper right side of thedisplay, the disc number for anempty position blinks, and thegreen CD load indicator comes on.
To load only one CD, press andrelease the LOAD button.
Press and hold the LOAD buttonuntil you hear a beep and see‘‘LOAD’’ in the display, thenrelease the button.
3.
4.
5.
1.
2.
183
On RTS, RTL, and Touring modelswithout navigation system
CD Changer (Models without navigation system)
Loading Discs
To Play a Disc
182
Do not use discs with adhesive labels.The label can curl up and cause thedisc to jam in the unit.
12/08/09 16:23:22 31SJC670_189
2013 Ridgeline
Features
is loaded.
CONTINUED
If the text data has more than 17characters, you will see the first 15characters and the indicator inthe display. Press and hold the DISPbutton until the next 16 charactersare shown. You can see up to 31characters of the text data.
If you press and hold the DISPbutton again, the display shows thefirst 15 characters again.
If any letter is not available, it isreplaced with ‘‘ . ’’ (dot) in the display.When the disc has no text data, youwill see ‘‘NO INFO’’ on the display.
You will also see some text dataunder these conditions:
When a new folder, file, or track isselected.
Each time you press the DISP button,the display shows you the text dataon a disc, if the disc was recordedwith text data.
You can see the album, artist, andtrack name in the display. If a disc isrecorded in MP3 or WMA, you cansee the folder and file name, and thealbum, artist, and track tag.
With the folder name, you will seethe FOLDER indicator in the display.The TRACK indicator is shown withthe file or track name.
When you press and release theDISP button while a disc without textdata is playing, you will see ‘‘NOINFO’’ on the display.
The display shows up to 16characters of selected text data (thefolder name, file name, etc.).
If you are not loading CDs into all sixpositions, press the LOAD buttonagain after the last CD has loaded.The system will begin playing thelast CD loaded.
If you stop loading CDs before all sixpositions are filled, the system willwait for 10 seconds, then stop theload operation and begin playing thelast CD loaded.
CD Changer (Models without navigation system)
Text Data Display Function
183
12/08/09 16:23:31 31SJC670_190
2013 Ridgeline
Features
- Each time you press andrelease the side of the SEEK/SKIP bar, the player skips forward tothe beginning of the next track (filein MP3 or WMA mode). Press andrelease the side, to skipbackward to the beginning of thecurrent track. Press it again to
To move rapidly within a track or file,press and hold either side ( or
) of the SEEK/SKIP bar.
Use the SEEK/SKIP bar while a discis playing to select passages andchange tracks (files in MP3 or
In MP3 or WMA mode, use theTUNE/FOLDER bar to selectfolders in the disc and use eitherside of the SEEK/SKIP bar tochange files.
To select a different disc, use theappropriate preset buttons (1through 6). If you select an emptyposition, the system will go into theloading sequence (see page ).
When you insert a disc, and thesystem begins to play.
When you change the audio modeto play a disc with text data or inMP3 or WMA.
When playing a CD-DA with textdata, the album and track name areshown in the display. With a disc inMP3 or WMA, the display shows thefolder and file name.
182
CD Changer (Models without navigation system)
SKIPTo Change or Select Tracks/Files
184
12/08/09 16:23:38 31SJC670_191
2013 Ridgeline
Features
WMA mode).
previous track.skip to the beginning of the
-
-
--This feature
continuously replays the current disc.To activate disc repeat, press andrelease the RPT button repeatedlyuntil you see ‘‘ RPT’’ in thedisplay. Press and hold the RPTbutton again to turn it off.
Each time you press and release theRPT button, the mode changes fromfile repeat to folder repeat, to discrepeat then to normal playing.
This feature,when activated, replays all the fileson the selected folder in the orderthey are compressed in MP3 orWMA. To activate folder repeatmode, press and release the RPTbutton repeatedly until you see‘‘ RPT’’ in the display. Thesystem continuously replays thecurrent folder. Press and hold theRPT button to turn it off. Pressingthe RDM button, or selecting adifferent folder with the TUNE/FOLDER bar also turns off therepeat feature.
To continuously replaya track (files in MP3 or WMA mode),press and release the RPT button.You will see ‘‘RPT’’ in the display.Press and hold the RPT button for 2seconds to turn it off.
Toselect a different folder, press eitherside of the TUNE/FOLDER bar.Press the side of the bar to skipto the next folder, and the sideof the bar to skip to the beginning ofthe previous folder.
In MP3 or WMA mode
In MP3 or WMA mode
CONTINUED
CD Changer (Models without navigation system)
DISC REPEAT
FOLDER REPEAT
REPEAT (TRACK/FILEREPEAT)FOLDER SELECTION
185
12/08/09 16:23:45 31SJC670_192
2013 Ridgeline
Features
---
The SCAN functionsamples all the tracks on the disc inthe order they are recorded on thedisc (all files in the current folder inMP3 or WMA mode). To activate thescan feature, press and release theSCAN button. You will see ‘‘SCAN’’in the display. You will get a 10second sampling of each track/file inthe disc/folder. Press and hold theSCAN button to get out of scanmode and play the last track sampled.
Thisfeature, when activated, plays thefiles within a current folder inrandom order, rather than in theorder they are compressed in MP3or WMA. To activate folder randomplay, press and release the RDMbutton repeatedly. You will see‘‘ RDM’’ in the display. Thesystem will then select and play filesrandomly. This continues until youdeactivate folder random play bypressing and holding the RDMbutton again, or you select adifferent folder with the TUNE/FOLDER bar.
This feature plays thetracks within a disc (the files in MP3or WMA mode) in random order. Toactivate random play, press andrelease the RDM button. In MP3 orWMA mode, press the RDM buttonrepeatedly to select RDM (within adisc random play). You will see‘‘RDM’’ in the display. Press theRDM button for 2 seconds to returnto normal play.
Each time you press and releasethe RDM button, the modechanges from folder random play,to within a disc random play,then to normal play.
In MP3 or WMA mode SCANFOLDER RANDOM
RANDOM (Random within adisc)
CD Changer (Models without navigation system)
186
12/08/09 16:23:50 31SJC670_193
2013 Ridgeline
Features
--
When the first track in the last disc,or the first file in the last main folderin the last disc begins to play, thedisc scan mode will be canceled.Pressing either side of the SEEK/SKIP bar or selecting a differentfolder with the TUNE/FOLDER baralso turns off the scan feature.
Each time you press and releasethe SCAN button, the modechanges from scan, disc scan,then to normal play.
Each time you press and release theSCAN button, the mode changesfrom file scan, folder scan, disc scan,then to normal play.
This feature, whenactivated, samples the first track ineach disc in order (the first file inthe main folder on each disc in MP3or WMA mode). To activate the discscan feature, press and release theSCAN button repeatedly until‘‘ SCAN’’ shows in the display.The system will then play the firsttrack/file in the first main folder inthe first disc for about 10 seconds. Ifyou do nothing, the system will thenplay the following first tracks/filesfor 10 seconds each. When it plays atrack/file that you want to continuelistening to, press and hold theSCAN button again.
This feature,when activated, samples the first filein each folder on the disc in theorder they are recorded. To activatethe folder scan feature, press andrelease the SCAN button repeatedly.You will see ‘‘ SCAN’’ in thedisplay. The system will then playthe first file in the main folders forabout 10 seconds. If you do nothing,the system will then play thefollowing first files for 10 secondseach. When it plays a file that youwant to continue listening to, pressand hold the SCAN button.
Pressing either side of the SEEK/SKIP bar, or selecting a differentdisc (using the preset buttons) orfolder (using the TUNE/FOLDERbar) turns off the SCAN or
In MP3 or WMA mode
In MP3 or WMA mode DISC SCANFOLDER SCAN
CD Changer (Models without navigation system)
187
12/08/09 16:23:57 31SJC670_194
2013 Ridgeline
Features
F-SCAN feature.
To remove the disc currently in play,press the eject button ( ). Whena disc is removed from a slot, thesystem automatically begins the loadsequence so you can load anotherdisc in that position. If you do notremove the disc from the changerwithin 10 seconds, the disc willreload into the slot. Then the systemreturns to the previous mode [AM,FM, or XM (if equipped)].
To remove a different disc from thechanger, first select it with theappropriate preset bar. When thatdisc begins playing, press the ejectbutton. Continue pressing the ejectbutton to remove all the discs fromthe changer.
Press the eject button ( ) toremove the disc. If you eject thedisc, but do not remove it from theslot, the system will automaticallyreload the disc after 10 seconds.To begin playing, press the CD orCD/AUX button.
You can also eject the disc when theignition switch is off.
To play the radio when a disc isplaying, press the AM/FM or XM (ifequipped) button. Press the CD(CD/AUX on models with XMsatellite radio) button again to switchback to the CD changer.
If you turn the system off while adisc is playing, either with the PWRbutton or by turning off the ignitionswitch, the disc will stay in thedrive. When you turn the system back on, the disc will begin playing where it left off.
For information on how to handleand protect compact discs, seepage .
You can also eject discs when theignition switch is on or off:
To eject one disc, press and releasethe eject button.
To eject all discs, press and hold theeject button until the LOADindicator begins to blink.
198
Removing Discs from the In-dashDisc Changer
To Stop Playing a Disc
Protecting Discs
CD Changer (Models without navigation system)
188
12/08/09 16:24:06 31SJC670_195
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Your audio system has an in-dashCD changer that holds up to six CDs,providing several hours ofcontinuous entertainment. Youoperate this CD changer with thesame controls used for the radio.
To load CDs or operate the CDchanger, the ignition switch must bein the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II)position.
CONTINUED
On RTL and Touring models withnavigation system
CD Changer (Models with navigation system)
To Play a Disc
189
SEEK/SKIP BAR
AM/FM BUTTON
SCANBUTTON
LOAD INDICATOR
LOAD BUTTON EJECT BUTTONCD SLOT
PRESET BARS
RTL and Touring models with navigation system
DISP BUTTON
RPTBUTTON
RDM BUTTON
Do not use CDs with adhesive labels.The label can curl up and cause the CDto jam in the unit.
12/08/09 16:24:14 31SJC670_196
2013 Ridgeline
Features
The CD changer is behind thenavigation system screen. To use theCD changer, press the OPEN buttonbeside the screen. The screen foldsback, and the CD changer appears.
Be careful not to injure your fingerswhen opening or closing thenavigation system screen.
Press and hold the LOAD buttonnext to the CD slot until the loadindicator above the slot turns fromamber to green.
To load only one CD, press andrelease the LOAD button.
To return the screen to the uprightposition, press the OPEN buttonagain. Do not use the folded screenas a tray. If you put a cup, forexample, on the screen, the liquidinside the cup may spill on thescreen when you go over a bump.
1.
CD Changer (Models with navigation system)
Loading Discs
190
LOAD BUTTON LOAD INDICATOR
CD SLOT
OPEN BUTTON
12/08/09 16:24:21 31SJC670_197
2013 Ridgeline
Features
The indicators above the discbuttons of the empty positions willblink, and the green load indicatorabove the CD slot comes on.
If you press the LOAD button whilea CD is playing, the system will stopplaying that CD and start the loadingsequence. It will then play the CDjust loaded.
Repeat this until all six positionsare loaded. The system will thenbegin playing the first CD loaded.
If you stop loading CDs before all sixpositions are filled, the system willwait for 10 seconds, then stop theload operation and begin playing thelast CD loaded.
You can also load a CD into an emptyposition while a CD is playing bypressing the appropriate disc button.Select an empty disc button (theindicator above the button is off),and press the button. The systemwill stop playing the current CD andstart the loading sequence. It willthen play the CD just loaded.
You cannot load and play 3-inch(8-cm) discs in this system.
Do not try to insert a disc until‘‘LOAD’’ appears. You coulddamage the audio unit.
Insert a CD into the CD slot.Insert it only about halfway; thedrive will pull it in the rest of theway. You will see ‘‘BUSY’’ in thedisplay. The CD load indicatorturns amber and blinks as the CDis loaded.
When ‘‘LOAD’’ appears again onthe display, insert the next CD intothe CD slot.
Each time you press the DISP button,the display shows you the text dataon a disc, if the disc was recordedwith text data.
You can see the album, artist, andtrack name in the display. If a disc isrecorded in MP3 or WMA, you cansee the folder and file name, and thealbum, artist, and track tag.
With the folder name, you will seethe FOLD indicator in the display.The TRACK indicator is shown withthe file or track name.
When you press and release theDISP button while a disc without textdata is playing, you will see ‘‘NOINFO’’ on the display.
2.
3.
4.
5.
CONTINUED
CD Changer (Models with navigation system)
Text Data Display Function
191
12/08/09 16:24:31 31SJC670_198
2013 Ridgeline
Features
->
You will also see some text dataunder these conditions:
When a new folder, file, or track isselected.
When you change the audio modeto play a disc with text data or inMP3 or WMA.
When you insert a disc, and thesystem begins to play.
When playing a CD-DA with textdata, the album and track name areshown in the display. With a disc inMP3 or WMA, the display shows thefolder and file name.
You can use the SEEK/SKIP barwhile a disc is playing to selectpassages and change tracks (files inMP3/WMA mode).
Each time you press andrelease the side of the SEEK/SKIP bar, the player skips forward tothe beginning of the next track (filein MP3 or WMA mode). Press andrelease the side, to skipbackward to the beginning of thecurrent track. Press it again to skipto the beginning of the previoustrack.
To move rapidly within a track, pressand hold the or SKIP bar.
The display shows up to 16characters of selected text data (thefolder name, file name, etc.).
If the text data has more than 17characters, you will see the first 15characters and the indicator inthe display. Press and hold the DISPbutton until the next 16 charactersare shown. You can see up to 31characters of the text data.
If you press and hold the DISPbutton again, the display shows thefirst 15 characters again.
If any letter is not available, it isreplaced with ‘‘ . ’’ (dot) in the display.When the disc has no text data, youwill see ‘‘NO INFO’’ on the display.
To Change or Select Tracks/Files
SKIP
CD Changer (Models with navigation system)
192
12/08/09 16:24:40 31SJC670_199
2013 Ridgeline
Features
-
--
-
-
Each time you press and release theRPT button, the mode changes fromfile repeat to folder repeat, to discrepeat then to normal playing.
This feature plays thetracks within a disc (the files in MP3or WMA mode) in random order. Toactivate random play, press andrelease the RDM button or touch theTRACK RANDOM icon on thescreen. In MP3 or WMA mode, pressthe RDM button repeatedly to selectRDM (within a disc random play).You will see ‘‘RDM’’ in the display.Press the RDM button or touch theTRACK RANDOM icon to return tonormal play.
This feature,when activated, replays all the fileson the selected folder in the orderthey are compressed in MP3 orWMA. To activate folder repeatmode, press and release the RPTbutton repeatedly until you see‘‘F-RPT’’ in the display. The systemcontinuously replays the currentfolder. Press and hold the RPTbutton to turn it off. Pressing theRDM button, or selecting a differentfolder with the TUNE bar also turnsoff the repeat feature.
Toselect a different folder, press eitherside of the TUNE bar. Press the
side to skip to the next folder,and press the side to skip to thebeginning of the previous folder.
To continuously replaya track (file in MP3 or WMA mode),press and release the RPT button ortouch the TRACK REPEAT icon onthe screen. You will see ‘‘RPT’’ in thedisplay. Press and hold the RPTbutton, or touch the TRACKREPEAT icon again to turn it off. This feature
continuously replays the current disc.To activate disc repeat, press andrelease the RPT button repeatedlyuntil you see ‘‘D-RPT’’ in the display,or touch the DISC REPEAT icon onthe screen. Press and hold the RPTbutton, or touch the DISC REPEATicon again to turn it off.
In MP3 or WMA mode In MP3 or WMA mode
CONTINUED
CD Changer (Models with navigation system)
RANDOM (Random within adisc)
FOLDER REPEATFOLDER SELECTION
REPEAT (TRACK/FILEREPEAT)
DISC REPEAT
193
12/08/09 16:24:47 31SJC670_200
2013 Ridgeline
Features
---
This feature, whenactivated, samples the first file ineach folder on the disc in the orderthey are recorded. To activate thefolder scan feature, press andrelease the SCAN button repeatedly.You will see ‘‘F-SCAN’’ in the display.The system will then play the firstfile in the main folders for about 10seconds. If you do nothing, thesystem will then play the first file ineach folder for 10 seconds. When itplays a file that you want to continuelistening to, press and hold theSCAN button.
Pressing either side of the SEEK/SKIP bar, or selecting a differentdisc (using the preset buttons) orfolder (using the TUNE bar) turnsoff the SCAN or F-SCAN feature.
Thisfeature, when activated, plays thefiles within a current folder inrandom order, rather than in theorder they are compressed in MP3or WMA. To activate folder randomplay, press and release the RDMbutton repeatedly. You will see‘‘F-RDM’’ in the display. The systemwill then select and play filesrandomly. This continues until youdeactivate folder random play bypressing and holding the RDMbutton again, or you select adifferent folder with the TUNE bar.
Each time you press and releasethe RDM button, the modechanges from folder random play,to within a disc random play,then to normal play.
The SCAN functionsamples all the tracks on the disc inthe order they are recorded on thedisc (all files in the selected folder inMP3 or WMA mode). To activate thescan feature, press and release theSCAN button or touch the TRACKSCAN icon on the screen. You willsee ‘‘SCAN’’ in the display. You willget a 10 second sampling of eachtrack/file in the disc/folder. Pressand hold the SCAN button or touchthe TRACK SCAN icon again to getout of scan mode and play the lasttrack sampled.
In MP3 or WMA modeIn MP3 or WMA mode
CD Changer (Models with navigation system)
F-SCANFOLDER RANDOMSCAN
194
12/08/09 16:24:52 31SJC670_201
2013 Ridgeline
Features
-
CONTINUED
Each time you press and releasethe SCAN button, the modechanges from scan, disc scan,then to normal play.
Each time you press and release theSCAN button, the mode changesfrom file scan, folder scan, disc scan,then to normal play.
When the first track in the last disc,or the first file in the last main folderin the last disc begins to play, thedisc scan mode will be canceled.Pressing either side of the SEEK/SKIP bar or selecting a differentfolder with the TUNE bar also turnsoff the scan feature.
You can also select a track/filedirectly from a track list on the audiodisplay. Touch the TRACK LISTicon. The track list menu appears onthe audio display.
When playing a CD recorded withtext data, each track name is shownon the audio display. With a discrecorded in MP3 or WMA, the foldernumber and the location are
This feature, whenactivated, samples the first track ineach disc in order (the first file inthe main folder on each disc in MP3or WMA mode). To activate the discscan feature, press and release theSCAN button repeatedly until‘‘D-SCAN’’ shows in the display, ortouch the DISC SCAN icon on thescreen. The system will then play thefirst track/file in the first mainfolder in the first disc for about 10seconds. If you do nothing, thesystem will then play the followingfirst track/file for 10 seconds each.When it plays a track/file that youwant to continue listening to, pressand hold the SCAN button or touchthe DISC SCAN icon again.
In MP3 or WMA mode
CD Changer (Models with navigation system)
Using a Track ListD-SCAN
195
FOLDER ICON TRACK FILE ICON
FOLDER NUMBER RETURN ICON
12/08/09 16:25:00 31SJC670_202
2013 Ridgeline
Features
also displayed.
▲ ▼
To remove the disc that is currentlyplaying, press the eject button. Youwill see ‘‘EJECT’’ in the display.When you remove the disc from theslot, the system begins the loadsequence so you can load anotherdisc in that position. If you do notload another CD within 10 seconds,the system selects the previousmode (AM, FM1, FM2, or
To remove the disc from thechanger, first select it by pressingthe appropriate preset bar orcorresponding number on the screen.When that disc begins playing, pressthe eject button.
To take the system out of CD mode,press the AM/FM button or XMbutton. Each time you press theAM/FM button, the system changesto the next mode (AM, FM1, or FM2). When you return to CD mode bypressing the CD/AUX button, playwill continue where it left off.
If you turn the system off while a CDis playing, either with the PWRbutton or the ignition switch, playwill continue at the same point whenyou turn it back on.
If the disc was not recorded with textdata, only the track number is shown.
To scroll through the display, touchthe or icon on the side ofthe display. To go back to theprevious display, touch the Returnicon on the display.
Select the desired track/file bytouching the icon on the display. Theselected icon will be highlighted inblue. The system begins to play theselected track/file. With a disc inMP3 or WMA, touch the folder iconon the upper left of the screen tomove to the parent folder. Thecurrent folder is highlighted in blue.
Removing CDs from the In-dashCD Changer
To Stop Playing a Disc
CD Changer (Models with navigation system)
196
12/08/09 16:25:06 31SJC670_203
2013 Ridgeline
Features
XM Radio).
When you press the eject buttonwhile listening to the radio, or withthe audio system turned off, the discthat was last selected is ejected.After that disc is ejected, pressingthe eject button again will eject thenext disc in numerical order. Bydoing this six times, you can removeall the discs from the changer.
To eject one disc, press and releasethe eject button.
You can also eject discs when theignition switch is on or off:
To eject all discs, press and hold theeject button until the LOADindicator begins to blink.
For information on how to handleand protect discs, see page .198
CD Changer (Models with navigation system)
Protecting Discs
197
12/08/09 16:25:12 31SJC670_204
2013 Ridgeline
Features
When a CD is not being played, storeit in its case to protect it from dustand other contamination. To preventwarpage, keep CDs out of directsunlight and extreme heat.
To clean a CD, use a clean soft cloth.Wipe across the CD from the centerto the outside edge.
A new CD may be rough on theinner and outer edges. The smallplastic pieces causing this roughnesscan flake off and fall on the re-cording surface of the CD, causingskipping or other problems. Removethese pieces by rubbing the innerand outer edges with the side of apencil or pen.
Handle a CD by its edges; nevertouch either surface. Do not placestabilizer rings or labels on the CD.These, along with contaminationfrom fingerprints, liquids, and felt-tippens, can cause the CD to not playproperly or possibly jam in the drive.
Never try to insert foreign objects inthe CD player or the CD changer.
When using CD-R or CD-RW discs,use only high quality CDs labeledfor audio use.
When recording a CD-R orCD-RW, the recording must beclosed for it to be used by thesystem.
Play only standard round CDs.Odd-shaped CDs may jam in thedrive or cause other problems.
Handle your CDs properly toprevent damage and skipping.
General Information Protecting CDs
Protecting Your CDs
198
12/08/09 16:25:20 31SJC670_205
2013 Ridgeline
Features
The in-dash disc player/changer hasa sophisticated and delicatemechanism. If you insert a damageddisc as indicated in this section, itmay become stuck inside anddamage the audio unit.
Examples of these discs are shownto the right:
Bubbled, wrinkled, labeled, and excessively thick discs1.
CONTINUED
Additional Information onRecommended Discs
Protecting Your CDs
199
Using Printer Label KitBubbled/Wrinkled
With Plastic Ring
With Label/Sticker
Sealed
12/08/09 16:25:28 31SJC670_206
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Small, irregular shaped discsDamaged discs Poor quality discs 4.2. 3.
Protecting Your CDs
200
3-inch (8-cm) CD Triangle Shape
Arrow ShapeCan Shape
WarpedChipped/Cracked
Burrs
12/08/09 16:25:36 31SJC670_207
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Discs with scratches, dirty discs
CD-R or CD-RW may not play dueto the recording conditions.
Scratches and fingerprints on thediscs may cause the sound to skip.
Recommended discs are printedwith the following logo.
Audio unit may not play thefollowing formats.
This audio unit cannot play a Dual-disc .
5.
Protecting Your CDs
201
Fingerprints, scratches, etc.
12/08/09 16:25:46 31SJC670_208
2013 Ridgeline
Features
*
*
*
*
*
*
**
The chart on the right explains theerror messages you may see in thedisplay while playing a disc.
If you see an error message in thedisplay while playing a disc, pressthe eject button. After ejecting thedisc, check it for damage ordeformation. If there is no damage,insert the disc again.For additional information ondamaged discs, see page .
The audio system will try to play thedisc. If there is still a problem, theerror message will reappear. Pressthe eject button, and pull out the disc.
Insert a different disc. If the newdisc plays, there is a problem withthe first disc. If the error messagecycle repeats and you cannot clear it,take your vehicle to a dealer.
CauseError Message Solution
199
High Temperature
Track/File format notsupported
Mechanical Error
Servo Error
Disc Error
Will disappear when the temperature returns tonormal.Current track will be skipped. The nextsupported track or file plays automatically.Press the EJECT button and pull out the disc(s).Check the disc for serious damage, signs ofdeformation, excessive scratches, and/or dirt(see page 199). Insert the disc again. If the codedoes not disappear, or the disc(s) cannot beremoved, consult your dealer. Do not try toforce the disc out the player.
Check the disc for serious damage, signs ofdeformation, excessive scratches, and/or dirt(see page 199).
On models without navigation systemOn models with navigation system
1 :2 :
CD Player/Changer Error Messages
202
HEAT ERRORHOT
UNSUPPORTEDUNSUPPORT
BAD DISCPLEASE CHECK
OWNER’SMANUAL
PUSH EJECTMECH ERROR
CHANGER ERRORCHK DISC LOAD
BAD DISCPLEASE CHECK
OWNER’SMANUAL
CHECK DISCDISC ERROR
1
2
1
2
1
2
12/08/09 16:25:53 31SJC670_209
2013 Ridgeline
Features
+
-
+ -
▲ ▼
Three controls for the audio systemare mounted in the steering wheelhub. These let you control basicfunctions without removing yourhand from the wheel.
If you are listening to the radio, usethe CH button to change stations.Each time you press the top ( ) ofthe button, the system goes to thenext preset station on the band youare listening to. Press the bottom( ) to go back to the previousstation.
To search up and down from thecurrent frequency and find a stationwith a strong signal, press the top( ) or bottom ( ) of the button for1 second.
The VOL button adjusts the volumeup ( ) or down ( ). Press the topor bottom of the button, hold it untilthe desired volume is reached, thenrelease it.
The MODE button changes themode. Pressing the buttonrepeatedly selects FM1, FM2, AM,XM1, XM2 (if equipped), CD (if adisc is loaded), or AUX-Audio.
CONTINUED
On RTS, RTL, Touring,and Sport models
Remote Audio Controls
203
MODE BUTTON
CH BUTTONVOL BUTTON
12/08/09 16:25:59 31SJC670_210
2013 Ridgeline
Features
+-
+-
+
-
+
-
+-
If you are playing a disc, the systemskips to the beginning of the nexttrack each time you press the top( ) of the CH button. Press thebottom ( ) to return to thebeginning of the current track. Pressit again to return to the previoustrack. You will see the disc and tracknumbers in the upper display.
To go to the next disc, press the top( ) of the button for 1 second.Press the bottom ( ) for 1 secondto go back to the previous disc.
When you play an MP3/WMA disc,press the top ( ) of the button for 1second to go to the next folder. Pressthe bottom ( ) for 1 second to goback to the previous folder.
If you are listening to XM Radio, usethe CH button to change channels.Each time you press the top ( ) ofthe button, the system goes to thenext preset channel. Press thebottom ( ) to go back to theprevious preset channel.To go to the next channel of thecategory you are listening to, pressthe top ( ) of the button for 1second. Press the bottom ( ) for1 second to go back to theprevious channel.
On models without navigation system
Remote Audio Controls
204
12/08/09 16:26:05 31SJC670_211
2013 Ridgeline
Features
When the appropriate audio unit isconnected to the auxiliary input jack,press the CD/AUX or AUX button toselect the unit.
The auxiliary input jack is on the trayabove the glove box. The system willaccept auxiliary input from standardaudio accessories.
The Anti-theft Identification Cardalso lists your audio serial number. Itis best to store the card in a safeplace at home. In addition, youshould write the audio system’sserial number in this owner’s manual.
If your vehicle’s battery isdisconnected or goes dead, the audiosystem disables itself. Ifthis happens, you will see ‘‘ENTERCODE’’ in the frequency displaynext time you turn on the system.Use the preset bars (icons on models with navigation system)to enter the five-digit code. The codeis on the Anti-theft Identification Card included in your owner’s manual kit. When it is entered correctly, the radio will start playing.
CONTINUED
Except RT and DX models
Auxiliary Input Jack, Radio Theft Protection
Auxiliary Input Jacks Radio Theft Protection
205
AUXILIARYINPUT JACK
12/08/09 16:26:12 31SJC670_212
2013 Ridgeline
Features
If you make a mistake entering thecode, do not start over; complete thefive-digit sequence, then enter thecorrect code. You have ten tries toenter the correct code. If you areunsuccessful in ten attempts, youmust then leave the system on forone hour before trying again.
The system will retain your AM andFM presets even if power isdisconnected.
We recommend that you register thesecurity code at Owner Link (owners.honda.com). If you lose the Anti-theft Identification Card beforeregistering the code at Owner Link,you must obtain the code from yourdealer or
. To do this, you will need theaudio system’s serial number. If youdo not have the serial number withyou, ask your dealer or go to
forinformation on how to retrieve it.
If you lose the Anti-theftIdentification Card, you must obtainthe code from your dealer. To do this,you will need the audio system’sserial number. If you do not have theserial number with you, ask yourdealer how to retrieve it.
You need to enter the same code forthe navigation system to reactivate.Read the navigation system manualfor details.
https://radio-navicode.honda.com/
https://radio-navicode.honda.com/
On models with navigation system
U.S. owners Canadian owners
Radio Theft Protection
206
12/08/09 16:26:18 31SJC670_213
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Press and hold the H (Preset 1) sideof the bar until the hour advances tothe desired time. Press and hold theM (Preset 2) side of the bar until theminutes advance to the desired time.
To set the time, press the CLOCKbutton until you hear a beep. Thedisplayed time begins to blink.
If your vehicle’s battery isdisconnected or goes dead, you mayneed to set the clock. You can quickly set the time to the
nearest hour. If the displayed time isbefore the half hour, pressing theclock set button until you hear abeep, then pressing the R (Preset 3)side of the bar sets the clock back tothe previous hour.
If the displayed time is after the halfhour, the clock sets forward to thebeginning of the next hour.
Press the clock set button again toenter the set time.
For example:
The navigation system receivessignals from the global positioningsystem (GPS), and the displayedtime is updated automatically by theGPS. Refer to the navigation systemmanual for how to adjust the time.
1:06 will reset to 1:001:52 will reset to 2:00
On models with navigation system
On models without navigation system
Setting the Clock
207
PRESET BARS
CLOCK BUTTON CLOCK BUTTON
Model without XM satelliteradio is shown. PRESET BARS
RTS, RTL, and Touring models without navigation systemRT, DX, VP, and Sport models
12/08/09 16:26:26 31SJC670_214
2013 Ridgeline
Features
If equippedThe security system helps to protectyour vehicle and valuables from theft.The horn sounds and a combinationof headlights, parking lights, licenseplate lights, and taillights flashes ifsomeone attempts to break into yourvehicle or remove the audio unit.This alarm continues for twominutes, then the system resets. Todeactivate the system before the twominutes have elapsed, unlock thedriver’s door with the key or theremote transmitter. Once the security system sets,
opening any door (without using thekey or the remote transmitter), thehood, or the In-Bed Trunk, will causethe alarm to activate. It also activatesif the radio and navigationcomponents are removed from thedashboard or the wiring is cut.
The security system automaticallysets 15 seconds after you lock thedoors, hood, and the In-Bed Trunk.For the system to activate, you mustlock the doors from the outside withthe key, or use driver’s lock tab, doorlock switch, or remote transmitter.The security system indicator on theinstrument panel starts blinkingimmediately to show you the systemis setting itself.
Security System
208
SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR
12/08/09 16:26:31 31SJC670_215
2013 Ridgeline
Features
The security system does not set ifthe hood, In-Bed Trunk, or any dooris not fully closed. If the system willnot set, check the door and tailgateopen monitor and In-Bed Trunk openindicator on the instrument panel(see pages and ) to see if thedoors and In-Bed Trunk are fullyclosed. Since it is not part of themonitor display, manually check thehood.
Use the remote transmitterto quickly check that the hood,In-Bed Trunk, and all doors areclosed. Push the lock button twicewithin five seconds. There should bean audible confirmation beep.
Do not attempt to alter this systemor add other devices to it.
11 75
Security System
209
NOTE:
12/08/09 16:26:36 31SJC670_216
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Cruise control allows you to maintaina set speed above 25 mph (40 km/h)without keeping your foot on theaccelerator pedal. It should be usedfor cruising on straight, openhighways. It is not recommended forcity driving, winding roads, slipperyroads, heavy rain, or bad weather.
Push in the CRUISE button on thesteering wheel. The CRUISEMAIN indicator on the instrumentpanel comes on.
Press and release the SET/DECEL button on the steeringwheel. The CRUISE CONTROLindicator on the instrument panelcomes on to show the system isnow activated.
Accelerate to the desired cruisingspeed above 25 mph (40 km/h).
The cruise control system can beleft on, even when it is not in use.
1.
2.
3.Using Cruise Control
Cruise Control
210
CRUISE BUTTON
CANCELBUTTON
SET/DECEL BUTTON
RES/ACCELBUTTON
Improper use of the cruisecontrol can lead to a crash.
Use the cruise control onlywhen traveling on openhighways in good weather.
12/08/09 16:26:43 31SJC670_217
2013 Ridgeline
Features
You can increase the set cruisingspeed in any of these ways:
You can decrease the set cruisingspeed in any of these ways:
Press and hold the RES/ACCELbutton. When you reach thedesired cruising speed, release thebutton.
Push on the accelerator pedal.Accelerate to the desired cruisingspeed, then press the SET/DECEL button.
Cruise control may not hold the setspeed when you are going up anddown hills. If your vehicle speedincreases going down a hill, use thebrakes to slow down. This will cancelthe cruise control. To resume the setspeed, press the RES/ACCEL button.The CRUISE CONTROL indicatoron the instrument panel will comeback on.
To increase the speed in verysmall amounts, tap the RES/ACCEL button. Each time you dothis, your vehicle will speed upabout 1 mph (1.6 km/h).
If you need to decrease yourspeed quickly, use the brakes as younormally would.
Tap the brake pedal lightly withyour foot. The CRUISECONTROL indicator on theinstrument panel will go out.When the vehicle slows to thedesired speed, press the SET/DECEL button.
Press and hold the SET/DECELbutton. Release the button whenyou reach the desired speed.
To slow down in very smallamounts, tap the SET/DECELbutton. Each time you do this,your vehicle will slow down about1 mph (1.6 km/h).
CONTINUED
Changing the Set Speed
Cruise Control
211
NOTE:
12/08/09 16:26:52 31SJC670_218
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Tap the brake pedal.
Push the CANCEL button on thesteering wheel.
Resting your foot on the brake pedalcauses cruise control to cancel.
You can cancel cruise control in anyof these ways:
Push the CRUISE button on thesteering wheel.
When you push the CANCEL buttonor tap the brake pedal, the systemremembers the previously set speed.To return to that speed, accelerate toabove 25 mph (40 km/h), then pressand release the RES/ACCEL button.The CRUISE CONTROL indicatorcomes on. The vehicle accelerates tothe same speed as before.
Pressing the CRUISE button turnsthe system completely off and erasesthe previous cruising speed.
Even with cruise control turned on,you can still use the acceleratorpedal to speed up for passing. Aftercompleting the pass, take your footoff the accelerator pedal. The vehiclewill return to the set cruising speed.
Resuming the Set SpeedCanceling Cruise Control
Cruise Control
212
CRUISE BUTTON
CANCEL BUTTON
12/08/09 16:27:00 31SJC670_219
2013 Ridgeline
Features
The HomeLink UniversalTransceiver built into your vehiclecan be programmed to operateup to three remote controlled devices around your home,such as garage doors, lighting, orhome security systems.
Before programming yourHomeLink to operate a garage dooropener, confirm that the opener hasan external entrapment protectionsystem, such as an ‘‘electronic eye,’’or other safety and reverse
If your garage door wasmanufactured before April 1, 1982,you may not be able to programHomeLink to operate it. These unitsdo not have safety features thatcause the motor to stop and reverseit if an obstacle is detected duringclosing, increasing the risk of injury.
Do not use HomeLink with anygarage door opener that lacks safetystop and reverse features.
If equipped
CONTINUED
HomeLink Universal Transceiver
General Information
213
12/08/09 16:27:05 31SJC670_220
2013 Ridgeline
Features
stop features.
×
-Units manufactured between April 1,1982 and January 1, 1993 may beequipped with safety stop andreverse features. If your unit doesnot have an external entrapmentprotection system, an easy test toconfirm the function andperformance of the safety stop andreverse feature is to lay a 2 4under the closing door. The doorshould stop and reverse uponcontacting the piece of wood.As an additional safety feature,garage door openers manufacturedafter January 1, 1993 are required tohave external entrapment protectionsystems, such as an electronic eye,which detect an object obstructingthe door.
Refer to the safety information thatcame with your garage door openerto test that the safety features arefunctioning properly. If you do nothave this information, contact themanufacturer of the equipment.Before programming HomeLink to agarage door or gate opener, makesure that people and objects are outof the way of the device to preventpotential injury or damage.When programming a garage dooropener, park just outside the garage.
If you justreceived your vehicle and have nottrained any of the buttons inHomeLink before, you should eraseany previously learned codes beforetraining the first button. To do this,press and hold the two outsidebuttons on the HomeLinktransceiver for about 20 seconds,until the red indicator flashes.Release the buttons, then proceed tostep 1.
HomeLink Universal Transceiver
Important Safety Precautions Training HomeLinkBefore you begin
214
12/08/09 16:27:11 31SJC670_221
2013 Ridgeline
Features
If you are training the second or third buttons, go directly to step 1.
CONTINUED
HomeLink Universal Transceiver
215
12/08/09 16:27:24 31SJC670_222
2013 Ridgeline
Features
HomeLink is a registeredtrademark of Johnson Controls, Inc.
This device complies with theappropriate requirements or therequired standards. See page formore information.
400
HomeLink Universal Transceiver
216
12/08/09 16:27:27 31SJC670_223
2013 Ridgeline
Features
-
-
Bluetooth
handsfreelink.honda.com
www.handsfreelink.ca,
HandsFreeLink (HFL)allows you to place and receivephone calls using voice commands,without handling your cell phone.
Press andrelease to give a command or answera call.
Press andrelease to end a call, go back to theprevious command, or cancel thecommand.
To use HFL, you need aBluetooth- compatible cell phone.For a list of compatible phones,pairing procedures, and special feature capabilities:
In the U.S.,visitor call (888) 528-7876.
In Canada,visitor call (888) 528-7876.
CONTINUED
On models with navigation systemHFL Buttons
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Using HFL
HFL Talk button
HFL Back button
217
HFL BACK BUTTON
NAVI VOICECONTROLBUTTONS
HFL TALKBUTTON
12/08/09 16:27:35 31SJC670_224
2013 Ridgeline
Features
####
Try to reduce all backgroundnoise. If the microphone picks upvoices other than yours,commands may be misinterpreted.
Many commands can be spokentogether. For example, you cansay ‘‘Call 123-456- ’’ or‘‘Dial Peter.’’
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton each time you want tomake a command. After the beep,speak in a clear, natural tone.
When HFL is in use, navigationvoice commands cannot be recognized.
To change the volume level ofHFL, use the audio system volume knob or the steering wheel volume controls.
Air or wind noise from thedashboard and side vents and allwindows may interfere with themicrophone. Adjust or close themas necessary.
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Voice Control Tips
218
MICROPHONE
12/08/09 16:27:42 31SJC670_225
2013 Ridgeline
Features
CONTINUED
To hear general HFL information,including help on pairing a phoneor setting up the system, say‘‘Tutorial.’’
For help at any time, including alist of available commands, say‘‘Hands free help.’’
As an incoming call notification, youwill see the following display:
Some phones may send battery,signal strength, and roaming statusinformation to HFL.
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Help Features Information Display
219
HFLMODE
BATTERYLEVEL STATUS
ROAM STATUS
SIGNALSTRENGTH
PHONE NUMBER
12/08/09 16:27:49 31SJC670_226
2013 Ridgeline
Features
A notification that there is anincoming call, or HFL is in use, willappear on the navigation screenwhen the audio system is on.
When there is an incoming call,or HFL is in use, ‘‘HANDS FREE LINK’’ will appear on theaudio display.
The Bluetooth icon will alsoappear on the audio display when aphone is linked.
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
220
BLUETOOTH INDICATOR
12/08/09 16:27:54 31SJC670_227
2013 Ridgeline
Features
####
CONTINUED
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
How to Use HFL
221
‘‘Phone Setup’’
‘‘Call’’ or ‘‘Dial’’
‘‘Pair’’
‘‘Edit’’
‘‘Delete’’
‘‘Jim Smith’’
‘‘Set PairingCode’’
The ignition switch must be in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position.
‘‘List’’
‘‘Status’’
‘‘Next Phone’’
‘‘123-555- ’’
Press HFLTalk button
Press and release the HFL Talk button each time you give a command.
Edit the name of a paired phone
Delete a paired phone from the system
Hear a list of all phones paired to the system
Hear which paired phone is currently linked to the system
Search for another previously paired phone to link to
Set the pairing code to a ‘‘Fixed’’ or ‘‘Random’’ number
Enter desired phone number
Once a phonebook entry is stored, you can say a name here.
Pair a phone to the system (See page 224)
(See page 225)
(See page 225)
(See page 225)
(See page 226)
(See page 226)
(See page 226)
(See page 227)
(See page 227)
12/08/09 16:28:03 31SJC670_228
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
222
‘‘Redial’’
‘‘Transfer’’
‘‘Mute’’
‘‘Send’’
‘‘Phonebook’’
‘‘Store’’
‘‘Edit’’
‘‘Delete’’
‘‘ReceiveContact’’
‘‘List’’
Press HFLTalk button
Press and release the HFL Talk button each time you give a command.
Transfer a call from HFL to your phone, or from your phone to HFL
Store a phonebook entry
If your phone supports this function, use this to transfer contacts fromyour phone to HFL
Redial the last number called (See page 228)
(See page 230)
Mute your voice to the person at the other end of the call (See page 230)
Send numbers or names during a call (See page 230)
(See page 231)
Edit the number of an existing phonebook entry (See page 231)
Delete a phonebook entry (See page 232)
(See page 232)
Hear a list of all stored phonebook entries (See page 232)
12/08/09 16:28:09 31SJC670_229
2013 Ridgeline
Features
*
*
CONTINUED
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
223
‘‘Change Language’’
‘‘Hands Free Help’’
‘‘SystemSet up’’
‘‘Tutorial’’
‘‘Clear’’
‘‘Auto Transfer’’
‘‘Call Notification’’
‘‘Security’’
‘‘Change Passcode’’
Press HFLTalk button
Press and release the HFL Talk button each time you give a command.
: Canadian models
Set how you would like to be notified of an incoming call
Hear a list of available commands and additional information describing each command
Apply a security passcode to the system that must be input at each keycycle to access the system (See page 237)
Change your security passcode (See page 238)
(See page 238)
Clear the system of all paired phones, phonebook entries and securitypasscode (See page 239)
Change language from English to French (See page 240)
Hear a tutorial for general rules on using the system (See page 219)
(See page 219)
Set calls to automatically transfer from your phone to HFL when youenter the vehicle (See page 238)
12/08/09 16:28:16 31SJC670_230
2013 Ridgeline
Features
To use HFL, you need to pair yourBluetooth-compatible cell phone tothe system.
This command group is available forpaired cell phones.
You cannot pair your phone whilethe vehicle is moving.
Your phone must be in discoveryor search mode to pair. Refer toyour phone’s manual.
Up to six phones can be paired.
Your phone’s battery may drainfaster when it is paired to HFL.
If after three minutes your phoneis not ready to pair or a phone isnot found, the system will time outand return to idle.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton. If you are pairing a phonefor the first time, HFL will giveyou information about the pairingprocess. If it is not the first phoneyou are pairing, say ‘‘
’’ and say ‘‘ .’’
Follow the HFL prompts and putyour phone in discovery or searchmode. HFL will give you a 4-digitpairing code and begin searchingfor your phone.
When your phone finds aBluetooth device, select HFL fromthe options and enter the 4-digitcode from the previous step.
Follow the HFL prompts andname the newly paired phone.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Phone Setup
Phonesetup Pair
Phone pairing tips
To pair a cell phone:
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
224
12/08/09 16:28:26 31SJC670_231
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Say ‘‘ .’’
Say ‘‘ ’’ after the prompts.
If there is more than one phonepaired to the system, HFL will askyou which phone’s name you wantto change. Follow the HFLprompts and rename the phone.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Say ‘‘ ’’ after the prompts.
HFL will ask you which phoneyou want to delete. Follow theHFL prompts to continuewith the deletion.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
HFL will read out all the pairedphone’s names.
Say ‘‘ ’’ after the prompts.
Say ‘‘ .’’1.
2.
3. 3.
1.
2.1.
2.
3.
CONTINUED
Phone setup
Edit
Phone setup
DeleteList
Phone setup
To hear the names ofall paired phones:
To rename a paired phone: To delete a paired phone:
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
225
12/08/09 16:28:37 31SJC670_232
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Say ‘‘ ’’ after the prompts.
HFL will tell you which phone islinked to the system.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’Say ‘‘ .’’
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ ’’ after theprompts.
HFL disconnects the linked phoneand searches for anotherpaired phone.
Once another phone is found, it islinked to the system. HFL willinform you which phoneis now linked.
If no other phones are found orpaired, HFL will inform you that theoriginal phone is linked again.
Say ‘‘ ’’ after theprompts.
If you want HFL to create arandom code each time you pair aphone, say ‘‘ .’’ If you wantto choose your own 4-digit code tobe used each time, say ‘‘ ’’and follow the HFL prompts.
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
To hear which paired phone iscurrently linked:
To change from the currently linkedphone to another paired phone:
To change the pairing code setting:
Phone setup
Status
Phone setupPhone setup
Next phoneSet pairing code
Random
Fixed
226
12/08/09 16:28:49 31SJC670_233
2013 Ridgeline
Features
CONTINUED
HFL uses a Class 2 Bluetooth,which means, the maximum rangebetween your phone and vehicle is30 feet (10 meters).
During a call, HFL allows you to talkup to 30 minutes after you removethe key from the ignition switch.However, this may weaken thevehicle’s battery.
You can make calls using a name inthe HFL phonebook or any phonenumber. You can also redial the lastnumber called.
Once connected, you will hear theperson you called through theaudio speakers.
Follow the HFL prompts toconfirm the name and makethe call.
Follow the HFL prompts toconfirm the number and say‘‘ ’’ or ‘‘ .’’
Follow the HFL prompts and saythe name stored in the HFLphonebook that you want to call.
Follow the HFL prompts and saythe phone number you want to dial.
Say ‘‘ ’’ or ‘‘ .’’ Say ‘‘ ’’ or ‘‘ .’’
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
3.
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Making a Call
Call Dial
Call Dial Call Dial
To make a call using a phonenumber:
To make a call using a name in theHFL phonebook:
227
12/08/09 16:29:00 31SJC670_234
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Select ‘‘.’’
Press the INFO button, then select‘‘ .’’
Select a phonebook you want tochoose a phone number from.
If the phonebook you select is PIN-protected, you will need to enter thePIN to access it. See page formore information.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton and say ‘‘ .’’
1.
2.
3.
235
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Search ImportedPhonebook
Cellular Phonebook
Redial
To redial the last numbercalled by HFL:
To make a call from an imported phonebook:
228
12/08/09 16:29:08 31SJC670_235
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Select the name. All the phonenumbers stored for that name willbe listed.
When you receive a call, an incomingcall notification (if activated) willplay and interrupt the audio systemif it is on.
Press the HFL Talk button to answerthe call, or the HFL Back button tohang up.
If your phone has Call Waiting, pressand release the HFL Talk button toput the original call on hold andanswer the incoming call.
To return to the original call, pressthe HFL Talk button again. If youdon’t want to answer the incomingcall, disregard it and continue withyour original call. If you want to hangup the original call and answer thenew call, press the HFL Back button.
To search for a specific name in thephonebook, enter the keyword foreither the first or last name.
To display all names in thephonebook, select the ‘‘ ’’ option.
If you choose ‘‘,’’ the phone
number will be stored in HFL, sothat you can call it using HFL’s nametag by voice.
Select the phone number, andHFL begins dialing.
4.
5.
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Receiving a Call
ListStore in
HandsFreeLink
Call Waiting
229
12/08/09 16:29:17 31SJC670_236
2013 Ridgeline
Features
#
You can transfer a call from HFLto your phone, or from your phoneto HFL.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton and say ‘‘ .’’
You can mute your voice to theperson you are talking to during a call.
HFL allows you to send numbers or names during a call.This is useful when you call amenu-driven phone system.To mute your voice during a call,
press and release the HFL Talkbutton and say ‘‘ .’’
To unmute your voice, press andrelease the HFL Talk button and say‘‘ ’’ again.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
To send a pound ( ), say‘‘pound.’’ To send a star (*), say ‘‘star.’’
Follow the HFL prompts to sendthe tones and continue the call.
Follow the HFL prompts and saythe name or number you want tosend.
Say ‘‘ .’’1.
2.
3.
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Transferring a Call
Transfer
Muting a Call Send Numbers orNames During a Call
Mute
MuteSend
To send a name ornumber during a call:
230
NOTE:
12/08/09 16:29:26 31SJC670_237
2013 Ridgeline
Features
You can store up to 50 names withtheir associated numbers in HFL.The numbers you store can be notonly phone numbers but other types,such as account numbers orpasswords, which can be sent duringa menu-driven call.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Say ‘‘ ’’ after the prompts.
Say a name you want to list as yourphonebook entry.
Say the number you want to storefor the name entry.
Follow the HFL prompts and say‘‘ ’’ to store the entry.
Avoid using duplicate nameentries.
Avoid using ‘‘home’’ as a nameentry.
It is easier for HFL to recognize amultisyllabic or longer name. Forexample, use ‘‘Peter’’ instead of‘‘Pete,’’ or ‘‘John Smith’’ instead of‘‘John.’’
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Say ‘‘ ’’ after the prompts.
Follow the HFL prompts and saythe name entry you want to edit.
When asked, say the new numberfor that name.
Follow the HFL prompts tocomplete the edit.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
CONTINUED
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
To store a phonebook entry:
To edit the number stored in a name:
Phonebook
Store
Enter
Phonebook
Edit
Phonebook
231
NOTE:
12/08/09 16:29:41 31SJC670_238
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Say ‘‘ ’’ after the prompts.
Say the name you want to deleteand follow the HFL prompts tocomplete the deletion.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Say ‘‘ ’’ after the prompts.
HFL begins reading the names inthe order they were stored.
If you hear a name you want to call,immediately press the HFL Talkbutton and say ‘‘ .’’
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Follow the HFL prompts, select anumber from your cell phone, andsend it to HFL.
Say ‘‘ ’’ after
Say ‘‘ .’’
Follow the HFL prompts andname the number, or say‘‘ ’’ if it is not the numberyou want to store.
Follow the HFL prompts if youwant to store another number.
1.
2.
3.
4.
1.
2.
3.
4.
1.
2.
3.
5.
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Phonebook
Delete
Phonebook
List
Call
Receive contact
Phonebook
Discard
To delete a name: To list all names in the phonebook: To store a specific phone numberfrom your cell phone directly to theHFL phonebook (available on somephones):
232
12/08/09 16:29:53 31SJC670_239
2013 Ridgeline
Features
the prompts.
(available on some phones)
If you selectfrom the Information screen menu,you will see four HFL options.
The entire phonebook data of thecell phone that is linked to HFL canbe imported to the navigation system.
Select ‘‘,’’ and HFL will begin
importing the phonebook. Select‘‘ ’’ after the import is completed.
Once a phonebook has beenimported, you can search the phonenumbers by the person’s name.
Select ‘‘,’’ and a list of imported
phonebooks will be displayed.
Select a phonebook from the list.
For a list of cell phones that arecompatible with this feature:
CONTINUED
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Cellular Phonebook
Cellular Phonebook
Import CellularPhonebook
OK
Search ImportedPhonebook
Import Cellular Phonebook: Search Imported Phonebook:
233
IMPORTED PHONEBOOK
IMPORTED DATE
PIN ICON
12/08/09 16:30:04 31SJC670_240
2013 Ridgeline
Features
handsfreelink.honda.com
www.handsfreelink.ca,
In the U.S.,visitor call (888) 528-7876.
In Canada,visitor call (888) 528-7876.
Select a person from the list. Up tothree category icons are displayed inthe left side of the list:
Select the person’s number you wantto call, and press the HFL Talkbutton.
These indicate how many numbersare stored for the name. If a namehas more than three category icons,‘‘…’’ is displayed.
If the phonebook is PIN-protected,you will need to enter the 4-digit PIN.
To search for a specific name in thephonebook, enter the keyword foreither the first or last name.
To display all names in thephonebook, select the ‘‘ ’’ option.
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
List
234
Preference
Home
Mobile
Work
Pager
Fax
Car
Voice
Other
12/08/09 16:30:16 31SJC670_241
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Select ‘‘,’’ and a list of imported
phonebooks will be displayed.
After making a selection, thefollowing screen will appear.
Select ‘‘ ,’’ then ‘‘ ’’ to completethe deletion.
You can add, change, or remove aPIN number from any phonebook.
You can delete anyimported phonebook.
Select a phonebook you want todelete. If the phonebook is PIN-protected, you will need to enter the4-digit PIN number.
If you have selected a phonebookwithout a PIN, you will see theabove display.
Enter the new 4-digit PIN. You willhave to re-enter the PIN forconfirmation.
CONTINUED
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Delete ImportedPhonebook
Yes OK
PIN NumberDelete Imported Phonebook:
To add a PIN:
235
12/08/09 16:30:25 31SJC670_242
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Select ‘‘ ,’’ then select‘‘ ’’ after you enterthe current PIN.
Enter the new 4-digit PIN number.You will be asked to re-enter the PINfor verification.
The display will change as shownabove.Select the phonebook you want. The
display will change as shown above.
Enter the current PIN for thisphonebook.
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
To remove a PIN:To change the PIN to a new number:PIN number
Do not use PIN
236
12/08/09 16:30:32 31SJC670_243
2013 Ridgeline
Features
This command group allows youto change or customize HFLbasic settings.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Once a passcode is set, youwill need to enter it to use HFL eachtime you start the vehicle. If youforget the code, your dealer will haveto reset it for you, or you will have toclear the entire system (see page ).
Follow the HFL prompts toconfirm the number.
Follow the HFL prompts and say the 4-digit passcodeyou want to set.
Say ‘‘ ’’ after the prompts.
1.
2.
3.
4.
239
CONTINUED
System Setup
System setup
Security
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
To set a 4-digit passcode to lock theHFL system for security purposes:
237
NOTE:
12/08/09 16:30:40 31SJC670_244
2013 Ridgeline
Features
*
*
If you get into the vehicle while youare on the phone, the call can beautomatically transferred to HFLwith the ignition switch in theACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Follow the HFL prompts toconfirm the number.
Follow the HFL prompts and saythe new 4-digit passcode.
Say ‘‘ ’’ after
Follow the HFL prompts and say‘‘ ’’ or ‘‘ .’’ Youcan also say ‘‘ ’’ for no audibleincoming call notification.
Say ‘‘ ’’ after
The default setting is a ring tone . HFL will let you know if autotransfer is on or off, depending on the previous setting. Follow the HFL prompts to change the setting.
Say ‘‘ ’’ after theprompts.
2.
3.
4.
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
3. 1.
:
System setup
System setup
System setupChange passcode
Ring tone PromptOff
Call notif ication
Auto transfer
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
To change your security passcode: To select either a ring tone or aprompt as the incoming callnotif ication :
To activate or deactivate the autotransfer function:
238
12/08/09 16:30:53 31SJC670_245
2013 Ridgeline
Features
the prompts.
the prompts.
This operation clears the passcodes,paired phones, all names in the HFLphonebook, and all importedphonebook data.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Say ‘‘ ’’ after the prompts.
Follow the HFL prompts tocontinue to complete theclearing procedure.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say the language you want tochange to in that language.
Follow the HFL prompts.
You can also clear the system whenyou have forgotten the passcode andcannot access HFL. When HFL asksyou for the passcode, say ‘‘
.’’ Paired phones, all names inthe HFL phonebook and all importedphonebook data will be lost.
1.
2.
3.
2.
1.
Canadian models only
System setup
Clear
Quick Language Selection
Systemclear
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
To clear the system:
To quickly change the language:
239
12/08/09 16:31:02 31SJC670_246
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Follow the HFL prompts tochange the language to English orFrench.
If you have not named your pairedphone in the language you justselected, HFL will ask you to name itin the current language.
When French is your currentlyselected language, you can give voicecommands in French.
The word mark and logosare registered trademarks owned byBluetooth SIG, Inc. and any use ofsuch marks by Honda Motor Co.,Ltd. is under license. Othertrademarks and trade names arethose of their respective owners.
This device complies with theappropriate requirements or therequired standards. See page formore information.
Refer to the navigation systemmanual for operation of therearview camera.
Whenever you shift to reverse (R)with the ignition switch in the ON(II) position, the rear view appearson a display in the rearview mirror.
1.
2.
400
BluetoothCanadian models onlyChange Language
Change language
Wireless Technology
Rearview Mirror with RearviewCamera Display
To change the system languagebetween English and French:
Bluetooth On models withoutnavigation system
On models with navigation system
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink , Rearview Mirror with Rearview Camera Display
240
REARVIEW CAMERA DISPLAY
SENSOR
SENSOR
POWER BUTTON
12/09/07 16:43:17 31SJC670_247
2013 Ridgeline
Features
For the best picture, always keep therearview camera clean, and do notcover the camera lens. To avoidscratching the lens when you clean it,use a moist, soft cloth.
Since the rearview camera displayarea is limited, you should alwaysback up slowly and carefully, andlook behind you for obstacles.
The camera display brightness isadjusted automatically by sensors. Ifyou use the camera displaycontinuously at high temperatures,the image will gradually dim.
The rearview mirror will be hotwhen you use the camera display foran extended period of time.
Rearview Mirror with Rearview Camera Display
Rearview Camera Guide Lines
241
SCREEN DISPLAY
4th line
3rd line
2nd line1st line
ACTUAL DISTANCE
12/09/07 16:43:24 31SJC670_248
2013 Ridgeline
Features
The camera display has parkingguide lines that indicate distancefrom your vehicle.
1st line2nd line3rd line4th line
20 in (0.5 m)39 in (1 m)79 in (2 m)118 in (3 m)
The rearview camera has a uniquelens that makes objects appearcloser than they actually are.
The rearview camera display has alimited coverage, and the size andposition of objects may appeardifferent than they actually are.Make sure to check thesurrounding area carefully.
To turn off the guide lines, press andhold the power button for more than3 seconds. If you turn the guide linesoff, they remain off until you turnthem back on.
You can select the displayedlanguage on the rearviewmirror between English,French, and Spanish.
Move the shift lever to R to displaythe rearview monitor.
Press and hold the power buttonfor about six seconds or more.The displayed operation guidemessage begins blinking.
Press the power button to changethe language while it is blinking.Pressing the button switches thedisplayed language. Your selectionis set about five seconds after youstop adjusting.
1.
2.
3.
Rearview Mirror with Rearview Camera Display
Customizing the display language
242
NOTE:
POWER BUTTON
12/09/07 16:43:33 31SJC670_249
2013 Ridgeline
Features
Before you begin driving yourvehicle, you should know whatgasoline to use and how to check thelevels of important fluids. You alsoneed to know how to properly storeluggage or packages. Theinformation in this section will helpyou. If you plan to add anyaccessories to your vehicle, pleaseread the information in this sectionfirst.
.............................Break-in Period . 244.................Fuel Recommendation . 244
.........Service Station Procedures . 246....................................Refueling . 246
Opening and Closing the.......................................Hood . 250
...................................Oil Check . 251.............Engine Coolant Check . 251
...............................Fuel Economy . 252...Accessories and Modifications . 255
.............................Carrying Cargo . 257
Before Driving
243
12/08/09 16:31:31 31SJC670_250
2013 Ridgeline
Help assure your vehicle’s futurereliability and performance by payingextra attention to how you driveduring the first 600 miles (1,000 km).During this period:
Avoid full-throttle starts and rapidacceleration.
Do not change the oil until thescheduled maintenance time.
Avoid hard braking for the first200 miles (300 km).
Do not tow a trailer.
You should also follow theserecommendations with anoverhauled or exchanged engine, orwhen the brakes are replaced.
Your vehicle is designed to operateon unleaded gasoline with a pumpoctane number of 87 or higher. Useof a lower octane gasoline can causea persistent, heavy metallic rappingnoise that can lead to engine damage.
Premium fuel is recommended whentowing in certain conditions (seepage ).301
Break-in Period Fuel Recommendation
Break-in Period, Fuel Recommendation
244
To help prevent harmf ul f uel systemand engine deposits, use high qualityf uel containing detergent and additives.In addition, in order to maintain goodperf ormance, f uel economy, andemissions control, we stronglyrecommend the use of gasoline thatdoes NOT contain harmf ul manganese-based f uel additives such as MMT, ifsuch gasoline is available.
12/08/09 16:31:39 31SJC670_251
2013 Ridgeline
Before
Driving
Because the level of detergency andadditives in gasoline vary in themarket, Honda endorses the use of‘‘TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline’’where available to help maintain theperformance and reliability of yourvehicle. TOP TIER DetergentGasoline meets a new gasolinestandard jointly established byleading automotive manufacturers tomeet the needs of today’s advancedengines. Qualifying gasoline retailerswill, in most cases, identify theirgasoline as having met ‘‘TOP TIERDetergent Gasoline’’ standards at theretail location. This fuel isguaranteed to contain the properlevel of detergent additives and befree of metallic additives. The properlevel of detergent additives, andabsence of harmful metallic additivesin gasoline, help avoid build-up ofdeposits in your engine and emissioncontrol system.
For further important fuel-relatedinformation for your vehicle, orinformation on gasoline that does notcontain MMT, visit Owner Link at
. In Canada, visitfor additional
information on gasoline. For moreinformation on top tier gasoline, visit
Use of gasoline with these additivesmay adversely affect performance,and cause the malfunction indicatorlamp on your instrument panel tocome on. If this happens, contactyour dealer for service. Somegasoline today is blended withoxygenates such as ethanol. Yourvehicle is designed to operate onoxygenated gasoline containing up to10% ethanol by volume. Do not usegasoline containing methanol. If younotice any undesirable operatingsymptoms, try another servicestation or switch to another brand of gasoline.
owners.honda.comwww.honda.ca
www.toptiergas.com.
Fuel Recommendation
Before
Driving
245
12/08/09 16:31:43 31SJC670_252
2013 Ridgeline
Open the fuel fill door by pullingon the handle to the left of thedriver’s seat.
Park with the driver’s side closestto the service station pump.
Remove the fuel fill cap slowly.You may hear a hissing sound aspressure inside the tank escapes.The fuel fill cap is attached to thefuel filler with a tether. Insert theattachment on the fuel fill cap intothe slit on the fuel fill door.
1.
2.
3.Refueling
Service Station Procedures
246
Pull
FUEL FILL CAPATTACHMENT
TETHER
Gasoline is highly flammableand explosive. You can beburned or seriously injuredwhen handling fuel.
Stop the engine, and keepheat, sparks, and flame away.Handle fuel only outdoors.Wipe up spills immediately.
12/08/09 16:31:50 31SJC670_253
2013 Ridgeline
Before
Driving
Screw the fuel fill cap back onuntil it clicks at least once.
If you do not properly tighten thecap, you will see a ‘‘CHECK FUELCAP’’ message on the informationdisplay (see page ).
Push the fuel fill door closed untilit latches.
Stop filling the tank after the fuelnozzle automatically clicks off. Donot try to ‘‘top off’’ the tank. Thisleaves some room in the fuel tankfor the fuel to expand withtemperature changes.
If the fuel nozzle keeps clicking offeven though the tank is not full,there may be a problem with yourvehicle’s fuel vapor recoverysystem. The system helps keepfuel vapor from going into theatmosphere. Try filling at anotherpump. If this does not fix theproblem, consult your dealer.
If you do not properly tighten thecap, you will see a ‘‘TIGHTENFUEL CAP’’ message on the multi-information display.
Your vehicle’s on board diagnosticsystem will detect a loose ormissing fuel fill cap as anevaporative system leak. The firsttime a leak is detected a‘‘TIGHTEN FUEL CAP’’ messageappears on the multi-informationdisplay.
5.
6.
81
4.
CONTINUED
On models without navigation system
On models with navigation system
On models with navigation system
Service Station Procedures
Tighten Fuel Cap Message
247
12/08/09 16:31:58 31SJC670_254
2013 Ridgeline
Before
Driving
If the system still detects a leak inthe vehicle’s evaporative emissionssystem, the malfunction indicatorlamp (MIL) comes on. If the fuel fillcap was not already tightened, turnthe engine off, and check orretighten the fuel fill cap until itclicks at least once. The MIL shouldgo off after several days of normaldriving once the cap is tightened orreplaced. If the MIL does not go off,have your vehicle inspected by adealer. For more information, seepage .
Turn the engine off, and confirm thefuel fill cap is installed. If it is, loosenit, then retighten it until it clicks atleast once. The message should gooff after several days of normaldriving once you tighten or replacethe fuel fill cap. To scroll to anothermessage, press the INFO button.
The ‘‘TIGHTEN FUEL CAP’’message will appear each time yourestart the engine until the systemturns the message off.
373
Service Station Procedures
248
12/08/09 16:32:02 31SJC670_255
2013 Ridgeline
Before
Driving
Your vehicle has a warning label forfilling a portable fuel container onthe left rear side of the pickup bed.
Gasoline or fuel vapors areextremely flammable and explosive.Improperly handling fuel can causean explosion in which you can beseriously injured.
Before placing the fuel container inthe vehicle, wipe up any spillcompletely.
Whenever filling a fuel container,use an approved fuel container, andplace it on the ground. Do not fill thefuel container in the vehicle,including the pickup bed and theIn-Bed Trunk. Make sure to put thefuel pump nozzle in the fuel filler ofthe container securely and to handleit properly.
Service Station Procedures
Filling a Portable Fuel Container
249
Do not fill a portable fuelcontainer in the pickup bed.
Static electricity can ignite gasvapors and you can be burned.
12/08/09 16:32:08 31SJC670_256
2013 Ridgeline
Before
Driving
Put your fingers under the frontedge of the hood. The hood latchhandle is above the ‘‘H’’ logo. Pullthis handle until it releases thehood, then lift the hood.
To close the hood, lift it up slightly toremove the support rod from thehole. Put the support rod back intoits holding clip. Lower the hood toabout a foot (30 cm) above thefender, then let it drop. Make sure itis securely latched.
If the hood latch handle movesstiffly, or you can open the hoodwithout lifting the handle, themechanism should becleaned and lubricated.
Park the vehicle, and set theparking brake. Pull the hoodrelease handle under the lower leftcorner of the dashboard. Thehood will pop up slightly.
Holding the grip, pull the supportrod out of its clip. Insert the endinto the designated hole in thehood marked by an arrow.
1.2. 3.
Opening and Closing the Hood
Service Station Procedures
250
GRIP
HOOD RELEASE HANDLE
LATCH
SUPPORT ROD
12/08/09 16:32:16 31SJC670_257
2013 Ridgeline
Before
Driving
Wait a few minutes after turning theengine off before you check the oil.
Remove the dipstick (orange loop).
Wipe off the dipstick with a cleancloth or paper towel.
Insert the dipstick all the way backinto its hole.
Remove the dipstick again,and check the level. It should be between the upper and
If it is near or below the lower mark,see on page .
Look at the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank. Make sure it isbetween the MAX and MIN lines. Ifit is below the MIN line, see
on pageinformation on adding the proper
Refer toon page for information
about checking other items on your
1.
2.
3.
4.
324327
321
Adding Engine Oil
Engine Coolant CheckOil Check
AddingEngine Coolant
Owner’s MaintenanceChecks
Service Station Procedures
251
UPPER MARK
LOWER MARK
DIPSTICK
MIN
MAXRESERVE TANK
12/08/09 16:32:26 31SJC670_258
2013 Ridgeline
Before
Driving
lower marks.
vehicle.
proper coolant.
-
-
-
-
Fuel economy is not a fixed number.It varies based on driving conditions,driving habits, and vehicle condition.Therefore, it is not possible for oneset of estimates to predict fueleconomy precisely for all drivers inall environments.
Provides an estimated annual fuelcost, based on 15,000 miles (20,000km) per year multiplied by the costper gallon (based on EPA fuel costdata) divided by the combined fuel economy.
For more information on fueleconomy ratings and factors thataffect fuel economy, visit
(Canada: Visit )
Represents urbandriving in light traffic. A range ofmiles per gallon achieved is alsoprovided.
The EPA fuel economy estimatesshown in the example to the rightare a useful tool for comparisonwhen buying a vehicle. EPAestimates include:
Represents amixture of rural and interstatedriving, in a warmed-up vehicle,typical of longer trips in free-flowing
traffic. A range of miles per gallonachieved is also provided.
Represents a combination of city andhighway driving. The scalerepresents the range of combinedfuel economy for other vehicles inthe class.
www.fueleconomy.govwww. vehicles.gc.ca
Actual Mileage and EPA FuelEconomy Estimates Comparison.
Estimated Annual Fuel Cost
City MPG
Highway MPG
Combined Fuel Economy
Fuel Economy
252
Combined FuelEconomy
(Sample U.S. EPA label shown)
Estimated AnnualFuel Cost
City MPG Highway MPG
12/08/09 16:32:35 31SJC670_259
2013 Ridgeline
Before
Driving
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
The following factors can lower yourvehicle’s fuel economy:
Aggressive driving (hardacceleration and braking)Excessive idling, accelerating andbraking in stop-and-go trafficCold engine operation (enginesare more efficient when warmed up)Driving with a heavy load or theair conditioner runningImproperly inflated tires
A properly maintained vehiclemaximizes fuel economy. Poormaintenance can significantly reducefuel economy. Always maintain yourvehicle according to the maintenancemessages displayed on theinformation display (see
on page ).
For example:Rapid
acceleration, abrupt cornering,and hard braking increase
If your vehicle has amanual transmission, you canboost your fuel economy by upshifting as early as possible.
Aerodynamic drag has a big effecton fuel economy at speeds above45 mph (75 km/h). Reduce yourspeed and you reduce the drag.Trailers, car top carriers, roofracks and bike racks are also bigcontributors to increased drag.
Idlingresults in 0 miles per gallon (0 kmsper liter).
An underinflated tire increases‘‘rolling resistance,’’ which reducesfuel economy.
It puts a heavierload on the engine, increasing
Inparticular, a build-up of snow ormud on your vehicle’s undersideadds weight and rolling resistance.Frequent cleaning helps your fuel economy.
321 CONTINUED
Fuel Economy Factors
Improving Fuel Economy
Owner’sMaintenance Checks
Use the recommended viscositymotor oil, displaying the APICertif ication Seal (see
).
Drive moderately
Always drive in the highest gearpossible
Observe the speed limit
Avoid excessive idling
Maintain proper tire inflation
Avoid carrying excess weight inyour vehicle
Keep your vehicle cleanVehicle Maintenance
Drive Efficiently
Fuel Economy
253
12/08/09 16:32:48 31SJC670_260
2013 Ridgeline
Before
Driving
fuel consumption.
fuel consumption.page 324
-
-
Fill the fuel tank until the nozzle automatically clicks off.Reset trip counter to zero.Record the total gallons (liters) needed to refill.Follow one of the simple calculations above.
The A/Cputs an extra load on the enginewhich makes it use more fuel.Use the fresh-air ventilation when possible.
Combine several short trips intoone. A warmed-up engine is morefuel efficient than a cold one.
Direct calculation is therecommended source of informationabout your actual fuel economy.Using frequency of fill-ups or takingfuel gauge readings are NOTaccurate measures of fuel economy.Fuel economy may improve over thefirst several thousand miles(kilometers).
1.2.3.4.
Checking Your Fuel Economy
Measuring Techniques
Fuel Economy
Minimize the use of the airconditioning system
Plan and combine trips
Calculating Fuel Economy
254
Miles drivenGallons of
fuelMiles per
Gallon
100 Kilometers L per 100 kmLiter
12/08/09 16:32:56 31SJC670_261
2013 Ridgeline
Before
Driving
Your dealer has Honda accessoriesthat allow you to personalize yourvehicle. These accessories havebeen designed and approved for yourvehicle, and are covered by warranty.
Modifying your vehicle, or installingnon-Honda accessories, may makeyour vehicle unsafe. Before youmake any modifications or add anyaccessories, be sure to read thefollowing information.
Although non-Honda accessoriesmay fit on your vehicle, they may notmeet factory specifications, andcould adversely affect your vehicle’shandling, stability, and reliability.
If you install a truck cap, be sure it isproperly installed and does notexceed your vehicle’s load limits (seepage ).
When properly installed, cellularphones, alarms, two-way radios, andlow-powered audio systems shouldnot interfere with your vehicle’scomputer controlled systems, suchas your airbags, anti-lock brakes, andtire pressure monitoring system.
Be sure electronic accessories donot overload electrical circuits(see page ) or interfere withthe proper operation of yourvehicle.
Make sure the accessory does notobscure any lights, or interferewith proper vehicle operation orperformance.
Before installing any accessory:
258
376
CONTINUED
Accessories
Your vehicle should not be used tocarry a slide-in camper.
Accessories and Modifications
255
Improper accessories ormodifications can affect yourvehicle’s handling, stability, andperformance, and cause acrash in which you can be hurtor killed.
Follow all instructions in thisowner’s manual regardingaccessories and modifications.
12/08/09 16:33:05 31SJC670_262
2013 Ridgeline
Before
Driving
Removing parts from your vehicle,or replacing components withnon-Honda components couldseriously affect your vehicle’shandling, stability, and reliability.
Some examples are:Lowering the vehicle with a non-Honda suspension kit thatsignificantly reduces groundclearance can allow theundercarriage to hit speed bumpsor other raised objects, whichcould cause the airbags to deploy.
Raising your vehicle with anon-Honda suspension kit canaffect the handling, stability, andreliability.
Before installing any electronicaccessory, have the installercontact your dealer for assistance.If possible, have your dealerinspect the final installation.
Do not install accessories on theside pillars or across the rearwindows. Accessories installed inthese areas may interfere withproper operation of the sidecurtain airbags.
Non-Honda wheels, because theyare a universal design, can causeexcessive stress on suspensioncomponents and will not be
compatible with the tire pressuremonitoring system (TPMS).
If you plan to modify your vehicle,consult your dealer.
Modifying your steering wheel orany other part of your vehicle’ssafety systems could make thesystems ineffective.
Larger or smaller wheels and tirescan interfere with the operation ofyour vehicle’s anti-lock brakes andother systems.
Modifying Your Vehicle
Accessories and Modifications
256
12/08/09 16:33:13 31SJC670_263
2013 Ridgeline
Before
Driving
The pickup bed on your vehicleallows you to carry heavy and largecargo. You can also store items inthe In-Bed Trunk and on a roof-rack(if equipped).
Your vehicle also has theseconvenient storage areas inside:
Glove boxFront door and seat-back pocketsFold-up rear seat with under-seatstorageConsole compartmentPockets on the dashboard
However, carrying too much cargo,or improperly storing it, can affectyour vehicle’s handling, stability,stopping distance, and tires, andmake it unsafe. Before carrying anytype of cargo, be sure to read thefollowing pages.
Carrying Cargo
257
DASHBOARDPOCKETS
PICKUP BED
SEAT-BACK POCKETS
IN-BED TRUNKGLOVE BOX DOOR POCKET
CONSOLE COMPARTMENTS
FOLD-UP REAR SEAT WITH UNDER-SEAT STORAGE
12/08/09 16:33:21 31SJC670_264
2013 Ridgeline
Before
Driving
The maximum load for yourvehicle is:
Steps for Determining CorrectLoad Limit:
Locate the statement ‘‘Thecombined weight of occupants andcargo should never exceed XXXkg or XXX lbs.’’ on your vehicle’splacard.
Determine the combined weightof the driver and passengers thatwill be riding in your vehicle.
Subtract the combined weight ofthe driver and passengers fromXXX kg or XXX lbs.
These figures include the totalweight of all occupants, cargo, andaccessories, and the tongue load ifyou are towing a trailer.
Label Example
See Tire And Loading Informationlabel attached to the driver’sdoorjamb.
1.
2.
3.
RT, RTS, DX, VP, Canadian Sportmodels, and Touring model withoutmoonroof
RTL, U.S. Sport models, and Touringmodel with moonroof
Load Limits (Payload)
Carrying Cargo
258
1,470 lbs (670 kg)
1,520 lbs (690 kg) Overloading or improperloading can affect handling andstability and cause a crash inwhich you can be hurt or killed.
Follow all load limits and otherloading guidelines in thismanual.
12/08/09 16:33:31 31SJC670_265
2013 Ridgeline
Before
Driving
- ×
The resulting figure equals theavailable amount of cargo andluggage load capacity. Forexample, if the ‘‘XXX’’ amountequals 1,400 lbs. and there will befive 150 lb. passengers in yourvehicle, the amount of availablecargo and luggage load capacityis 650 lbs.(1,400 750 (5 150) = 650 lbs.)
Determine the combined weightof luggage and cargo being loadedon the vehicle. That weight maynot safely exceed the availablecargo and luggage load capacitycalculated in Step 4.
If your vehicle will be towing atrailer, load from your trailer willbe transferred to your vehicle.Consult this manual to determinehow this reduces the availablecargo and luggage load capacity ofyour vehicle.
In addition, the total weight of thevehicle, all occupants, accessories,cargo, and trailer tongue loadmust not exceed the Gross VehicleWeight Rating (GVWR) or the
Gross Axle Weight Rating(GAWR). Both are on a label onthe driver’s doorjamb.
5.
6.
4.
Example 3
Example 2
Example 1
Carrying Cargo
259
Passenger Weight(150 lbs x 2 = 300 lbs)(68 kg x 2 = 136 kg)
Cargo Weight(1,220 lbs)(554 kg)
Max Load (1,520 lbs)(690 kg)
Max Load (1,520 lbs)(690 kg)
Max Load (1,520 lbs)(690 kg)
Passenger Weight(150 lbs x 4 = 600 lbs)(68 kg x 4 = 272 kg)
Passenger Weight(150 lbs x 5 = 750 lbs)(68 kg x 5 = 340 kg)
Cargo Weight(770 lbs)(350 kg)
Cargo Weight(920 lbs)(418 kg)
12/08/09 16:33:43 31SJC670_266
2013 Ridgeline
Before
Driving
Store or secure all items that couldbe thrown around and hurtsomeone during a crash.
Distribute cargo evenly on thefloor in the In-Bed Trunk, placingthe heaviest items on the bottomand as far forward as possible. Tiedown items that could be thrownduring a crash or sudden stop.
Make sure the In-Bed Trunk lid isclosed securely before driving.
Be sure the total weight of theitems in the In-Bed Trunk does notexceed 300 lbs (136 kg).
Be sure items placed on the floorbehind the front seats cannot rollunderneath and interfere with theproper operation of the seats, thesensors under the seats, or thedriver’s ability to operate thepedals.
Keep the glove box closed whiledriving. If it is open, a passengercould injure their knees during acrash or sudden stop.
If you fold the rear seats up, tiedown items that could be thrownabout the vehicle during a crash orsudden stop. Also, keep all cargobelow the bottom of the windows.If it is higher, it could interferewith the proper operation of theside curtain airbags.
Distribute cargo evenly on thefloor of the cargo area with therear seats folded up, placing theheaviest items on the bottom andas far forward as possible. Tiedown items that could be thrownabout the vehicle during a crash orsudden stop. If you carry any items on a roof
rack, be sure the total weight ofthe rack and the items does notexceed 110 lbs (50 kg).
Carrying Items in the PassengerCompartment
Carrying Cargo in the In-BedTrunk or on a Roof Rack
Carrying Cargo
260
12/08/09 16:33:51 31SJC670_267
2013 Ridgeline
Before
Driving
Your vehicle can carry a largeamount of cargo in the pickup bed.
However, the pickup bed is notintended for carrying passengers.People who ride in the pickup bedcan be very seriously injured orkilled in a crash (see page ).
Make sure your cargo is properlyloaded and all items are secured sothey will not shift or fall out whiledriving.
When loading and unloading cargo,make sure all passengers or anyobjects are clear of the tailgatebefore opening or closing it. Thetailgate should be closed securelybefore driving when it is not usedas the extended pickup bed.
The maximum allowable loadingweight on the pickup bed is 1,100lbs (500 kg). Do not exceed theload limit (see page ).
Distribute cargo evenly on thepickup bed. Place the heaviestitems on the bottom and as farforward as possible of the rearaxle. Tie down and secure allitems that could be thrown out ofthe vehicle during a crash orsudden stop.
If you stack items higher than thebed sides, tailgate, or back window,secure them with a net or cover.This will reduce the risk of itemsbeing thrown out of the pickupbed during a crash or sudden stop.
When the tailgate is dropped open,it can be used as an extendedpickup bed. The maximumallowable weight on the tailgatewhile driving is 300 lbs (136 kg).Exceeding this limit could damagethe tailgate.
Carrying heavy cargo in thepickup bed will raise your vehicle’scenter of gravity. This can affecthandling and performance. Drivemore slowly and cautiously, andallow extra time and distance forbraking.
8
258
CONTINUED
Carrying Cargo in the Pickup Bed
Carrying Cargo
261
Allowing passengers to ride inthe pickup bed or on the tailgatecan result in death or seriousinjury in a crash.
Make sure all passengers ridein a seat and wear a seat beltproperly.
12/08/09 16:33:59 31SJC670_268
2013 Ridgeline
Before
Driving
You can also support motorcycles onthe pickup bed floor with the cleats.The floor panel of the pickup bed isdesigned to hold motorcycle tires. Besure to tighten motorcycles securely,with an approved tie-down ormotorcycle strap, according to themotorcycle maker’s instructions.
They are used to secure cargo on thepickup bed and to install a cargo netfor securing items. Do not use anyother parts of the pickup bed tosecure cargo or nets.
When carrying motorcycles or anyother cargo, do not spill any oil orfluid on the pickup bed. A spilledliquid may damage the pickup bed.
Your vehicle has eight tie downcleats on the pickup bed.
Tie Down Cleats
Carrying Cargo
262
TIE DOWN CLEAT
Exceeding load limits orimproperly loading cargo on thevehicle can cause a crash inwhich you can be seriouslyinjured or killed.
Load the cargo carefully beforestarting to drive.
Never let passengers ride in thepickup bed, in the In-Bed Trunkspace, or on the bed rails. Thiscould cause very seriousinjuries or death. No one shouldride in any position on yourvehicle that is not equipped withseats and seat belts.
12/08/09 16:34:06 31SJC670_269
2013 Ridgeline
Before
Driving
The cargo net can be used to holdlightweight items in the pickup bed.Secure all items properly. The netmay not prevent heavy items frombeing thrown outward in a crash or asudden stop.
The cargo cover can be used tocover the cargo area on thepickup bed.
Your vehicle’s pickup bed has a rustresistant surface. To repair smallchips and scratches in the bed, arepair kit is available from yourdealer. More extensive damageshould be repaired by your dealer.
To avoid problems with the bedsurface and the In-Bed Trunk lid, donot use spray-in bed liner products.
Optional Cargo Net Optional Cargo Cover
Pickup Bed Repair
Carrying Cargo
263
12/08/09 16:34:12 31SJC670_270
2013 Ridgeline
Before
Driving
264
12/08/09 16:34:13 31SJC670_271
2013 Ridgeline
This section gives you tips onstarting the engine under variousconditions, and how to operate theautomatic transmission. It alsoincludes important information onparking your vehicle, the brakingsystem, the Variable TorqueManagement 4-wheel drive(VTM-4 ) system, the vehiclestability assist (VSA ), akaElectronic Stability Control (ESC),system, the tire pressure monitoringsystem (TPMS), and facts you needif you are planning to tow a trailer ordrive off-highway.
........................Driving Guidelines . 266
........................Preparing to Drive . 267.......................Starting the Engine . 268
..............Automatic Transmission . 269Variable Torque Management
...........4WD (VTM-4 ) System . 274Tire Pressure Monitoring System
......................................(TPMS) . 276...........................................Parking . 284
.............................Braking System . 286...............Anti-lock Brakes (ABS) . 287
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA ),aka Electronic Stability Control
.......................(ESC), System . 288.................Towing Weight Limits . 291
..........Towing Weight Guidelines . 293...........................Towing a Trailer . 294
Off-Highway Driving..................................Guidelines . 304
Driving
265
12/08/09 16:34:17 31SJC670_272
2013 Ridgeline
Your vehicle has higher groundclearance that allows you to travelover bumps, obstacles, and roughterrain. It also provides goodvisibility so you can anticipateproblems earlier.
With heavy cargo on the pickup bed, your vehicle has a highercenter of gravity. Drive slowlyand cautiously, and allow more time and distance for braking.Loading heavy cargo could affect your vehicle’s handling and performance.
To prevent rollovers or loss of control:
Take corners at slower speedsthan you would with apassenger vehicle.
Avoid sharp turns and abruptmaneuvers whenever possible.
Make sure the cargo is properlyloaded and all items are secured sothey will not shift while driving.
Do not modify your vehiclein any way that would raise thecenter of gravity.
Do not carry heavy cargo on the roof.
Your vehicle allows you to carrymore cargo than a typical passenger vehicle.
Because your vehicle rides higheroff the ground, it has a high centerof gravity that can cause it to rollover if you make abrupt turns.Utility vehicles have a significantlyhigher roll over rate than othertypes of vehicles.
See page for off-highway drivingguidelines.
304
Driving Guidelines
266
12/08/09 16:34:25 31SJC670_273
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
You should do the following checksand adjustments before you driveyour vehicle.
Make sure all windows, mirrors,and outside lights are clean andunobstructed. Remove frost, snow,or ice.
Check that the hood is fully closed.
Check that the tailgate is fullyclosed when it is not used as anextended pickup bed.
Visually check the tires. If a tirelooks low, use a gauge to checkits pressure.
Check that any items you may becarrying are stored properly orfastened down securely.
Check the adjustment of theinside and outside mirrors (seepage ).
Check the steering wheeladjustment (see page ).
Make sure the doors and In-Bed Trunk are securelyclosed and locked.
Fasten your seat belt. Check thatyour passengers have fastenedtheir seat belts (see page ).
Check the seat adjustment (seepages and ).
When you start the engine, checkthe gauges and indicators in theinstrument panel, and themessages on the informationdisplay or multi-informationdisplay (depending on the model)(see pages , , ,
).
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
8.
7.
9.
10.
11.
121
133
99
16
61 76 77
119
Preparing to Drive
Driving
267
12/08/09 16:34:35 31SJC670_274
2013 Ridgeline
and 89
Apply the parking brake.
In cold weather, turn off allelectrical accessories to reducethe drain on the battery.
Make sure the shift lever is inPark. Press on the brake pedal.
Without touching the acceleratorpedal, turn the ignition key to theSTART (III) position. Do not holdthe key in the START (III)position for more than 15 secondsat a time. If the engine does notstart right away, pause for at least10 seconds before trying again.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Starting the Engine
268
The immobilizer system protects yourvehicle f rom thef t. If an improperlycoded key (or other device) is used, theengine’s f uel system is disabled. Formore inf ormation, see page .
The engine is harder to start in coldweather. Also, the thinner air f ound ataltitudes above 8,000 f eet (2,400meters) adds to this problem.
101
12/08/09 16:34:41 31SJC670_275
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
These indicators on the instrumentpanel show which position the shiftlever is in.
The ‘‘D’’ indicator comes on for afew seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. If it flashes while driving (inany shift position), it indicates apossible problem in the transmission.
If the malfunction indicator lampcomes on along with the ‘‘D’’indicator, there is a problem with theautomatic transmission controlsystem. Avoid rapid acceleration, andhave the transmission checked byyour dealer as soon as possible.
To shift from Park to any position,press firmly on the brake pedal, andpull the shift lever toward you. Youcannot shift out of Park when theignition switch is in the LOCK (0) orACCESSORY (I) position.
When the ‘‘D’’ indicator warns of apossible problem with thetransmission, you will see a ‘‘CHECKTRANSMISSION’’ message on themulti-information display (see page ).91
CONTINUED
On models with navigation system
Shift Lever Position Indicators Shifting
Automatic Transmission
269
SHIFT LEVER
12/08/09 16:34:49 31SJC670_276
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
- -This position mechani-cally locks the transmission. UsePark whenever you are turning off orstarting the engine. To shift out ofPark, you must press on the brakepedal and have your foot off theaccelerator pedal. Pull the shift levertowards you, then move it out
If you have done all of the above andstill cannot move the lever out ofPark, see onpage .
You must also pull the shift levertowards you to shift into Park. Toavoid transmission damage, come toa complete stop before shifting intoPark. The shift lever must be in Parkfor you to remove the key from theignition switch.
Press the brakepedal and pull the shift lever towardsyou to shift from Park to reverse. Toshift from reverse to neutral, cometo a complete stop, and then shift.Pull the shift lever towards youbefore shifting into reverse
273To shift from:
P to R
R to PN to RD to 22 to 11 to 22 to DD to NN to DR to N
Do this:Press the brake pedal, andpull the shift lever towardsyou.
Pull the shift lever towardsyou.
Move the shift lever.
Automatic Transmission
Park (P)
Shift Lock Release
Reverse (R)
270
12/08/09 16:34:54 31SJC670_277
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
of Park.from neutral.
--
CONTINUED
Press the D3 switch on the end ofthe shift lever to turn this mode onor off; the D3 indicator comes onwhenever D3 is selected.
The D3 switch can be operated onlywhen the ignition switch is in the ON(II) position and the shift lever is inthe D position.
Use this position foryour normal driving. Thetransmission automatically selects asuitable gear (1 through 5) for yourspeed and acceleration. You maynotice the transmission shifting up athigher engine speeds when theengine is cold. This helps the enginewarm up faster.
After you stop in D, 2, 1, N, or Rposition with the ignition switch inthe ACCESSORY (I) position for anextended period, you may not beable to move the shift lever fromneutral to reverse or Park. In thiscase, press the brake pedal, and turnthe ignition switch to the ON (II)position, then shift out of neutral.
Use neutral if youneed to restart a stalled engine, or ifit is necessary to stop briefly withthe engine idling. Shift to the Parkposition if you need to leave yourvehicle for any reason. Press on thebrake pedal when you are movingthe shift lever from neutral toanother gear.
Automatic Transmission
D3Drive (D)Neutral (N)
271
D3 SWITCH
12/08/09 16:35:00 31SJC670_278
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
- To shift to second,pull the shift lever towards you, thenshift to the lower gear. This positionlocks the transmission in secondgear. It does not downshift to firstgear when you come to a stop.
Use second gear:
For more power when climbing.
To increase engine braking whengoing down steep hills.
For starting out on a slipperysurface or in deep snow.
To help reduce wheel spin.
When driving downhill with atrailer.
This will increase
Shifting out of the D position willcancel D3, and cause the D3indicator to go out. Selecting the Dposition again will resume D3, andthe indicator will come on.
Turning the ignition switch to theLOCK (0) position turns D3 off. Touse D3 when you restart the engine,select the D position, and press theD3 switch again.
The D3 indicator also comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position.
When D3 is on, the transmissionselects only the first three gears.Use D3 for engine braking whengoing down a steep hill.
Automatic Transmission
Second (2)When towing a trailer on level roadsunder normal driving conditions, donot use D3.
272
D3 INDICATOR
12/08/09 16:35:09 31SJC670_279
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
the automatic transmissionfluid temperature and maycause overheating.
- To shift from second tofirst, pull the shift lever towards you,then shift to the lower gear. Thisposition locks the transmission infirst gear. By upshifting anddownshifting through 1, 2, and D,you can operate the transmissionmuch like a manual transmissionwithout a clutch pedal.
If you shift into first position whenthe vehicle speed is above 28 mph(45 km/h), the transmission shiftsinto second gear first to avoidsudden engine braking.
If you exceed the maximum speedfor the gear you are in, the enginespeed will enter into the tachometer’sred zone. If this occurs, you may feelthe engine cut in and out. This iscaused by a limiter in the engine’scomputer controls. The engine willrun normally when you reduce therpm below the red zone.
This allows you to move the shiftlever out of Park if the normalmethod of pushing on the brakepedal and pulling the shift lever doesnot work.
Set the parking brake.
Make sure the ignition switch is inthe LOCK (0) position.
Put a cloth on the notch of theshift lock release slot cover toprevent scratches. Using a smallflat-tip screwdriver or a metalfingernail file, carefully pry on thenotch of the cover to remove it.
1.
2.
3.
CONTINUED
First (1) Engine Speed Limiter Shift Lock Release
Automatic Transmission
273
12/08/09 16:35:17 31SJC670_280
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
Insert the built-in key into the shiftlock release slot.
Push down on the key while youpull the shift lever towards you,and move it out of Park to neutral.
Remove the key from the shiftlock release slot, then reinstall thecover. Make sure the notch on thecover is on the instrument panelside. Insert the key into theignition switch, press the brakepedal, and restart the engine.
Your vehicle is equipped with aVariable Torque Management4-wheel-drive system (VTM-4 ) thatdistributes engine torque to theappropriate drive axle depending onthe available traction conditions. Thesystem is completely automatic,always active, and does not requireany driver interaction.
If you need to use the shift lockrelease, it means your vehicle isdeveloping a problem. Have itchecked by your dealer.
6.4.
5.
Automatic Transmission, VTM-4 System
VTM-4 System
274
SHIFT LOCK RELEASE SLOT
COVER
VTM-4 LOCK BUTTON
12/08/09 16:35:25 31SJC670_281
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
Press the VTM-4 LOCK button.The indicator in the button comes on.
To get unstuck, apply light pressureto the accelerator pedal. Do not spinthe front tires for more than a fewseconds. Because of the amount oftorque applied to the rear tires, theyshould not spin. This is normal. Ifyou are not able to move the vehicle,stop and reverse direction.
If you become stuck, you canactivate the VTM-4 by pressing theVTM-4 LOCK button while in first(1), second (2), or reverse (R) gearbelow 18 mph (30 km/h). This modeoverrides the auto system to sendmaximum torque to the rear axle.This mode is only intended forintermittent use at low speed to freeyour vehicle if it becomes stuck orwhen you encounter a steep gradewith one wheel on a slippery surface.Generally, you should first allow theauto mode to operate to adjust forthe available traction conditions.
Turn the ignition switch to theLOCK (0) position.
Move the shift lever to D.
Press the VTM-4 LOCK button.
doany of the following:
The VTM-4 Lock will temporarilydisengage when the vehicle speedexceeds 18 mph (30 km/h). Theindicator in the button will remain on.
The vehicle speed must be below18 mph (30 km/h).
Move the shift lever to first (1),second (2), or reverse (R) gear.
1.
2.
3.
VTM-4 System
To Engage the VTM-4 Lock:
To Disengage the VTM-4 Lock,
275
Do not use the VTM-4 LOCK button ondry, paved roads. Driving on dry,paved roads with VTM-4 Lock ON maydamage the rear dif f erential whenmaking a turn. Strange noise andvibration can also result.
Do not continuously spin the f ront tiresof your vehicle. Continuously spinningthe f ront tires can cause transmissionor rear dif f erential damage.
12/08/09 16:35:34 31SJC670_282
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
When the low tire pressure indicatoris on, one or more of your tires issignificantly underinflated. Youshould stop and check your tires assoon as possible, and inflate them tothe proper pressure as indicated onthe vehicle’s tire information placard.
If you think you can safely drive ashort distance to a service station,proceed slowly, and inflate the tire tothe recommended pressure shownon the driver’s doorjamb.
If the tire is flat, or if the tirepressure is too low to continuedriving, replace the tire with thecompact spare tire (see page ).
If you cannot make the low tirepressure indicator go out afterinflating the tires to the specifiedvalues, have your dealer check thesystem as soon as possible.
Driving on a significantly underinflated tire causes the tire tooverheat and can lead to tire failure.Underinflation also reduces fuelefficiency and tire tread life, and mayaffect the vehicle’s handling andstopping ability.
Because tire pressure varies bytemperature and other conditions,the low tire pressure indicator maycome on unexpectedly.
Each tire has its own pressuresensor (not including the spare tire).If the air pressure of a tire becomessignificantly low, the sensor in thattire immediately sends a signal thatcauses the low tire pressureindicator and the appropriate tire onthe tire pressure monitor to come on.
Your vehicle is equipped with a tirepressure monitoring system (TPMS)that turns on every time you start theengine and monitors the pressure inyour tires while driving.
358
On models without navigation system
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Low Tire PressureIndicator
276
12/08/09 16:35:42 31SJC670_283
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
This indicator comes on and stays onif there is a problem with the tirepressure monitoring system.
If this happens, the system will shutoff and no longer monitor tirepressures. Have the system checkedby your dealer as soon as possible.
If the low tire pressure indicator orTPMS indicator comes on, the VSAsystem automatically turns on even ifthe VSA system is turned off bypressing the VSA OFF switch (seepage ). If this happens, youcannot turn the VSA system off bypressing the VSA OFF switch again.
Although your tire pressure ismonitored, you must manually checkthe tire pressures monthly.
The appropriate tire indicator andlow tire pressure indicator comes onif a tire becomes significantlyunderinflated. See
on page .
For example, if you check and fillyour tires in a warm area, then drivein extremely cold weather, the tirepressure will be lower thanmeasured and could be underinflatedand cause the low tire pressureindicator to come on. Or, if youcheck and adjust your tire pressurein cooler conditions, and drive intoextremely hot conditions, the tiremay become overinflated. However,the low tire pressure indicator willnot come on if the tires areoverinflated.
Refer to page for tireinflation guidelines.
When you restart the vehicle withthe compact spare tire, the TPMSindicator may also come on and stay on after driving several miles (kilometers).
Each tire, including the spare, shouldbe checked monthly when cold, andset to the recommended inflationpressure as specified on the tireinformation label and in the owner’smanual (see page ).
346
347
276290
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Tire Pressure MonitoringSystem (TPMS) Indicator
Tire Pressure Monitor
Low TirePressure Indicator
277
12/08/09 16:35:50 31SJC670_284
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
If you have a flat tire, the low tirepressure indicator will come on.Replace the indicated flat tire withthe compact spare tire (see page ).
Each wheel (except the compactspare tire wheel) is equipped with atire pressure sensor. You must useTPMS specific wheels. It isrecommended that you always haveyour tires serviced by your dealer orqualified technician.
After you replace the flat tire withthe compact spare tire, the low tirepressure indicator stays on. This isnormal; the system is not monitoringthe spare tire pressure. Manuallycheck the spare tire pressure to besure it is correct. After several miles(kilometers) driving with thecompact spare tire, the TPMSindicator comes on and the low tirepressure indicator goes off.
The low tire pressure indicator orthe TPMS indicator will go off, afterseveral miles (kilometers) driving,when you replace the spare tire withthe specified regular tire equippedwith the tire pressure monitor sensor.
Never use a puncture-repairing agentin a flat tire. If used, you will have toreplace the tire pressure sensor.Have the flat tire repaired by yourdealer as soon as possible.
This device complies with theappropriate requirements or therequired standards. See page formore information.
358
400
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Changing a Tire with TPMS
278
12/08/09 16:35:56 31SJC670_285
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
CONTINUED
If you think you can safely drive ashort distance to a service station,proceed slowly to the station, theninflate the tire to therecommended pressure.
If the tire is flat, or if the tirepressure is too low to continuedriving, replace the tire with thecompact spare tire (see page ).
Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire tooverheat and can lead to tire failure.Under-inflation also reduces fuelefficiency and tire tread life, and mayaffect the vehicle’s handling andstopping ability.
Because tire pressure varies bytemperature and other conditions,the low tire pressure/TPMSindicator may come on unexpectedly.
When the low tire pressure/TPMSindicator is on, one or more of yourtires is significantly underinflated.You should stop and check yourtires as soon as possible, and inflatethem to the proper pressureas indicated on the vehicle’s tireinformation placard.
It is possible that thepressures shown on the multi-information display and thepressures you manuallymeasure are slightly different.
If the difference is significant or youcannot make the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator and message on themulti-information display go out afterinflating the tires to the specifiedvalues, have your dealer check thesystem as soon as possible.
Each tire has its own pressuresensor. If the air pressure of a tirebecomes significantly low, thesensor in that tire immediatelysends a signal that causes the lowtire pressure/TPMS indicatorin the instrument panel to come on.If this happens, you will seewhich tire is losing pressure on themulti- information displayalong with a ‘‘CHECKTIRE PRESSURE’’ message.
Your vehicle is equipped with a tirepressure monitoring system (TPMS)that turns on every time you start theengine and monitors the pressure inyour tires while driving.
358
On models with navigation system Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
279
12/08/09 16:36:04 31SJC670_286
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
Although your tire pressure ismonitored, you must manually checkthe tire pressures monthly.
Each tire, including the spare,should be checked monthlywhen the vehicle is cold, and setto the recommended inflation pressure as specified on the vehicleplacard and in the owner’s manual (see page ).
To select the tire pressure monitor,press the INFO button several timeswith the ignition switch in the ON(II) position.
You will see the above display on themulti-information display when alltire pressures are normal.
For example, if you check and fillyour tires in a warm area, then drivein extremely cold weather, the tirepressure will be lower thanmeasured and could be underinflatedand cause the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator to come on. Or, ifyou check and adjust your tirepressure in cooler conditions, anddrive into extremely hot conditions,the tire may become overinflated.However, the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator will not come on ifthe tires are overinflated.
Refer to page for tire inflationguidelines.
If there is a problem with the TPMS,this indicator begins to flash. It stopsflashing after approximately 1minute, then stays on. You will alsosee a ‘‘CHECK TPMS SYSTEM’’message on the multi-informationdisplay (see page ).91
346
347
Tire Pressure Monitor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
280
12/08/09 16:36:11 31SJC670_287
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
CONTINUED
To see the inflation pressures of allfour tires, press the SEL/RESETbutton. The display changes asshown above.
Each tire pressure is shown in PSI (U.S. models) or in kPa(Canadian models).
Each tire has its own pressuresensor. If the air pressure of a tirebecomes significantly low, thesensor in that tire immediatelysends a signal that causes the lowtire pressure/TPMS indicatorin the instrument panel to come on.If this happens, you will seewhich tire is losing pressure on themulti- information displayalong with a ‘‘CHECKTIRE PRESSURE’’ message.
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
281
U.S. models Canadian models
12/08/09 16:36:18 31SJC670_288
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
If there is a problem with theTPMS, the tire pressure monitorshows a ‘‘SYSTEM FUNCTIONERROR’’ message and the tirepressure readings are not displayed.If this happens, you will first see asystem warning message ‘‘CHECKTPMS SYSTEM’’ on the multi-information display.
If there is a problem with the TPMS,you will see the above message onthe multi-information display.
If you see this message, the systemis off and is not monitoring the tirepressures. Have the system checkedby your dealer as soon as possible.
Also, the low tire pressure/TPMSindicator begins to flash, then stayson (see page ).279
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
TPMS System Failure
282
12/08/09 16:36:24 31SJC670_289
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
If the low tire pressure/TPMSindicator comes on, or the multi-information display shows a‘‘CHECK TPMS SYSTEM’’ message,the VSA system automatically turnson even when the VSA system isturned off by pressing the VSA OFFswitch (see page ). If thishappens, you cannot turn the VSAsystem off by pressing the VSA OFFswitch again.
When you restart the vehicle withthe compact spare tire, the TPMSsystem message will also bedisplayed on the multi-informationdisplay after several miles(kilometers) driving.
This indicator and the warningmessage on the multi-informationdisplay will go off, after several miles(kilometers) driving, when the sparetire is replaced with the specifiedregular tire equipped with the tirepressure monitor sensor.
If you have a flat tire, the low tirepressure/TPMS and tire monitorindicators will come on. Replace theindicated flat tire with the compactspare tire (see page ).
After the flat tire is replaced with the spare tire, the low tirepressure/ TPMS indicatorstays on while driving. Afterseveral miles (kilometers) driving,this indicator begins to flash,then stays on again.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK TPMSSYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display. This is normal;the system cannot monitor thespare tire pressure. Manually checkthe spare tire pressure to be sure itis correct.
Each wheel (except the compactspare tire wheel) is equipped with atire pressure sensor. You must useTPMS specific wheels. It isrecommended that you always haveyour tires serviced by your dealer orqualified technician.
Never use a puncture-repairing agentin a flat tire. If used, you will have toreplace the tire pressure sensor.Have the flat tire repaired by yourdealer as soon as possible.
290
358
CONTINUED
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Changing a Tire with TPMS
283
12/08/09 16:36:31 31SJC670_290
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
This device complies with theappropriate requirements or therequired standards. See page formore information.
Always use the parking brake whenyou park your vehicle. Make surethe parking brake is set firmly, oryour vehicle may roll if it is parkedon an incline.
Set the parking brake before you putthe transmission in Park. This keepsthe vehicle from moving and puttingpressure on the parking mechanismin the transmission.
400
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS), Parking
Parking
284
12/08/09 16:36:35 31SJC670_291
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
Make sure the parking brake isfully released before driving away.Driving with the parking brakepartially set can overheat ordamage the rear brakes.
Make sure the moonroof (ifequipped) and thewindows are closed.
Turn off the lights.
Place any packages, valuables, etc.in the cargo area in your vehicle orthe In-Bed Trunk, or take themwith you.
Lock the doors.
Check the indicator on the driver’sdoor to verify that the securitysystem is set.
Never park over dry leaves, tallgrass, or other flammablematerials. The hot three waycatalytic converter could causethese materials to catch on fire.
If the vehicle is facing uphill,turn the front wheels awayfrom the curb.
If the vehicle is facing downhill,turn the front wheels toward the curb.
On vehicles with security system
Parking
Parking Tips
285
12/08/09 16:36:43 31SJC670_292
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
Your vehicle is equipped with discbrakes at all four wheels. A powerassist helps reduce the effort neededon the brake pedal. The emergencybrake assist system increases thestopping force when you depress thebrake pedal hard in an emergencysituation. The anti-lock brake system(ABS) helps you retain steeringcontrol when braking very hard.
Resting your foot on the pedal keepsthe brakes applied lightly, builds upheat, reduces their effectiveness andreduces brake pad life. In addition,fuel economy can be reduced. It alsokeeps your brake lights on all thetime, confusing drivers behind you.
Constant application of the brakeswhen going down a long hill buildsup heat and reduces their effective-ness. Use the engine to assist thebrakes by taking your foot off theaccelerator and downshifting to alower gear.
Check the brakes after drivingthrough deep water. Apply thebrakes moderately to see if they feelnormal. If not, apply them gently andfrequently until they do. Be extracautious and alert in your driving.
The hydraulic system that operatesthe brakes has two separate circuits.Each circuit works diagonally acrossthe vehicle (the left-front brake isconnected with the right-rear brake,etc.). If one circuit should develop aproblem, you will still have brakingat two wheels.
If the brake pads need replacing, youwill hear a distinctive, metallicscreeching sound when you applythe brake pedal. If you do not havethe brake pads replaced, they willscreech all the time. It is normal forthe brakes to occasionally squeal orsqueak when you apply them.
Braking System Design
Brake Pad Wear Indicators
Braking System
286
12/08/09 16:36:50 31SJC670_293
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
The anti-lock brake system (ABS)helps prevent the wheels fromlocking up, and helps you retainsteering control by pumping thebrakes rapidly, much faster than aperson can do it.
The electronic brake distribution(EBD) system, which is part of theABS, also balances the front-to-rearbraking distribution according tovehicle loading.
If this indicator comes on, the anti-lock function of the braking systemhas shut down. The brakes still worklike a conventional system, butwithout anti-lock. You should haveyour dealer inspect your vehicle assoon as possible.
You will feel a pulsation in the brakepedal when the ABS activates, andyou may hear some noise. This isnormal: it is the ABS rapidlypumping the brakes. On drypavement, you will need to press onthe brake pedal very hard before theABS activates. However, you mayfeel the ABS activate immediately ifyou are trying to stop on snow or ice.
Let the ABS work for you by alwayskeeping firm, steady pressure on thebrake pedal. This is sometimesreferred to as ‘‘stomp and steer.’’
If the indicator comes on whiledriving, test the brakes as instructedon page .
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK ABSSYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).91
374
You should never pump the brake pedal.
On models with navigation system
CONTINUED
ABS Indicator
Anti-lock Brakes (ABS)
287
12/08/09 16:36:57 31SJC670_294
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
Always steer moderatelywhen you are braking hard. Severeor sharp steering wheel movementcan still cause your vehicle to veerinto oncoming traffic or off the road.
such as trying to take acorner too fast or making asudden lane change. Always driveat a safe speed for theroad and weather conditions.
It only helps with thesteering control during braking.
If the ABS indicator and the brakesystem indicator come on together,and the parking brake is fullyreleased, the EBD system may alsobe shut down.
Test your brakes as instructed onpage . If the brakes feel normal,drive slowly and have your vehiclerepaired by your dealer as soon aspossible. Avoid sudden hard brakingwhich could cause the rear wheels tolock up and possibly lead to a loss
If this happens, you will also seethe ‘‘CHECK ABS SYSTEM’’ and‘‘CHECK BRAKE SYSTEM’’messages on the multi-informationdisplay.
on loose oruneven surfaces, such as gravel or snow, than a vehicle withoutanti-lock.
When VSA activates, you may noticethat the engine does not respond tothe accelerator in the same way itdoes at other times. There may alsobe some noise from the VSAhydraulic system. You will also seethe VSA system indicator blink.
The vehicle stability assist (VSA)system helps to stabilize the vehicleduring cornering if the vehicle turnsmore or less than desired. It alsoassists you in maintaining tractionwhile accelerating on loose orslippery road surfaces. It does thisby regulating the engine’s output andby selectively applying the brakes.
The VSA system cannot enhance thevehicle’s driving stability in allsituations and does not control yourvehicle’s entire braking system. It isstill your responsibility to drive andcorner at reasonable speeds and toleave a sufficient margin of safety.
374
On models with navigation system
Important Safety Reminders
ABS cannot prevent a loss ofstability.
ABS will not prevent a skid thatresults from changing directionabruptly,
ABS does not reduce the time ordistance it takes to stop thevehicle.
A vehicle with ABS may require alonger distance to stop
Anti-lock Brakes (ABS), Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA ), aka Electronic Stability Control (ESC), System
288
12/08/09 16:37:06 31SJC670_295
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
of control.
When VSA is off, the VSA OFFindicator comes on as a reminder.
When VSA activates, you will see theVSA system indicator blink.
If this indicator comes on whiledriving, pull to the side of the roadwhen it is safe, and turn off theengine. Reset the system byrestarting the engine. If the VSAsystem indicator stays on or comesback on while driving, have the VSAsystem inspected by your dealer.
The main function of theVSA system is generally known asElectronic Stability Control (ESC).The system also includes a tractioncontrol function.
If the low tire pressure/TPMSindicator comes on, see page .Or, if the multi-information displayshows a ‘‘CHECK TPMSSYSTEM’’ message with theindicator flashing, see page .
If the low tire pressure indicator orTPMS indicator comes on, seepage .
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK VSASYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display if there is aproblem with the VSA system.
If the indicator does not come onwhen the ignition switch is turned tothe ON (II) position, there may be aproblem with the VSA system. Haveyour dealer inspect your vehicle assoon as possible.
In this case, you cannot turn off theVSA using the OFF switch again.
Without VSA, your vehicle will havenormal braking and cornering ability,but it will not have VSA traction andstability enhancement.
91
276
279
On models with navigation system
On models with navigation system
On models without navigation system
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA ), aka Electronic Stability Control (ESC), System
VSA OFF Indicator
Vehicle Stability Assist(VSA) System Indicator
289
NOTE:
12/08/09 16:37:16 31SJC670_296
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
Driving with varying tire or wheelsizes may cause the VSA tomalfunction. When replacing tires,make sure they are of the same sizeand type as your original tires (seepage ).
If you install winter tires, make surethey are the same size as those thatwere originally supplied with yourvehicle. Exercise the same cautionduring winter driving as you would
VSA is turned on every time youstart the engine, even if you turned it off the last time you drovethe vehicle.
This switch is above the parkingbrake release handle. To turn theVSA system on and off, press andhold it until you hear a beep.
When VSA is off, the VSA OFFindicator comes on as a reminder.Press and hold the switch again. Itturns the system back on.
In certain unusual conditions whenyour vehicle gets stuck in shallowmud or fresh snow, it may be easierto free it with the VSA temporarilyswitched off. When the VSA systemis off, the traction control system isalso off. You should only attempt tofree your vehicle with the VSA off ifyou are not able to free it when theVSA is on.
Immediately after freeing yourvehicle, be sure to switch the VSA onagain. We do not recommend drivingyour vehicle with the VSA andtraction control systems switched off.
350
VSA OFF Switch VSA and Tire Sizes
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA ), aka Electronic Stability Control (ESC), System
290
12/08/09 16:37:24 31SJC670_297
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
with VSA.if your vehicle was not equipped
Your vehicle has been designed totow a trailer, as well as carryingpassengers and their cargo. Tosafely tow a trailer, you shouldcarefully observe the load limits (seepage ), use the proper equipment,and follow the guidelines in thissection.
The maximum allowable weight ofthe trailer and everything in or on itdepends on the number of occupantsin your vehicle and the type of trailerbeing towed (see page ).
Towing a trailer that is too heavy canseriously affect your vehicle’shandling and performance. It canalso damage the engine anddrivetrain.
Avoid towing a trailer during yourvehicle’s first 600 miles (1,000 km)(see page ).
Be sure to read thesection on
258
244
293
CONTINUED
Towing Weight Limits
Load Limits
Off-HighwayDriving Guidelines
Total Trailer Weight
Break-In Period
291
Exceeding any load limit orimproperly loading your vehicleand trailer can cause a crash inwhich you can be seriously hurtor killed.
Check the loading of yourvehicle and trailer carefullybefore starting to drive.
12/08/09 16:37:32 31SJC670_298
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
page 304 if you plan to tow offpaved surfaces.
-
-
-
The best way to confirm that allloads are within limits is to checkthem at a public scale (seepage ).
To help ensure a safe drive to a scale,or if you cannot get to a public scale,we recommend that you estimateyour total trailer weight and tongueload as described.
Add the weight of your trailer (asquoted by the manufacturer) witheverything in or on the trailer. Thencheck the tables on page tomake sure you do not exceed thelimit for your conditions.
The maximumallowable weight of the vehicle, alloccupants, all accessories, all cargo,and the tongue load is 6,050 lbs(2,745 kg).
The maximumallowable weight on the vehicle axlesis 3,105 lbs (1,410 kg) on the frontaxle, and 3,245 lbs (1,475 kg) on therear axle.
The maximumallowable weight of the fully loadedvehicle and trailer is 10,088 lbs(4,575 kg) with the proper hitch.
The GCWR must be reduced 2percent for every 1,000 feet (305meters) of elevation.
The weight that the tongue of a fully-loaded trailer puts on the hitchshould follow the recommended loadguidelines (see page ). Toomuch tongue load reduces front-tiretraction and steering control. Toolittle tongue load can make thetrailer unstable and cause it to sway.
293
291
293
Towing Weight Limits
Estimating LoadsGross Vehicle Weight Rating(GVWR)
Gross Axle Weight Rating(GAWR)
Gross Combined Weight Rating(GCWR)
To Estimate the Total Trailer WeightTongue Load
292
12/08/09 16:37:41 31SJC670_299
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
- -
*
**
*
**
Number ofOccupants
2345
Max. Trailer Weight Max. Tongue Load
Towing Weight Guidelines
293
Total Trailer Weight and Tongue Load Guidelines:
Recommended tongue load should be 5 15% of the total trailer weight for boat trailers, and 10 15% of the total trailer weight for all othertrailers.
The corresponding weight limits assume occupants fill seats from the front of the vehicle to the back, each occupant weighs 150 lbs (70 kg),and each has 15 lbs (7 kg) of cargo in the cab, pickup bed, or In-Bed Trunk. Any additional weight, including cargo or accessories, reducesthe maximum trailer weight and maximum tongue load. Never exceed the gross axle weight ratings (see page ).292
5,000 lbs (2268 kg)4,750 lbs (2155 kg)4,750 lbs (2155 kg)4,500 lbs (2041 kg)
600 lbs (272 kg)600 lbs (272 kg)570 lbs (258 kg)516 lbs (234 kg)
12/08/09 16:37:47 31SJC670_300
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
To accurately check your loads atthe public scale, the vehicle andtrailer should be fully loaded,and all occupants should stay in thevehicle while the attendantwatches the scale.
Check the front gross axle weight.Limit: 3,105 lbs (1,410 kg)
Check the gross vehicle weight.Limit: 6,050 lbs (2,745 kg)
Check the weight of the hitchedtrailer. Write this number down.
Check the gross combined weight.Limit: 10,088 lbs (4,575 kg)Remember, maximum grosscombined weight should bedecreased 2% for every 1,000 feet(305 meters) of elevation.
If you cannot weigh the rear axledirectly, you can calculate the reargross axle weight by subtractingthe weight in step 1 from theweight in step 2.Limit: 2,945 lbs (1,335 kg)
Check the rear gross axle weight.Limit: 3,245 lbs (1,475 kg)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Checking Loads
Towing a Trailer
294
12/08/09 16:37:56 31SJC670_301
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
Check the weight of the unhitchedtrailer. Limit: See page .
Towing generally requires a varietyof supplemental equipment. Toensure the best quality, werecommend that you purchaseHonda equipment whenever possible.
Discuss any additional needs withyour trailer sales or rental agency,and make sure all equipment isproperly installed, maintained, andalso meets state, federal, province,and local regulations.
Your dealer offers trailer packagesthat include a ball mount, hitch plug,and hitch pin. A wiring harness kit isalso available from your dealer.
Read the trailer manufacturer’sinstructions, and select theappropriate draw bar for the heightof the trailer you will be towing.
A weight distributing hitch is notrecommended for use with yourvehicle, as an improperly adjustedweight distributing hitch mayreduce handling, stability,and braking performance.Calculate the tongue load.
Subtract the weight in step 6 fromthe weight in step 7.Limit: See page .Recommended: see page .Range: 5-15% for boat trailers
10-15% for other trailers
7.
8.
293
293293
CONTINUED
Towing Equipment andAccessories
Hitch
Weight Distributing Hitch
Towing a Trailer
295
12/08/09 16:38:05 31SJC670_302
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
There are two common types oftrailer brakes: surge and electric.Surge brakes are common for boattrailers, since the brakes will get wet.
If you choose electric brakes, besure they are electronically actuated.Do not attempt to tap into yourvehicle’s hydraulic system. Nomatter how successful it may seem,any attempt to attach trailer brakesto your vehicle’s hydraulic systemwill lower braking effectiveness andcreate a potential hazard.
A factory installed, 4-pin grayconnector is located under theinstrument panel near the top of theparking brake pedal. This connectorhas all of the circuits required toinstall most electric trailer brakecontrollers. A jumper harness toadapt your electric trailer brakecontroller to the vehicle is includedwith the optional Genuine Hondatrailer hitch kit. To obtain a trailerhitch kit, see your dealer.
Have a qualified mechanic installyour trailer brake controllerfollowing the trailer brake controllermanufacturer’s instructions. Failureto properly install the trailer brakecontroller may increase the distanceit takes for you to stop your vehiclewhen towing a trailer.
Use this illustration to identify eachterminal in the trailer brakecontroller connector.
Honda recommends that any trailerwith a total trailer weight of 1,000 lbs(450 kg) or more has its own brakes.
See your trailer dealer or rentalagency for more information oninstalling electric brakes.
Trailer Brakes
Towing a Trailer
296
BRAKE(20A)(BLUE)
ELECTRIC BRAKE(BROWN/WHITE)
GROUND(BLACK)
STOP(SKY BLUE)
12/08/09 16:38:13 31SJC670_303
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
Always use safety chains when youtow a trailer. Make sure the chainsare secured to the trailer and hitch,and that they cross under the tongueand can catch the trailer if itbecomes unhitched. Leave enoughslack to allow the trailer to turncorners easily, but do not let thechains drag on the ground.
When towing a trailer, werecommend that you carry a full-sizespare wheel and tire for your vehicleand trailer. See page for propertire size, page for how to store afull size wheel and tire, and page
for information on changing aflat tire.
Remember to unhitch the trailerbefore changing a flat. Ask yourtrailer sales or rental agencywhere and how to store thetrailer’s spare tire.
This device is recommended if yourtrailer tends to sway. Your trailerdealer or rental agency can tell youwhat kind of sway control you needand how to install it.
Many states and provinces requirespecial exterior mirrors when towinga trailer. Even if they don’t, youshould install special mirrors if youcannot clearly see behind you, or ifthe trailer creates a blind spot.
350364
359
Safety Chains
Sway Control
Spare Tires
Trailer Mirrors
Towing a Trailer
297
12/08/09 16:38:20 31SJC670_304
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
+
Trailer lights and equipment mustcomply with federal, state, province/territory, and local regulations.Check trailer light requirements forthe areas where you plan to tow, anduse only equipment designed foryour vehicle.
Refer to the above illustration forwiring information.
We recommend that you have yourdealer install a Honda wiring harnessand converter. This harness hasbeen designed for your vehicle.
Your vehicle is equipped with atrailer lighting connector.
Your vehicle is equipped with aconnector to install an optional trailerlighting connector that mates withyour vehicle. You can get thisoptional connector from your dealer.
Since lighting and wiring vary withtrailer type and brand, you shouldalso have a qualified mechanic installa suitable connector between thevehicle and the trailer.
Except RT and U.S. Sport models
On RT and U.S. Sport models
Trailer Lights
Towing a Trailer
298
TAILLIGHTS(GREEN/BLACK)
ELECTRIC BRAKE(BROWN/WHITE)
RIGHT TURN SIGNALAND BRAKE LIGHTS(GREEN/RED)
GROUND(BLACK)
B CHARGE(GREEN)
LEFT TURN SIGNALAND BRAKE LIGHTS(GREEN/RED)
BACK-UP LIGHTS(BLUE)
12/08/09 16:38:27 31SJC670_305
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
CONTINUED
Insert the connector securely intothe socket.
Hook the retaining tab on theinner side of the lid against theretaining tab of the connector toprevent disconnection duringoperation.
Your vehicle has a class 3 trailerhitch as standard equipment.
Make sure the connector and thesocket are free of dirt, moisture,or other foreign material.
Open the socket lid by pulling it up.
Also see page for trailer-relatedinformation.
The 7-pin trailer connector is neededfor the trailer lights. To connect theconnector:
1.
2.
3.
4.
295
Except RT and U.S. Sport modelsTowing Equipment
Towing a Trailer
Connecting the Trailer Connectors
299
TRAILER HITCH
7-PIN TRAILER CONNECTOR
7-PIN TRAILER CONNECTOR
LID
RETAININGTAB
SOCKET
RETAINING TAB
12/08/09 16:38:37 31SJC670_306
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
+
Refer to the above illustrations forwiring information.
The trailer jumper harness is used toinstall the controller for the electrictrailer brakes. For more information,see on page .
Insert the trailer brake fuse into thesecondary under-hood fuse box (seepage ).
296
379
Except RT and U.S. Sport models Except RT and U.S. Sport modelsTrailer Connector Sockets Trailer Jumper Harness
Trailer Brakes
Trailer Brake Fuse
Towing a Trailer
300
7-PIN TRAILER SOCKET
SMALLLIGHT(GREEN)
BACK LIGHT(YELLOW)
GROUND(WHITE)
GROUND(BLACK)
ELECTRIC BRAKE(BROWN/WHITE)
LEFTTURN/STOP(RED) BRAKE
(20A)(BLUE)
BCHARGE(BLACK)
RIGHTTURN/STOP(BROWN)
ELECTRICBRAKE(BLUE)
BRAKE LIGHTS(SKY BLUE)
12/08/09 16:38:45 31SJC670_307
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
The added weight, length, andheight of a trailer will affect yourvehicle’s handling and performance,so driving with a trailer requiressome special driving skills and techniques.
The vehicle has been properlyserviced, and the tires, brakes,suspension, cooling system,and lights are in good operating condition.
The trailer has been properlyserviced and is in good condition.
All weights and loads arewithin limits.
The hitch, safety chains, and anyother attachments are secure.
All items on and in the trailer areproperly secured and cannot shiftwhile you drive.
When preparing to tow, and before driving away, be sure to check the following:
Towing performance can beaffected by high altitude, hightemperature, or when climbingsteep grades. Therefore,premium fuel (premium unleaded gasolinewith pump octane number of 91 or higher)is recommended whentowing more than 3,500 lbs (1,590 kg).
The trailer tires and spare arein good condition and inflated as recommended bythe trailer maker.
Your vehicle tires and spareare in good condition and properly inflated.
The lights and brakes on yourvehicle and the trailer areworking properly.
For your safety and the safety ofothers, take time to practice drivingmaneuvers before heading for theopen road, and follow the guidelineson the following page.
CONTINUED
Driving Safely With a TrailerPre-Tow Checklist
Towing a Trailer
301
12/08/09 16:38:56 31SJC670_308
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
Drive slower than normal in alldriving situations, and obey postedspeed limits for vehicles with trailers.When towing a fixed-sided trailer (e.g.,camper), do not exceed 55 mph (88km/h). At higher speeds, the trailermay sway or affect vehicle handling.
When towing a trailer on level roadsunder normal driving conditions, donot use D3. This will increase theautomatic transmission fluidtemperature and may causeoverheating.
With heavy cargo on the pickup bed, your vehicle has a highercenter of gravity. Drive slowlyand cautiously, and allow more timeand distance for braking. Loading heavy cargo could affect yourvehicle’s handling and performance.
Make turns more slowly and widerthan normal. The trailer tracks asmaller arc than your vehicle, and itcan hit or run over something thevehicle misses.
Allow more time and distance forbraking. Do not brake or turnsuddenly as this could cause thetrailer to jackknife or turn over.
When driving down hills, reduceyour speed, and use D3. Do not‘‘ride’’ the brakes.
If you must stop when facing uphill,use the foot brake or parking brake.Do not try to hold the vehicle inplace by pressing on the accelerator,as this can cause the automatictransmission to overheat.
When climbing hills, closely watchyour temperature gauge. If it nearsthe red (Hot) mark, turn the airconditioning off, reduce speed and, ifnecessary, pull to the side of theroad to let the engine cool.
If the automatic transmission fluidtemperature increases and exceedsthe specified limit, the A/Ttemperature indicator comes on (seepage ).
You will also see an ‘‘A/T TEMPHIGH’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
69
91
On models with navigation system
Towing Speeds and Gears
Making Turns and Braking
Driving on Hills
Towing a Trailer
Remember, ittakes longer to slow down andstop when towing a trailer.
302
12/08/09 16:39:06 31SJC670_309
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
If the vehicle’s tires slip whenretrieving a boat from the water,shift to first gear, and turn on VTM-4lock (see page ). DisengageVTM-4 lock as soon as the boat isout of the water to prevent damageto the VTM-4 system.
Your vehicle is not designed to betowed behind a motor home. If yourvehicle needs to be towed in anemergency, see page .
Do not park on an incline unless it isunavoidable. If you must park on anincline, follow the steps below tohelp prevent the vehicle and trailerfrom rolling and possibly injuringsomeone.
Turn the front wheels toward thecurb on a downhill, and away fromthe curb on an uphill.
With the foot brake fully pressed,have someone place wheel chockson the downhill side of the vehicleand trailer wheels.
Firmly apply the parking brakebefore you put the transmission inPark. This keeps the vehicle fromputting pressure on the parkingmechanism in the transmission. Italso makes it easier to move theshift lever out of Park when youwant to drive away.
Crosswinds and air turbulencecaused by passing trucks can disruptyour steering and cause the trailer tosway. When being passed by a largevehicle, keep a constant speed, andsteer straight ahead. Do not try tomake quick steering or brakingcorrections.
When parking on level ground,follow all normal precautions (seepage ) including putting thetransmission in Park, and firmlysetting the parking brake.
Always drive slowly and havesomeone guide you when backing up.Grip the of the steering wheel,then turn the wheel to the left to getthe trailer to move to the left. Turnthe wheel to the right to move thetrailer to the right.
1.
2.
3.
284
274
381bottom
Retrieving a BoatHandling Crosswinds and Buffeting
Parking
Backing Up
Towing a Trailer
Towing Your Vehicle
303
12/08/09 16:39:15 31SJC670_310
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
Your vehicle has been designedprimarily for use on pavement. Butits higher ground clearance and four-wheel drive VTM-4 system allowyou to occasionally travel on unpavedroads and surfaces. Your vehicle isnot designed for trailblazing,mountain climbing, or otherchallenging off-road activities.
If you decide to drive on unpavedroads, you will find that it requiressomewhat different driving skills.Your vehicle will also handlesomewhat differently than itdoes on pavement. Be sure to payextra attention to the precautions and tips in this section, and getacquainted with your vehicle beforeleaving the pavement.
General Information
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
304
Improperly operating thisvehicle on or off-pavement cancause a crash or rollover inwhich you and your passengerscould be seriously injured orkilled.
Keep your speed low, anddon’t drive faster thanconditions permit.
Follow all instructions andguidelines in this owner’smanual.
12/08/09 16:39:21 31SJC670_311
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
Before you leave the pavement, besure to do all scheduled maintenanceand service, and inspect your vehiclefor any problems. Pay specialattention to the condition of the tires,and check the tire pressures.
After you return to the pavement,carefully inspect your vehicle tomake sure there is no damage thatcould make driving it unsafe.Recheck the condition of the tiresand the tire pressures.
The route presents limits (too steepor bumpy roads). You have limits(driving skill and comfort). And yourvehicle has limits (traction, stability,and power).
Driving off-highway can behazardous if you fail to recognize limits and take theproper precautions.
To avoid loss of control or rollover,be sure to follow all precautions andrecommendations.
Be sure to store cargo properlyand do not exceed your cargo loadlimits (see page and ).
Be aware that a heavy load canreduce ground clearance and yourability to clear obstacles.
Whenever you drive, make sureyou and your passengers alwayswear seat belts.
Keep your speed low, and nevergo faster than the conditions allow.
It’s up to you to continuallyassess the situation and drivewithin the limits.
258 291
Check Out Your VehicleRememberImportant Safety Precautions
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
305
12/08/09 16:39:31 31SJC670_312
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
For better traction on all surfaces,accelerate slowly and gradually buildup speed. If you try to start too faston wet soil, mud, snow, or ice, youmight not have enough traction toget underway, and you may digyourself a hole. Starting with theshift lever in second (2) gear willhelp you have a smoother start onsnow or ice.
Keep in mind that you will usuallyneed more time and distance tobrake to a stop on unpaved surfaces.Avoid hard braking. Do not ‘‘pump’’the brakes; let the anti-lock brakingsystem pump them for you.
Your vehicle is not equipped withundercarriage guards to protect keycomponents, so take care to avoidrocks, tree stumps, and otherobstacles in your path.
Because your vehicle has a highercenter of gravity than a conventionalpassenger vehicle, driving a wheelover a tall object, or allowing a wheelto drop into a deep hole, can causeyour vehicle to tip or roll over.
If you can’t clearly see all conditionsor obstacles on a slope, walk theslope before you drive on it. If youhave any doubt whether or not youcan safely drive on the slope, don’tdo it. Find another route.
If you are driving up a hill and findthat you cannot continue,
. Your vehicle could rollover. Slowly back down the hill,following the same route you took upthe hill.
do not try toturn around
Accelerating and Braking Avoiding Obstacles Driving on Slopes
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
306
12/08/09 16:39:37 31SJC670_313
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
The banks and surface under thewater provide good traction. Thewater may hide hazards such asrocks, holes, or mud.
Before driving through water, stop,get out if necessary, and make sure that:
If you decide it is safe to drivethrough water, choose a suitablespeed, and proceed without shifting,changing speeds, stopping, orshutting off the engine.
Do not try to cross water at highspeeds, as this may cause severedamage to the cooling system orresult in loss of control.
After driving through water, testyour brakes. If they got wet, gently‘‘pump’’ them while driving slowlyuntil they operate normally.
If the water is deeper than the wheelhubs, some additional service maybe required. This service is notcovered by your warranties.
The water is not flowing too fast.Deep rushing water can sweep youdownstream. Even very shallowrushing water can wash theground from under your tires andcause you to lose traction andpossibly roll over.
The banks are sloped so you candrive out.
The water is not deep enough tocover your wheel hubs, axles, orexhaust pipe. You could stall andnot be able to restart your engine.The water can also damageimportant vehicle components.
If you get stuck, and cannot getunstuck with the VTM-4 system,engage the VTM-4 Lock (see page
), and carefully try to go in thedirection (forward or reverse) thatyou think will get you unstuck. Donot spin the tires at high speeds. Itwill not help you get out and maycause damage to the transmission orVTM-4 system.
If you are still unable to free yourself,your vehicle is equipped with frontand rear tow hooks designed for thispurpose (see page ).
274
381
CONTINUED
If You Get StuckCrossing a Stream
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
307
12/08/09 16:39:47 31SJC670_314
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
Use a nylon strap to attach yourvehicle to the recovery vehicle, andcarefully take out the slack in thestrap. Once the strap is tight, therecovery vehicle should apply force.Remember that the recovery vehicleneeds good traction to avoidbecoming stuck, too.
You should never use a jack to try toget unstuck. Your vehicle couldeasily slip off the jack and hurt youor someone else.
You may safely tow a trailer off-roadif you follow these guidelines:
Do not exceed the trailer weightor tongue limits (see page ).
Stay on smooth, level dirt roads,and avoid driving in hilly terrain.
Allow extra room for starting,stopping, and turning.
Slow down if you encounter bumpsor other obstacles.
293
Towing a Trailer Off-Road
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
308
12/08/09 16:39:54 31SJC670_315
2013 Ridgeline
Driving
This section explains why it isimportant to keep your vehicle wellmaintained and how to follow basicmaintenance safety precautions.
This section also includesinstructions on how to read theMaintenance Minder messages onthe information display or multi-information display (depending onthe model), and instructions forsimple maintenance tasks you maywant to take care of yourself.
U.S. Vehicles:
If you have the skills and tools toperform more complex maintenancetasks on your vehicle, you may wantto purchase the service manual. Seepage for information on how toobtain a copy, or see your dealer.
......................Maintenance Safety . 310.................Maintenance Minder . 311
..............................Fluid Locations . 323........................Adding Engine Oil . 324
Changing the Engine Oil and...........................................Filter . 325
..............................Engine Coolant . 327....................Windshield Washers . 328
....Automatic Transmission Fluid . 329....................................Brake Fluid . 331
....................Power Steering Fluid . 332....................................Timing Belt . 333
.............................................Lights . 333................Cleaning the Seat Belts . 341
.....................................Floor Mats . 342..................Dust and Pollen Filter . 342
.................................Wiper Blades . 343...........................................Wheels . 345
...............................................Tires . 345...................Checking the Battery . 353
.............................Vehicle Storage . 354..................................Interior Care . 355
405
Maintenance
Maintenance, replacement, orrepair of emissions controldevices and systems maybe done by any automotive repair establishment orindividual using parts that are ‘‘certif ied’’ to EPA standards.
309
TM
12/08/09 16:40:00 31SJC670_316
2013 Ridgeline
To eliminate potential hazards, readthe instructions before you begin,and make sure you have the toolsand skills required.
All service items not detailed in thissection should be performed by acertified technician or otherqualified mechanic.
Make sure your vehicle is parkedon level ground, the parking brakeis set, and the engine is off.
To clean parts, use a commerciallyavailable degreaser or partscleaner, not gasoline.
To reduce the possibility of fire orexplosion, keep cigarettes, sparks,and flames away from the batteryand all fuel-related parts.Wear eye protection andprotective clothing when workingwith the battery or compressed air.
Be sure there isadequate ventilation whenever youoperate the engine.
Some of the most important safetyprecautions are given here. However,we cannot warn you of everyconceivable hazard that can arise inperforming maintenance. Only youcan decide whether or not youshould perform a given task.
Donot run the engine unlessinstructed to do so.
Let theengine and exhaust system cooldown before touching any parts.
Maintenance Safety
Important Safety Precautions
Carbon Monoxide poison fromengine exhaust.
Potential Vehicle Hazards
Injury from moving parts.
Burns from hot parts.
310
Improperly maintaining thisvehicle, or failing to correct aproblem before driving cancause a crash in which you canbe seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the inspectionand maintenancerecommendations andschedules in this owner’smanual.
Failure to properly followmaintenance instructions andprecautions can cause you tobe seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the proceduresand precautions in this owner’smanual.
12/08/09 16:40:09 31SJC670_317
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
------------
Your vehicle displays engine oil lifeand maintenance service items onthe information display or multi-information display (depending onthe model) to show you when youshould have your dealer performengine oil replacement and indicatedmaintenance services.
Based on the engine operatingconditions and accumulated enginerevolutions, the onboard computerin your vehicle calculates theremaining engine oil life and displays it as a percentage.
The remaining engine oil life isshown on the display according tothis table:
To see the current engine oil life,turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position, and press the SELECTbutton repeatedly until the engine oillife display appears (see page ).78
CONTINUED
Calculated EngineOil Life (%)100% 91%90% 81%80% 71%70% 61%60% 51%50% 41%40% 31%30% 21%20% 16%15% 11%10% 6%5% 1%
0%
DisplayedEngine Oil Life (%)
100%90%80%70%60%50%40%30%20%15%10%5%0%
On models without navigation systemEngine Oil Life Display
Maintenance Minder
Maintenance
311
SELECT BUTTON
ENGINE OIL LIFE DISPLAY
U.S. model is shown.
TM
12/08/09 16:40:18 31SJC670_318
2013 Ridgeline
The 15 and 10 percent oil lifeindicator reminds you that the timeis coming soon to take your vehiclein for the required maintenance.
If the remaining engine oil life is 15to 6 percent, you will see the engineoil life indicator every time you turnthe ignition switch to the ON (II)position. The Maintenance Minderindicator will also come on, and themaintenance item code(s) for otherscheduled maintenance itemsneeding service will be displayednear the ‘‘OIL LIFE’’ message.
When the remaining engine oil life is5 to 1 percent, you will see a‘‘SERVICE’’ message along with thesame maintenance item code(s),every time you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position.
Maintenance Minder
312
‘‘SERVICE’’ MESSAGE
ENGINE OIL LIFE INDICATOR
U.S. model is shown.
MAINTENANCE ITEM CODE(S)MAINTENANCE MINDER INDICATOR
TM
12/08/09 16:40:24 31SJC670_319
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
The maintenance item code or codesindicate the main and sub itemsrequired at the time of the oil change(see page ).
When the remaining engine oil life is0 percent, the engine oil life indicatorwill blink. The display comes onevery time you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position. TheMaintenance Minder indicator( ) also comes on and remainson in the instrument panel. Whenyou see this message, immediatelyhave the indicated maintenance doneby your dealer.
If you do not perform the indicatedmaintenance, negative distancetraveled is displayed and begins toblink after the vehicle has beendriven 10 miles (10 km) or more.
Negative distance traveled meansyour vehicle has passed themaintenance required point.
Immediately have the indicatedmaintenance done by your dealer.
You can switch the informationdisplay from the engine oil lifedisplay to the odometer or the tripmeter. Press and release theSELECT button on the dashboard.
When the engine oil life is 15 to 1percent, the Maintenance Minderindicator ( ) comes on everytime you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, then it goes outif you switch the information display.
When you see this message, havethe indicated maintenanceperformed by your dealer as soon as possible.
314
CONTINUED
Maintenance Minder
313
U.S. model is shown.
TM
12/08/09 16:40:34 31SJC670_320
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Immediately have the serviceperformed, and make sure to resetthe display as described as follows.
When the engine oil life is 0 percentor negative distance traveled, theMaintenance Minder indicator( ) remains on even if youchange the information display.
All maintenance items displayed onthe information display are in code.For an explanation of thesemaintenance codes, see page .
Your dealer will reset the displayafter completing the requiredmaintenance service. You will see‘‘OIL LIFE 100%’’ on theinformation display the next timeyou turn the ignition switch to theON (II)position.
If maintenance service is doneby someone other than yourdealer, reset the MaintenanceMinder as follows:
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position.
To change the information displayfrom the engine oil life display to theodometer or the trip meter, pressand release the SELECT button.
Press the SELECT buttonrepeatedly until the engine oil lifeis displayed.
1.
2.322
On models without navigation system On models without navigation system
Maintenance Main Resetting the Engine
Maintenance Minder
314
MAINTENANCE MAIN ITEM
MAINTENANCE SUB ITEM(S)
TM
12/08/09 16:40:43 31SJC670_321
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Items and Sub Items Oil Life Display
CONTINUED
Press the TRIP/RESET button forabout 10 seconds. The engine oillife and the maintenance itemcode(s) will blink.
Press the TRIP/RESET button foranother 5 seconds. Themaintenance item code(s) willdisappear, and the engine oil lifewill reset to ‘‘100.’’
To see the current engine oil life,turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position, and push and releasethe SEL/RESET button on thedashboard repeatedly, until theengine oil life is displayed (see page ).
3. 4.
83
On models with navigation system
Maintenance Minder
315
U.S. model is shown.
ENGINE OIL LIFE DISPLAY
SEL/RESET BUTTON
TM
12/08/09 16:40:50 31SJC670_322
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
▲ ▼
When the remaining engine oil life is15 percent or less, the display showsa ‘‘SERVICE DUE SOON’’ messagealong with the maintenance itemcode(s) for other scheduledmaintenance items needing service.
The system message indicator onthe instrument panel will also comeon, and a beeper will sound.
To cancel the system message, pressand release the INFO ( / ) buttonon the dashboard. At this time, thesystem message indicator will alsobe turned off. Then the display willchange to the engine oil life display.
Maintenance Minder
316
MAINTENANCE ITEM CODE(S)SYSTEM MESSAGE INDICATOR
U.S. model is shown.
TM
12/08/09 16:40:56 31SJC670_323
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
▲ ▼You will also see the systemmessage every time you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position until you have the indicatedmaintenance performed by yourdealer.
The maintenance item code(s)indicate the main and sub itemsrequired at the time of the oil change(see page ).
When the remaining engine oil life isless than 5 percent, you will see theabove display. The display thenchanges to ‘‘SERVICE DUE NOW.’’Have the indicated maintenancedone as soon as possible.
The system message indicator onthe instrument panel will also comeon, and a beeper will sound.
To cancel the system message, pressand release the INFO ( / ) buttonon the dashboard. At this time, thesystem message indicator will alsobe turned off. Then the display willchange to the engine oil life display.
You will also see the systemmessage every time you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position until you have theindicated maintenanceperformed by your dealer.
319
CONTINUED
Maintenance Minder
317
TM
12/08/09 16:41:03 31SJC670_324
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
▲ ▼▲ ▼
Negative distance traveled meansyour vehicle has passed themaintenance required point.
The system message will appearagain by pressing the INFO ( / )button after canceling it.
You will also see the systemmessage every time you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position until you have theindicated maintenanceperformed by your dealer.
Immediately have the serviceperformed, and make sure to resetthe display as described on page .
If the indicated required service isnot done and the remaining engineoil life becomes 0%, the multi-information display will show a‘‘SERVICE PAST DUE’’ message,the total distance traveled after theremaining oil life became 0%, and themaintenance item code(s).
To cancel the system message, pressand release the INFO ( / ) buttonon the dashboard. At this time, thesystem message indicator will beturned off. Then the display willchange to the engine oil life display.
319
Maintenance Minder
not
318
Canada
U.S.
TM
12/08/09 16:41:09 31SJC670_325
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
▲ ▼
All maintenance items displayed onthe information display are in code.For an explanation of thesemaintenance codes, see page .
Your dealer will reset the displayafter completing the requiredmaintenance service. You will see‘‘OIL LIFE 100%’’ on the display thenext time you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position.
If maintenance service is doneby someone other than yourdealer, reset the MaintenanceMinder as follows:
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position.
Press the SEL/RESET button onthe dashboard until you see theengine oil life display.
Press and hold the SEL/RESETbutton for 10 seconds. The multi-information display will ask for aconfirmation.
If you are sure you want to resetthe display, press the SEL/RESET button to select ‘‘OK.’’
If you do not want to reset thedisplay, press the INFO ( / )button to select ‘‘Cancel.’’
1.
2.
3.
322
On models with navigation system On models with navigation system
Maintenance Main Resetting the Engine
Maintenance Minder
319
MAINTENANCEMAIN ITEM
MAINTENANCE SUB ITEM(S)
TM
12/08/09 16:41:19 31SJC670_326
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Items and Sub Items Oil Life Display
If you have the required servicedone but do not reset the display, orreset the display without doing theservice, the system will not show thecorrect maintenance intervals. Thiscan lead to serious mechanicalproblems because you will no longerhave an accurate record of whenmaintenance is needed.
We recommend the use of Hondaparts and fluids whenever you havemaintenance done. These aremanufactured to the same high-quality standards as the originalcomponents, so you can be confidentof their performance and durability.
Your authorized Honda dealerknows your vehicle best and canprovide competent, efficient service.
However, service at a dealer is notmandatory to keep your warrantiesin effect. Maintenance may bedone by any qualified servicefacility or person who is skilled in this type of automotive service.Make sure to have the servicefacility or person reset the displayas previously described.Keep all receipts as proof ofcompletion, and have the personwho does the work fill out yourHonda Service History or Canadian Maintenance Log. Check your warranty booklet formore information.
Maintenance Minder
Important Maintenance Precautions
320
TM
12/08/09 16:41:24 31SJC670_327
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
-
-
-
-
-
-
#
You should check the followingitems at the specified intervals. Ifyou are unsure of how to performany check, turn to the appropriatepage listed.
Engine oil level Check everytime you fill the fuel tank. Seepage .
Engine coolant level Check theradiator reserve tank every timeyou fill the fuel tank. See page .
Automatic transmissionCheck the fluid level monthly.See page .
Brakes Check the fluid levelmonthly. See page .
Tires Check the tire pressuremonthly. Examine the tread forwear and foreign objects. See page .
Lights Check the operation ofall the lights monthly. See page .
According to state and federalregulations, failure to performmaintenance on the items markedwith will not void your emissionswarranties. However, allmaintenance services should beperformed in accordance with theintervals indicated by the odometer/trip meter display or the multi-information display. 251
251
329
331
345
333
CONTINUED
Maintenance Minder
Owner’s Maintenance Checks
321
TM
12/08/09 16:41:32 31SJC670_328
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
*
*
#
#
- -
*
#
Maintenance Minder
322
Maintenance Main Items
Replace engine oil
Replace engine oil and oil filter
Inspect front and rear brakes
Check parking brake adjustment
Inspect these items:
Tie rod ends, steering gear box, and boots
Suspension components
Driveshaft boots
Brake hoses and lines (including ABS/VSA)
All fluid levels and condition of fluids
Exhaust system
Fuel lines and connections
Maintenance Sub Items
Rotate tires
Replace air cleaner element
Replace dust and pollen filter
Inspect drive belt
Replace transmission and transfer fluid
Replace spark plugs
Replace timing belt and inspect water pump
Inspect valve clearance
Replace engine coolant
Replace VTM-4 rear differential fluid
Symbol Symbol
A
B
1
2
3
4
5
6
TM
Inspect idle speed every 160,000 miles (256,000 km).Adjust the valves during services A, B, 1, 2, or 3 if they are noisy.
See information on maintenance and emissions warranty on page .
Independent of the Maintenance Minder information, replace the brakefluid every 3 years.
If the message ‘‘SERVICE DUE NOW’’ does not appear more than 12 monthsafter the display is reset, change the engine oil every year.
NOTE :
:
: 321
If you drive in dusty conditions, replace every 15,000miles (24,000 km).
If you drive primarily in urban areas that have highconcentrations of soot in the air from industry and fromdiesel-powered vehicles, replace every 15,000 miles(24,000 km).
If you drive regularly in very high temperatures(over 110°F, 43°C), in very low temperatures(under 20°F, 29°C), or towing a trailer, replace every60,000 miles (U.S.)/100,000 km (Canada).
Driving in mountainous terrain at very low speeds,towing a trailer or driving when fully loaded causesmore mechanical (shear) stress and fluid deterioration.This requires differential fluid changes more frequentlythan recommended by the Maintenance Minder. If youregularly drive your vehicle under these conditions,have the differential fluid changed at 7,500 miles(12,000 km), then every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
Main
tenance
Min
der
12/08/09 16:41:39 31SJC670_329
2013 Ridgeline
*
*
Fluid Locations
323
RADIATOR CAP ENGINE OIL FILL CAP
POWER STEERING FLUID(Red cap)
AUTOMATICTRANSMISSIONFLUID DIPSTICK(Yellow loop)
ENGINE COOLANTRESERVOIR
ENGINE OIL DIPSTICK(Orange loop)
WASHER FLUID(Blue cap)
BRAKE FLUID(Gray cap)
Under the gray cover:
12/08/09 16:41:43 31SJC670_330
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Unscrew and remove the engine oilfill cap on the valve cover. Pour inthe oil slowly and carefully so you donot spill any. Clean up any spillsimmediately. Spilled oil coulddamage components in the enginecompartment. Reinstall the engineoil fill cap, and tighten it securely.Wait a few minutes, and recheck theoil level on the engine oil dipstick.Do not fill above the upper mark; youcould damage the engine.
Oil is a major contributor to yourengine’s performance and longevity.Always use a premium-grade 0W-20detergent oil displaying the APICertification Seal. This seal indicatesthe oil is energy conserving, and thatit meets the American PetroleumInstitute’s latest requirements.
Honda Motor Oil is the preferred0W-20 lubricant for your vehicle. It ishighly recommended that you useHonda Motor Oil in your vehicle foroptimum engine protection. Makesure the API Certification Seal says‘‘For Gasoline Engines’’.
The oil viscosity or weight isprovided on the container’s label.0W-20 oil is formulated for year-round protection of your vehicle toimprove cold weather starting andfuel economy.
Recommended Engine Oil
Adding Engine Oil
324
API CERTIFICATION SEAL
Ambient Temperature
ENGINE OIL FILL CAP
12/08/09 16:41:51 31SJC670_331
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Open the hood, and remove theengine oil fill cap. Remove the oildrain bolt and washer from thebottom of the engine. Drain the oilinto an appropriate container.
You may use a synthetic motor oil ifit meets the same requirementsgiven for a conventional motor oil: itdisplays the API Certification Seal,and it is the proper weight. You mustfollow the oil and filter changeintervals shown on the odometer/trip meter display or on the multi-information display.
Your vehicle does not require any oiladditives. Additives may adverselyaffect the engine or transmissionperformance and durability.
Changing the oil and filter requiresspecial tools and access fromunderneath the vehicle. The vehicleshould be raised on a service station-type hydraulic lift for this service.Unless you have the knowledge andproper equipment, you should havethis maintenance done by a skilledmechanic.
Run the engine until it reachesnormal operating temperature,then shut it off.
Always change the oil and filteraccording to the maintenancemessages shown on the informationdisplay or multi-information display(depending on the model). The oiland filter collect contaminants thatcan damage your engine if they arenot removed regularly.
1.
2.
CONTINUED
Synthetic Oil Changing the Engine Oil and Filter
Engine Oil Additives
Adding Engine Oil, Changing the Engine Oil and Filter
325
WASHER DRAIN BOLT
12/08/09 16:42:00 31SJC670_332
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Remove the oil filter, and let theremaining oil drain. A specialwrench (available from yourdealer) is required.
Make sure the oil filter gasket isnot stuck to the contacting surfaceof the engine. If it is, remove itbefore installing a new oil filter.
Reinstall the engine oil fill cap.Start the engine. The oil pressureindicator should go out within 5seconds. If it does not, turn off theengine, and check your work.
Let the engine run for severalminutes, then check the drain boltand oil filter for leaks.
Turn off the engine and let it sitfor several minutes, then checkthe oil level on the dipstick. Ifnecessary, add more oil.
Refill the engine with the recom-mended oil.
Engine oil change capacity(including filter):
Put a new washer on the drain bolt,then reinstall the drain bolt.Tighten the drain bolt to:
Make sure to clean off any dirtand dust on the contacting surfaceof a new oil filter.
Install a new oil filter according tothe instructions that come with it.
9.
8.
7.
6.
4.
5.
3.
Changing the Engine Oil and Filter
326
OIL FILTER
4.5 US qt (4.3 )
29 lbf·ft (39 N·m , 4.0 kgf·m)
Improper disposal of engine oil can beharmf ul to the environment. If youchange your own oil, please dispose ofthe used oil properly. Put it in a sealedcontainer, and take it to a recyclingcenter. Do not discard it in a trash binor dump it on the ground.
12/08/09 16:42:09 31SJC670_333
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
If the reserve tank is completelyempty, you should also check thecoolant level in the radiator.
If Honda antifreeze/coolant is notavailable, you may use anothermajor-brand non-silicate coolant as atemporary replacement. Make sure it is a high-quality coolantrecommended for aluminum engines. Continued use of any non-Honda coolant can resultin corrosion, causing the cooling system to malfunction or fail. Havethe cooling system flushed and refilled with Honda antifreeze/coolant as soon as possible.
If the coolant level in the reservetank is at or below the MIN line, addcoolant to bring it up to the MAX line.Inspect the cooling system for leaks.
Always use Honda Long-life Anti-freeze/Coolant Type 2. This coolantis pre-mixed with 50 percentantifreeze and 50 percent distilledwater. Never add straight antifreezeor plain water.
CONTINUED
Adding Engine Coolant
Engine Coolant
327
RESERVE TANKMIN
MAX
Removing the radiator capwhile the engine is hot cancause the coolant to spray out,seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine andradiator cool down beforeremoving the radiator cap.
12/08/09 16:42:16 31SJC670_334
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Make sure the engine and radiatorare cool.
When the radiator and engine arecool, relieve any pressure in thecooling system by turning theradiator cap counterclockwise,without pressing down.
Remove the radiator cap bypushing down and turningcounterclockwise.
The coolant level should be up tothe base of the filler neck. Addcoolant if it is low.
Pour the coolant slowly andcarefully so you do not spill any.Clean up any spill immediately; itcould damage components in theengine compartment.
Put the radiator cap back on, andtighten it fully.
Pour coolant into the reserve tank.Fill it to halfway between the MAXand MIN marks. Put the cap backon the reserve tank.
Do not add any rust inhibitors orother additives to your vehicle’scooling system. They may not becompatible with the coolant orengine components.
Check the fluid level in thewindshield washer reservoir at leastmonthly during normal use.
Fill the reservoir with a good-qualitywindshield washer fluid. Thisincreases the cleaning capability andprevents freezing in cold weather.
The washer level indicatorwill come on when the level is low(see page ).
If the washer fluid is low, a‘‘WASHER FLUID LOW’’ messageappears on the multi-informationdisplay.
When you refill the reservoir, cleanthe edges of the windshield wiperblades with windshield washer fluidon a clean cloth. This will help tocondition them.
3.
4.
5.1.
2.
67
On models without navigation system
On models with navigation system
Windshield Washers
Engine Coolant, Windshield Washers
328
RADIATOR CAP
12/08/09 16:42:27 31SJC670_335
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
CONTINUED
Check the fluid level with the engineat normal operating temperature.
Park the vehicle on level ground.Start the engine, let it run until theradiator fan comes on, then shutoff the engine. For accurateresults, wait about 60 seconds (butno longer than 90 seconds) beforedoing step 2.
Remove the dipstick (yellow loop)from the transmission, and wipe itwith a clean cloth.
The transmission should be drainedand refilled with new fluid when thisservice is shown on the informationdisplay or multi-information display(depending on the model).
1.
2.
Windshield Washers, Automatic Transmission Fluid
Automatic Transmission Fluid
329
DIPSTICK
Do not use engine antif reeze or avinegar/water solution in thewindshield washer reservoir. Antif reezecan damage your vehicle’s paint, whilea vinegar/water solution can damagethe windshield washer pump. Use onlycommercially-available windshieldwasher f luid.
12/08/09 16:42:33 31SJC670_336
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Insert the dipstick all the way backin the transmission.
If you are not sure how to add fluid,contact your dealer.
If the level is below the lowermark, remove the fill plug, thenadd the fluid into the fill hole tobring it to the level between theupper and lower marks on the dipstick.
Pour the fluid slowly and carefullyso you do not spill any. Clean up any spill immediately; it could damage components in the engine compartment.
Insert the dipstick all the way intothe transmission securely asshown in the illustration.
Remove the dipstickand check the fluid level. Itshould be between the upperand lower marks.
Always use Honda ATF DW-1(automatic transmission fluid).
6.
5.
3.
4.
Automatic Transmission Fluid
330
DIPSTICK
UPPER MARK
LOWER MARK
Use only Honda ATF DW-1 (automatictransmission f luid). Do not mix withother transmission f luids.Using transmission f luid other thanHonda ATF DW-1 may causedeterioration in transmission operationand durability, and could result indamage to the transmission.Damage resulting f rom the use oftransmission f luid other than HondaATF DW-1 is not covered by the Hondanew vehicle warranty.
12/08/09 16:42:41 31SJC670_337
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
The fluid level should be betweenthe MIN and MAX marks on the sideof the reservoir. If the level is at orbelow the MIN mark, your brakesystem needs attention. Have thebrake system inspected for leaks orworn brake pads.
Using any non-Honda brake fluid cancause corrosion and decrease the lifeof the system. Have the brakesystem flushed and refilled withHonda Heavy Duty Brake FluidDOT 3 as soon as possible.
Brake fluid marked DOT 5 is notcompatible with your vehicle’sbraking system and can causeextensive damage.
Check the fluid level in the brakefluid reservoir monthly.
Always use Honda Heavy DutyBrake Fluid DOT 3. If it is notavailable, you should use onlyDOT 3 or DOT 4 fluid, from asealed container, as atemporary replacement.
Independent of the maintenancemessages in the information display,replace the brake fluid every 3 years.
Brake Fluid
331
MAX
MIN
12/08/09 16:42:48 31SJC670_338
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Pour the fluid slowly and carefullyso you do not spill any. Clean up any spill immediately; it could damage components in the engine compartment.
A low power steering fluid level can indicate a leak in the system.Check the fluid level frequently,and have the system inspected as soon as possible.
Always use Honda Power SteeringFluid. You may use another powersteering fluid as an emergencyreplacement, but have the powersteering system flushed and refilledwith Honda PSF as soon as possible.
If you are not sure how to add fluid,contact your dealer.
Remove the cover, then check thelevel on the side of the reservoirwhen the engine is cold.The fluid should be between theUPPER LEVEL and LOWER LEVEL.If not, add power steering fluid to theUPPER LEVEL mark, and put thecover back in place.
Power Steering Fluid
332
LOWER LEVEL
COVER UPPER LEVEL
Turning the steering wheel to f ull lef tor right lock and holding it there candamage the power steering pump.
12/08/09 16:42:54 31SJC670_339
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
- -
The headlights were properly aimedwhen your vehicle was new. If youregularly carry heavy items on thepickup bed or pull a trailer,readjustment may be required.Adjustments should be done by yourdealer or other qualified technician.
Your vehicle has halogen headlightbulbs. When replacing a bulb,handle it by its base, and protect theglass from contact with your skin orhard objects. If you touch the glass,clean it with denatured alcohol and aclean cloth.
The timing belt should be replacedat the intervals shown in theMaintenance Minder schedule.
Replace the timing belt every 60,000miles (100,000 km) if you regularlydrive your vehicle in any of thefollowing conditions:
In very high temperatures(over 110°F, 43°C).In very low temperatures(under 20°F, 29°C).Frequently towing a trailer.
CONTINUED
Headlight Aiming Replacing a Headlight BulbTiming Belt
Timing Belt, Lights
333
TM
Halogen headlight bulbs get very hotwhen lit. Oil, perspiration, or a scratchon the glass can cause the bulb tooverheat and shatter.
12/08/09 16:43:02 31SJC670_340
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Remove the electrical connectorfrom the bulb by pulling theconnector straight back.
Remove the rubber weather sealby pulling on the tab.
Unclip the end of the hold-downwire from its slot. Pivot it out ofthe way, and remove the bulb.
Install the new bulb into the hole,making sure the tabs are in theirslots. Pivot the hold-down wireback in place, and clip the end intothe slot.
Install the rubber weather sealover the back of the headlightassembly. Make sure it is rightside up.
Push the electrical connector ontothe new bulb. Make sure it isconnected securely. Turn on theheadlights to test the new bulb.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Lights
334
WEATHER SEAL
CONNECTOR HOLD-DOWN WIRE
BULB
12/08/09 16:43:09 31SJC670_341
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Remove the socket from theheadlight assembly by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.
Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket. Push the new bulb straightinto the socket until it bottoms.
Turn on the lights to make surethe new bulb is working.
Put the inner fender cover in place.Install and lock each holding clipby pushing on the center.
Insert the socket back into theheadlight assembly. Turn itclockwise to lock it in place.To change the passenger’s side
bulb, start the engine, turn thesteering wheel all the way to theleft, and turn off the engine. Tochange the driver’s side bulb, turnthe steering wheel to the right.
Use a flat-tip screwdriver toremove the two holding clips fromthe inner fender, and pull the innerfender cover back.
5.
6.
1.
2.
3.
4.
7.
Replacing a Front Turn Signal/Hazard/Parking Light Bulb
Lights
335
HOLDING CLIPS
BULB SOCKET
12/08/09 16:43:18 31SJC670_342
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Your vehicle uses halogen lightbulbs. When replacing a bulb, handleit by its plastic case, and protect theglass from contact with your skin orhard objects. If you touch the glass,clean it with denatured alcohol and aclean cloth.
Push down the inner fender.
Remove the electrical connectorfrom the bulb by pushing
Remove the bulb from the foglight assembly by turning it one-quarter turn counterclockwise.
Remove the bolts and use the flat-tip screwdriver to remove theholding clip located under thefront bumper.
2.
3.
4.
1.
Replacing Front Fog/DaytimeRunning Light Bulbs
Lights
336
BOLTS INNER FENDER
TABHOLDING CLIP
CONNECTOR
Halogen bulbs get very hot when lit. Oil,perspiration, or a scratch on the glasscan cause the bulb to overheat andshatter.
12/08/09 16:43:26 31SJC670_343
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
on the tab and pulling theconnector down.
Remove the socket by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.
Remove the burned-out bulb bypulling it straight out of the socket.
Drop open the tailgate.
Remove the two bolts, and removethe rear light assembly from therear pillar.
Determine which of the threebulbs is burned out: brake/taillight, turn signal/hazard light,or back-up light.
Install the new bulb into the holeand turn it one-quarter turnclockwise to lock it in place.
Push the electrical connector backonto the bulb. Make sure it is onall the way.
Turn on the lights to test thenew bulb.
Reinstall the inner fender. Makesure it is installed under the edgeof the front bumper.
Reinstall the holding clip, and pushin its head, then install the boltsand tighten them securely.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
CONTINUED
Replacing Rear Bulbs
Lights
337
BULB
SOCKET
12/08/09 16:43:37 31SJC670_344
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Remove the three mountingscrews from the light assembly.
Remove the lens from thelight assembly.
Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket. Push the new bulb straightinto the socket until it bottoms.
Place a cloth on the edge of thelens segment to prevent scratches.Remove each lens segment bycarefully prying on its edge with asmall flat-tip screwdriver.
Remove the screw under each lens.
Pull the high-mount brake lightassembly out of the vehicle.
Install the new bulb into the socket.
Push the socket into the lightassembly, and turn it clockwiseuntil it locks.
Turn on the lights to make surethe new bulb is working.
Install the rear light assembly inthe rear pillar. Tighten the twobolts securely.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Replacing a High-mount BrakeLight Bulb
Lights
338
LENS SEGMENT
SCREW
SCREW
BULB
12/08/09 16:43:48 31SJC670_345
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket. Push the new bulb straightinto the socket until it bottoms.
Push the socket into the lightassembly, and turn it clockwiseuntil it locks.
Remove the license plate lightassembly by pulling ittowards you, and then pulling thefront edge upward.
Remove the socket from the lightassembly by turning it one-quarterturn counterclockwise.
Put the lens back on the lightassembly, and tighten themounting bolts securely.
Turn on the lights to make surethe new bulb is working.
Put the light assembly back intothe vehicle. Install the screws andtighten them securely.Reinstall the lens segments.
1.
2.
3.
4.
8.
7.
9.
CONTINUED
Replacing a RearLicense Plate Bulb
Lights
339
BULB
SOCKET
12/08/09 16:43:56 31SJC670_346
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket. Push the new bulb straightinto the socket until it bottoms.
Push the socket into the lightassembly, and turn it clockwiseuntil it locks.
Remove the mounting screw fromthe bed light assembly.
Pull out the light assembly.
Remove the socket from the lightassembly by turning it one-quarterturn counterclockwise.
Turn on the lights to make surethe new bulb is working.
Reinstall the light assembly in
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
5.
6.
Replacing a Bed Light Bulb
Lights
340
SCREW
SCREW
BULB
SOCKET
12/08/09 16:44:04 31SJC670_347
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
the bumper.
If your seat belts get dirty, use a softbrush with a mixture of mild soapand warm water to clean them. Donot use bleach, dye, or cleaningsolvents. Let the belts air-dry beforeyou use the vehicle.
Dirt build-up in the loops of the seatbelt anchors can cause the belts toretract slowly. Wipe the insides ofthe loops with a clean clothdampened in mild soap and warmwater or isopropyl alcohol.
Reinstall the light assembly.
Turn on the lights to make surethe new bulb is working.
Reinstall the mounting screw, andtighten it securely.
6.
7.
8.
Cleaning the Seat Belts
Lights, Cleaning the Seat Belts
341
LOOP
12/08/09 16:44:11 31SJC670_348
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
The floor mats that camewith your vehicle hook over thefloor mat anchors. This keeps the floor mats from sliding forward, possibly interfering with the pedals, or backwards,making the front passenger’s weight sensors ineffective.
If you remove a floor mat, make sureto re-anchor it when you put it backin your vehicle.
A non-Honda floor mat may not fityour vehicle properly. This couldprevent the proper operation of thefolding rear seats and the passenger’sseat weight sensors. We recommendusing genuine Honda floor mats. Donot put additional floor mats on topof the anchored mats.
This filter removes the dust andpollen that is broughtin from the outside through theheating and cooling system/climate control system.
Have your dealer replace the filterwhen this service is indicated by amaintenance message on theinformation display or multi-information display (depending onthe models). It should be replacedevery 15,000 miles (24,000 km) ifyou drive primarily in urban areas that have high concentrations ofsoot in the air, or if the flowfrom the heating and cooling system/climate control system becomes less than usual.
Floor Mats Dust and Pollen Filter
Floor Mats, Dust and Pollen Filter
342
12/08/09 16:44:17 31SJC670_349
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Raise the wiper arm offthe windshield.
To replace a wiper blade:
To raise the wiper arm, turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position and activate the wipers(see page ). When the wipersare in the upright position, turnthe ignition switch off to stop thewipers in that position.
Check the condition of the wiperblades at least every six months.Replace them if you find signs ofcracking in the rubber, areas that aregetting hard, or if they leave streaksand unwiped areas when used.
1.
2.
94
CONTINUED
Wiper Blades
343
WIPER ARMS
Do not open the hood when the wiperarms are raised, or you will damage thehood and the wiper arms.
12/08/09 16:44:24 31SJC670_350
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Remove the blade from its holderby grabbing the tabbed end of theblade. Pull up firmly until the tabscome out of the holder.
Examine the new wiper blades. Ifthey have no plastic or metalreinforcement along the backedge, remove the metalreinforcement strips from the oldwiper blade, and install them inthe slots along the edge of thenew blade.
Disconnect the blade assemblyfrom the wiper arm:
Press and hold the lock tab.Slide the blade assembly towardthe lock tab until it releasesfrom the wiper arm.
3. 4. 5.
Wiper Blades
344
LOCK TAB
BLADE BLADE
REINFORCEMENT
12/08/09 16:44:31 31SJC670_351
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Slide the new wiper blade into theholder until the tabs lock.
Slide the wiper blade assemblyonto the wiper arm. Make sure itlocks in place.
Lower the wiper arm against the window.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position, and turn the wiperswitch off to return the wiper armsto the parked position.
Clean the wheels as you would therest of the exterior. Wash them with the same solution, and rinsethem thoroughly.
Aluminum alloy wheels have aprotective clear-coat that keepsthe aluminum from corroding andtarnishing. Cleaning the wheelswith harsh chemicals (includingsome commercial wheel cleaners)or a stiff brush can damage theclear-coat. To clean the wheels,use a mild detergent and a softbrush or sponge.
To safely operate your vehicle, yourtires must be the proper type andsize, in good condition with adequatetread, and correctly inflated.
The following pages give moredetailed information on how to takecare of your tires and what to dowhen they need to be replaced.
6.
7.
8.
9.
If equipped
Wheels Tires
Wiper Blades, Wheels, Tires
345
Using tires that are excessivelyworn or improperly inflated cancause a crash in which you canbe seriously hurt or killed.
Follow all instructions in thisowner’s manual regarding tireinflation and maintenance.
12/08/09 16:44:40 31SJC670_352
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Keeping the tires properly inflatedprovides the best combination ofhandling, tread life, and ridingcomfort.
Underinflated tires wear unevenly,adversely affect handling and fueleconomy, and are more likely tofail from being overheated.
Overinflated tires can make yourvehicle ride more harshly, aremore prone to damage from roadhazards, and wear unevenly.
Even though your vehicle isequipped with TPMS, werecommend that you visually checkyour tires every day. If you think atire might be low, check itimmediately with a tire gauge.
Use a gauge to measure the airpressure in each tire at least once amonth. Even tires that are in goodcondition may lose 1 to 2 psi (10 to20 kPa, 0.1 to 0.2 kgf/cm ) permonth. Remember to check thespare tire at the same time.
Check the air pressures when thetires are cold. This means thevehicle has been parked for at least 3hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6km). Add or release air, if needed, tomatch the recommended cold tirepressures on page .
If you check air pressures when thetires are hot (driven for severalmiles/kilometers), you will seereadings 4 to 6 psi (30 to 40 kPa, 0.3 to 0.4 kgf/cm ) higher than thecold readings. This is normal.Do not let air out to match therecommended cold air pressure.The tire will be underinflated.
You should get your own tirepressure gauge and use it wheneveryou check your tire pressures. Thiswill make it easier for you to tell if apressure loss is due to a tireproblem and not due to avariation between gauges.
While tubeless tires have someability to self-seal if they arepunctured, you should lookclosely for punctures if a tirestarts losing pressure.
The tire pressure monitoring system(TPMS) warns you when a tirepressure is low. See page or
for more information.276
279
347
Inflation Guidelines
Tires
346
12/08/09 16:44:49 31SJC670_353
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Never use a puncture-repairing agentin a flat tire. If used, you will have toreplace the tire pressure sensor.Have the flat tire repaired by yourdealer as soon as possible.
The following chart shows therecommended cold tire pressures for most normal and high-speed driving conditions.
Your tires have wear indicatorsmolded into the tread. When thetread wears down, you will see a 1/2inch (12.7 mm) wide band across thetread. This shows there is less than1/16 inch (1.6 mm) of tread left onthe tire.
A tire this worn gives very littletraction on wet roads. You shouldreplace the tire if you can see threeor more tread wear indicators.
The compact spare tire pressure is:
Excessive tread wear.
Cuts, splits, or cracks in the sideof the tire. Replace the tire if youcan see fabric or cord.
Bumps or bulges in the tread orside of the tire. Replace the tire ifyou find either of these conditions.
Every time you check inflation, youshould also examine the tires fordamage, foreign objects, and wear.
You should look for:
For additional information aboutyour tires, see page .
For convenience, the recommendedtire sizes and cold tire pressures areon a label on the driver’s doorjamb.
390
Tire Size Cold Tire Pressure
Tire Size Cold Tire Pressure
Front/Rear:
Front/Rear:
RTL, Touring, and Sport models
RT, RTS, DX, and VP models
Recommended Tire Pressures
Tire Inspection
Tires
347
INDICATOR LOCATION MARKS
TREAD WEAR INDICATORS
60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )
P245/65R17 105T 32 psi (220 kPa ,2.2 kgf/cm )
P245/60R18 104T 32 psi (220 kPa ,2.2 kgf/cm )
12/08/09 16:45:08 31SJC670_354
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
In addition to proper inflation,correct wheel alignment helps todecrease tire wear. If you find a tireis worn unevenly, have your dealercheck the wheel alignment.
Have your dealer check the tires ifyou feel a consistent vibration whiledriving. A tire should always berebalanced if it is removed from thewheel. When you have new tiresinstalled, make sure they arebalanced. This increases ridingcomfort and tire life. For bestresults, have the installer perform adynamic balance.
The service life of your tires isdependent on many factors,including, but not limited to, drivinghabits, road conditions, vehicleloading, inflation pressure,maintenance history, speed, andenvironmental conditions (evenwhen the tires are not in use).
In addition to your regularinspections and inflation pressuremaintenance, it is recommended thatyou have annual inspectionsperformed once the tires reach fiveyears old. It is also recommendedthat all tires, including the spare, beremoved from service after 10 yearsfrom the date of manufacture,regardless of their condition or stateof wear.The last four digits of the TIN (tireidentification number) are found onthe sidewall of the tire and indicatethe date of manufacture (See
on page ).
To help increase tire life anddistribute wear more evenly, rotatethe tires according to themaintenance messages displayed onthe information display or multi-information display (depending onmodels). Move the tires to thepositions shown in the diagram eachtime they are rotated. If youpurchase directional tires, rotateonly front-to-back.
390
Tire RotationTire MaintenanceTire Service Life
TireLabeling
Tires
348
Front
(For Non-directionalTires and Wheels)
(For DirectionalTires and Wheels)
Front
On vehicles with aluminum wheels,improper wheel weights can damageyour vehicle’s aluminum wheels. Useonly Honda wheel weights f orbalancing.
12/08/09 16:45:17 31SJC670_355
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
It is best to replace all four tires atthe same time. If that is not possibleor necessary, replace the two fronttires or two rear tires as a pair.Replacing just one tire can seriouslyaffect your vehicle’s handling.
If you ever replace a wheel, makesure that the wheel’s specificationsmatch those of the original wheels.
Replace your tires with radial tires ofthe same size, load range, speedrating, and maximum cold tirepressure rating (as shown on thetire’s sidewall).
Mixing radial and bias-ply tires onyour vehicle can reduce brakingability, traction, and steeringaccuracy. Using tires of a differentsize or construction can cause theABS and vehicle stability assistsystem (VSA) to work inconsistently.
Replacement wheels are available atyour dealer.
The ABS and VSA system work bycomparing the speed of thewheels. When replacing tires, usethe same size originallysupplied with the vehicle. Tire sizeand construction can affectwheel speed and may cause theABS or VSA system to activate.
Also be sure you use only TPMSspecific wheels. If you do not, thetire pressure monitoring system willnot work.
Replacing Tires and Wheels
Tires
349
Installing improper tires on yourvehicle can affect handling andstability. This can cause a crashin which you can be seriouslyhurt or killed.
Always use the size and type oftires recommended in thisowner’s manual.
12/08/09 16:45:24 31SJC670_356
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
+Wheels: If you mount snow tires on yourvehicle, make sure they are radialtires of the same size and load rangeas the original tires. Mount snowtires on all four wheels. The tractionprovided by snow tires on dry roadsmay be lower than your original tires.Check with the tire dealer formaximum speed recommendations.
Tires marked ‘‘M S’’ or ‘‘AllSeason’’ on the sidewall have an all-weather tread design suitable formost winter driving conditions.
For the best performance in snowyor icy conditions, you should installsnow tires or tire chains. They maybe required by local laws undercertain conditions.
Tires:
See page for DOT tire qualitygrading information, and page
for tire size information.
388
390
RTL, Touring, and Sport models
RTL, Touring, and Sport models
RT, RTS, DX, and VP models
RT, RTS, DX, and VP models
Wheel and Tire Specifications Snow TiresWinter Driving
Tires
350
17 x 7 1/2J
18 x 7 1/2J
P245/65R17 105T
P245/60R18 104T
12/08/09 16:45:33 31SJC670_357
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
#
*#
#
*Mount tire chains on your tires whenrequired by driving conditions orlocal laws. Install them only on thefront tires.
Because your vehiclehas limited tire clearance, Hondastrongly recommends using thechains listed below.
When installing chains, follow themanufacturer’s instructions andmount them as tightly as you can.Drive slowly with chains installed.If you hear them contacting thebody or chassis, stop and investigate. Make sure thechains are installed tightly, and that they are not contacting thebrake lines or suspension. Removethe chains as soon as you startdriving on cleared roads.
This tire chain is available at manyauto supply stores. To find a localstore that carries the chain, callQuality Chain Corp at 1-800-843-8824.To order the tire chain online, go to
, and enter yourvehicle information. When you installthe chains, follow the manufacturer’sinstructions, and mount them astightly as you can. Drive slowly withthe chains installed.
Rubber chain adjusters, or tensioners,must be used to prevent the chains fromcontacting the body or the chassis.
:SCC Super Z-6 SZ-429
Premium Cobra Cable Chain1046P with accessory adjusters
www.chainquest.com
On RTL, Touring, and Sport models
On RT, RTS, DX, and VP models
On RT, RTS, DX, and VP models
CONTINUED
Premium Cobra Cable Chain1046P with accessory
adjusters
Tire Chains
Tires
351
12/08/09 16:45:40 31SJC670_358
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
If you ever hear the chainscontacting the body or chassis, stopand investigate. If the chains haveloosened, retighten them. Make surethey do not contact the brake linesor suspension.
Remove the chains as soon as youbegin driving on cleared roads.
Tires
352
Using the wrong chains, or notproperly installing chains, candamage the brake lines andcause a crash in which you canbe seriously injured or killed.
Follow all instructions in thisowner’s manual regarding theselection and use of tire chains.
Traction devices that are the wrongsize or improperly installed candamage your vehicle’s brake lines,suspension, body, and wheels. Stopdriving if they are hitting any part ofthe vehicle.
12/08/09 16:45:45 31SJC670_359
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
-
If you need to connect the battery toa charger, disconnect both cables toprevent damaging your vehicle’selectrical system. Always disconnectthe negative ( ) cable first, andreconnect it last.
Check the terminals for corrosion (awhite or yellowish powder). Toremove it, cover the terminals with asolution of baking soda and water. Itwill bubble up and turn brown. Whenthis stops, wash it off with plainwater. Dry off the battery with acloth or paper towel. Coat theterminals with grease to help preventfuture corrosion.
If additional battery maintenance isneeded, see your dealer or aqualified technician.
Battery posts,terminals, and related accessoriescontain lead and lead compounds.
Check the condition of the batterymonthly by looking at the testindicator window. The label on thebattery explains the testindicator’s colors.
CONTINUED
WARNING:
Wash your hands after handling.
Checking the Battery
353
TEST INDICATOR WINDOW
The battery gives off explosivehydrogen gas during normaloperation.
A spark or flame can cause thebattery to explode with enoughforce to kill or seriously hurt you.
Wear protective clothing and aface shield, or have a skilledtechnician do the batterymaintenance.
12/08/09 16:45:51 31SJC670_360
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Block the rear wheels.
If the vehicle is to be stored for alonger period, it should besupported on jackstands so thetires are off the ground.
Leave one window open slightly (ifthe vehicle is being storedindoors).
Disconnect the battery.
Support the front wiper bladearms with a folded towel or rag sothey do not touch the windshield.
To minimize sticking, apply asilicone spray lubricant to all door,In-Bed Trunk lid, and tailgate seals.Also, apply a vehicle body wax tothe painted surfaces that matewith the door, In-Bed Trunk lidand tailgate seals.
If your vehicle’s battery isdisconnected, or goes dead, the timesetting may be lost. To reset the time,see page .
If your vehicle’s battery isdisconnected or goes dead, the audiosystem may disable itself. The nexttime you turn on the radio you willsee ‘‘CODE’’ in the frequency display.Use the preset bars to enter the code(see page ).
The navigation system will alsodisable itself. The next time you turnon the ignition switch, the systemwill require you to enter a PINbefore it can be used. Refer to thenavigation system manual.
If you need to park your vehicle foran extended period (more than 1month), there are several things youshould do to prepare it for storage.Proper preparation helps preventdeterioration and makes it easier toget your vehicle back on the road. Ifpossible, store your vehicle indoors.
Leave the parking brake off. Putthe transmission in Park.
Clean the interior. Make sure thecarpeting, floor mats, etc., arecompletely dry.
Wash and dry the exteriorcompletely.
Fill the fuel tank.
207
205
On models without navigation system
On models with navigation system
Vehicle Storage
Checking the Battery, Vehicle Storage
354
12/08/09 16:46:02 31SJC670_361
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
Cover the vehicle with a‘‘breathable’’ cover, one madefrom a porous material such ascotton. Non-porous materials, suchas plastic sheeting, trap moisture,which can damage the paint.
If possible, periodically run theengine until it reaches fulloperating temperature (thecooling fans cycle on and offtwice). Preferably, do this oncea month.
Vacuum dirt and dust from theleather frequently. Pay closeattention to the pleats and seams.Clean the leather with a soft clothdampened with a 90% water and 10%neutral soap solution. Then buff itwith a clean, dry cloth. Remove anydust or dirt on leather surfacesimmediately.
Leather
Vehicle Storage, Interior Care
355
12/08/09 16:46:06 31SJC670_362
2013 Ridgeline
Maintenance
356
12/08/09 16:46:09 31SJC670_363
2013 Ridgeline
This section covers the morecommon problems that motoristsexperience with their vehicles. Itgives you information about how tosafely evaluate the problem and whatto do to correct it. If the problem hasstranded you on the side of the road,you may be able to get going again.If not, you will also find instructionson getting your vehicle towed.
......................Compact Spare Tire . 358....................Changing a Flat Tire . 359
.............If the Engine Won’t Start . 367................................Jump Starting . 368
..............If the Engine Overheats . 370.........Low Oil Pressure Indicator . 372..........Charging System Indicator . 372
.......Malfunction Indicator Lamp . 373...............Brake System Indicator . 374
..............................................Fuses . 376..............................Fuse Locations . 379
......................Emergency Towing . 381..........If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck . 381
Taking Care of the Unexpected
357
12/08/09 16:46:12 31SJC670_364
2013 Ridgeline
Use the compact spare tire as atemporary replacement only. Getyour regular tire repaired or replaced,and put it back on your vehicle assoon as you can.
Check the air pressure of thecompact spare tire every time youcheck the other tires. It should beinflated to:
Follow these precautions:Replace the tire when you can seethe tread wear indicator bars. Thereplacement tire should be the samesize and design, mounted on thesame wheel. The spare tire is notdesigned to be mounted on a regularwheel, and the spare wheel is notdesigned for mounting a regular tire.
Never exceed 50 mph (80 km/h).
This tire gives a harsher ride andless traction on some roadsurfaces. Use greater cautionwhile driving.
Do not mount snow chains on acompact spare.
Do not use your compact sparetire on another vehicle unless it isthe same make and model.
The low tire pressure indicatorcomes on and stays on after youreplace the flat tire with the compactspare tire. After several miles(kilometers) driving with thecompact spare tire, the TPMSindicator comes on and the low tirepressure indicator goes off.
After the flat tire is replaced with thespare tire, the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator stays on. Afterseveral miles (kilometers) drivingwith the spare, this indicator beginsto flash, then stays on again. You willalso see a ‘‘CHECK TPMSSYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).282
On models without navigation system
On models with navigation system
Compact Spare Tire
358
INDICATOR LOCATION MARK
TREAD WEAR INDICATOR BAR
60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )
12/08/09 16:46:20 31SJC670_365
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
Turn on the hazard warning lights,and turn the ignition switch to theLOCK (0) position. Have allpassengers get out of the vehiclewhile you change the tire.
Park the vehicle on firm, level, andnon-slippery ground. Put thetransmission in Park. Apply theparking brake.
If you are towing a trailer,unhitch it.
If you have a flat tire while driving,stop in a safe place to change it.Drive slowly along the shoulder untilyou get to an exit or an area to stopthat is far away from the traffic lanes.
If you tow a trailer frequently, werecommend that you use a regulartire as a spare. You can store theregular size spare tire on the tire tray,but store the tool kit at the side ofthe In-Bed Trunk (see page ),and secure it.
2.1.
365CONTINUED
Changing a Flat Tire
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
359
TOOL BOX
SPARE TIRE
The vehicle can easily roll offthe jack, seriously injuringanyone underneath.
Follow the directions forchanging a tire exactly, andnever get under the vehiclewhen it is supported only by thejack.
12/08/09 16:46:27 31SJC670_366
2013 Ridgeline
Open the In-Bed Trunk.
Remove the two tire tray
Pull out the tire tray with thehandle, and hook the rear of thetire tray to the guides on the backedge of the In-Bed Trunk.
Unfasten the strap to removethe tool box, and unscrew thewing bolt.
Take out the compact spare tire.If you are using a cargo net or acargo cover in the In-Bed Trunk,remove it before pulling out thetire tray.
4.
3. 5. 6.
7.
Changing a Flat Tire
360
WING BOLT
TOOL BOX STRAPTIRETRAYTIRE TRAY HOLDING BOLTS
12/08/09 16:46:36 31SJC670_367
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
holding bolts.
CONTINUED
Loosen each wheel nut 1/2 turnwith the wheel nut wrench.
Place the jack under the jackingpoint nearest the tire you need to change.
Turn the dial at the bottom of thejack clockwise until the top of thejack contacts the jacking point.Make sure the jacking point tab isresting in the jack notch.
8. 9. 10.
Changing a Flat Tire
361
JACKING POINT DIAL
12/08/09 16:46:42 31SJC670_368
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
Attach the stay to the extension,then attach the wheel nut wrenchto the end of the extension.
Turn the jack dial (wheel nutwrench) clockwise as shown toraise the vehicle until the flat tireis off the ground.
Make sure the stay, the extension,and the wheel nut wrench aresecurely attached.
Insert the hook at the end of thestay into the opening on the dial atthe bottom of the jack.
11. 12. 13.
Changing a Flat Tire
362
EXTENSION
DIAL
CONNECTOR BUTTON
HOOK
STAY
WHEEL NUT WRENCH
CONNECTOR BUTTON
12/08/09 16:46:48 31SJC670_369
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
CONTINUED
Put on the spare tire. Put thewheel nuts back on finger-tight,then tighten them in a crisscrosspattern with the wheel nut wrenchuntil the wheel is firmly againstthe hub. Do not try to tighten thewheel nuts fully.
Lower the vehicle to the ground,and remove the jack.
Before mounting the spare tire,wipe any dirt off the mountingsurface of the wheel and hub with a clean cloth. Wipe the hub carefully; it may be hot from driving.
The wheel cap cannot beremoved without first removing the wheel nuts.
Remove the wheel nuts and thewheel cap (on RT and DX models)then remove the flat tire. Handlethe wheel nuts carefully; they maybe hot from driving. Place the flattire on the ground with the outsidesurface facing up.
14. 15.
16.
17.
On RT and DX models
Changing a Flat Tire
363
BRAKE HUB
WHEEL CAP
RT/DX model is shown.
12/08/09 16:46:56 31SJC670_370
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
Tighten the wheel nuts securely inthe same crisscross pattern. Havethe wheel nut torque checked atthe nearest automotive servicefacility.Tighten the wheel nuts to:
Place the flat tire face up on thetire tray.
Remove the spacer cone from thewing bolt, turn it over, and put itback on the bolt.
Secure the flat tire by screwingthe wing bolt back into its hole.
Release the tire tray and slide itback in place.
Tighten the tire tray holding boltssecurely.
Remove the center cap from theflat tire.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
On all models except RT and DX
Changing a Flat Tire
364
WING BOLT
SPACER CONEFor normaltire
For sparetire
94 lbf·ft (127 N·m , 13 kgf·m)
12/08/09 16:47:03 31SJC670_371
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
Store the wheel cap or center capin the In-Bed Trunk. Makesure it does not getscratched or damaged.
When storing the flat tire, placethe tool box at the right side of theIn-Bed Trunk as shown.
Store the jack and the tools in thetool box.
Refer to(see page or ).
25.
26.
27.
28.278 283
Changing a Flat Tire
Changing a Tire withTPMS
365
TOOL BOX
Loose items can be thrown outof the vehicle in a crash andcould seriously injure theoccupants.
Store the wheel, jack, and toolssecurely before driving.
12/08/09 16:47:10 31SJC670_372
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
As a temporary mounting location,you can secure a spare tire on thepickup bed, if needed.
Place the spare tire on the pickupbed as shown.
Place the spacer cone in the wheelhub, and secure the spare tire tothe pickup bed with the wing bolt.
If you remove the spare tire from thepickup bed, reinstall the clip backinto its hole.
Remove the clip by pushing thecenter of its top.
Remove the spare tire from thetire tray (see page ).
Store or secure the tool box.1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
360
Changing a Flat Tire
Securing a Spare Tire on the Pickup Bed
366
SPACER CONE
WING BOLT
12/08/09 16:47:18 31SJC670_373
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
Diagnosing why the engine won’tstart falls into two areas, dependingon what you hear when you turn theignition switch to the START (III)position:
Check the transmission interlock. The transmission mustbe in Park or neutral or thestarter will not operate.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position. Turn on theheadlights, and check theirbrightness. If the headlights arevery dim or do not come on at all,the battery is discharged. See
on page .
If the headlights dim noticeably orgo out when you try to start theengine, either the battery isdischarged or the connections arecorroded. Check the condition ofthe battery and terminal connec-tions (see page ). You canthen try jump starting the vehiclefrom a booster battery (seepage ).
In this case, the starter motor’sspeed sounds normal, or even fasterthan normal, when you turn theignition switch to the START (III)position, but the engine does not run.
Are you using a properly codedkey? An improperly coded key willcause the immobilizer systemindicator in the instrument panelto blink rapidly (see page ).
Turn the ignition switch to theSTART (III) position. If theheadlights do not dim, check thecondition of the fuses. If the fusesare OK, there is probablysomething wrong with theelectrical circuit for the ignitionswitch or starter motor. You willneed a qualified technician todetermine the problem. See
on page .
Check these things:
When you turn the ignition switch tothe START (III) position, you do nothear the normal noise of the enginetrying to start. You may hear aclicking sound, a series of clicks, ornothing at all.
You can hear the starter motoroperating normally, or the startermotor sounds like it is spinningfaster than normal, but the enginedoes not start up and run.
You hear nothing, or almostnothing. The engine’s startermotor does not operate at all, oroperates very slowly.
101
368
381
353
368
CONTINUED
Jump StartingThe Starter Operates Normally
Emergency Towing
Nothing Happens or the StarterMotor Operates Very Slowly
If the Engine Won’t Start
367
12/08/09 16:47:27 31SJC670_374
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
Are you using the proper startingprocedure? Refer to
on page .
There may be an electricalproblem, such as no power to thefuel pump. Check all the fuses(see page ).
If you find nothing wrong, you willneed a qualified technician to findthe problem. See
on page .
Although this seems like a simpleprocedure, you should takeseveral precautions.
You cannot start your vehicle bypushing or pulling it.
Do you have fuel? Check the fuelgauge; the low fuel indicator maynot be working.
Turn off all electrical accessories:heater, A/C, climate control, audiosystem, lights, etc. Put thetransmission in Park, and set theparking brake.
Open the hood, and check thephysical condition of the battery.In very cold weather, check thecondition of the electrolyte. If itseems slushy or frozen, do not tryjump starting until it thaws.
1.
2.
268
376
381
Starting theEngine
EmergencyTowing
Jump Starting
If the Engine Won’t Start, Jump Starting
To Jump Start Your Vehicle:
368
A battery can explode if you donot follow the correct procedure,seriously injuring anyonenearby.
Keep all sparks, open flames,and smoking materials awayfrom the battery.
If a battery sits in extreme cold, theelectrolyte inside can f reeze.Attempting to jump start with a f rozenbattery can cause it to rupture.
12/08/09 16:47:36 31SJC670_375
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
-
+
+
If the booster battery is in anothervehicle, have an assistant startthat vehicle and run it at a fast idle.
Start the vehicle. If the startermotor still operates slowly, checkthat the jumper cables have goodmetal-to-metal contact.
Keep the ends of the jumper cablesaway from each other and any metalon the vehicle until everything isdisconnected. Otherwise, you maycause an electrical short.
Connect the second jumper cableto the negative ( ) terminal onthe booster battery. Connect theother end to the grounding strapas shown. Do not connect thisjumper cable to any other part ofthe engine.
Connect one jumper cable to thepositive ( ) terminal on yourvehicle’s battery. Connect theother end to the positive ( )terminal on the booster battery.
The numbers in the illustration show you the order to connect thejumper cables.
Once your vehicle is running,disconnect the negative cable fromyour vehicle, then from thebooster battery. Disconnect thepositive cable from your vehicle,then from the booster battery.
4.
6.
7.
5.
3.
Jump Starting
369
BOOSTER BATTERY
12/08/09 16:47:45 31SJC670_376
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
If you see steam and/or spraycoming from under the hood, turnoff the engine. Wait until you seeno more signs of steam or spray,then open the hood.
If you do not see steam or spray,leave the engine running andwatch the temperature gauge. Ifthe high heat is due to overloading,the engine should start to cooldown almost immediately. If itdoes, wait until the temperaturegauge comes down to the midpoint,then continue driving.
Safely pull to the side of the road.Put the transmission in Park, andset the parking brake. Turn off allthe accessories, and turn on thehazard warning lights.
The pointer of your vehicle’stemperature gauge should stay inthe midrange under most conditions.If it climbs to the red mark, youshould determine the reason (hotday, driving up a steep hill, etc.).
If the vehicle overheats, you shouldtake immediate action. The onlyindication may be the temperaturegauge climbing to or above the redmark. Or you may see steam orspray coming from under the hood.
1.
2.
3.
If the Engine Overheats
370
Steam and spray from anoverheated engine canseriously scald you.
Do not open the hood if steamis coming out.
Driving with the temperature gaugepointer at the red mark can causeserious damage to the engine.
12/08/09 16:47:51 31SJC670_377
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
If the temperature gauge stays atthe red mark, turn off the engine.
Look for any obvious coolant leaks,such as a split radiator hose.Everything is still extremely hot,so use caution. If you find a leak, itmust be repaired before youcontinue driving (see
on page ).
Put the radiator cap back ontightly. Run the engine, and checkthe temperature gauge. If it goesback to the red mark, the engineneeds repair (see
on page ).
If the temperature stays normal,check the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank. If it hasgone down, add coolant to theMAX mark. Put the cap backon tightly.
If you do not find an obvious leak,check the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank. Add coolantif the level is below the MIN mark.
If there was no coolant in thereserve tank, you may need to addcoolant to the radiator. Let theengine cool down until the pointerreaches the middle of the tempera-ture gauge, or lower, before check-ing the radiator.
Using gloves or a large heavycloth, turn the radiator capcounterclockwise, withoutpushing down, to the first stop.After the pressure releases,push down on the cap, and turn ituntil it comes off.
Start the engine, and set thetemperature to maximum heat(climate control to AUTO at ‘‘’’). Add coolant to the radiatorup to the base of the filler neck.If you do not have the propercoolant mixture available,you can add plain water.Remember to have the coolingsystem drained and refilled withthe proper mixtureas soon as you can.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
381
381
EmergencyTowing
EmergencyTowing
If the Engine Overheats
371
Removing the radiator capwhile the engine is hot cancause the coolant to spray out,seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine andradiator cool down beforeremoving the radiator cap.
12/08/09 16:47:59 31SJC670_378
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
Safely pull off the road, and shutoff the engine. Turn on the hazardwarning indicators.
Let the vehicle sit for a minute.Open the hood, and check the oillevel (see page ). An enginevery low on oil can lose pressureduring cornering and other drivingmaneuvers.
If necessary, add oil to bring thelevel back to the full mark on thedipstick (see page ).
Start the engine, and watch the oilpressure indicator. If it does not goout within 10 seconds, turn off theengine. There is a mechanicalproblem that needs to be repairedbefore you can continue driving(see on
).
This indicator should never come onwhen the engine is running. If itstarts flashing or stays on, the oilpressure has dropped very low orlost pressure. Serious enginedamage is possible, and you shouldtake immediate action.
If the charging system indicatorcomes on brightly when theengine is running, the batteryis not being charged.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKCHARGING SYSTEM’’ message onthe multi-information display (seepage ).
Immediately turn off all electricalaccessories. Try not to use otherelectrically operated controls such asthe power windows. Keep the enginerunning; starting the engine willdischarge the battery rapidly.
Go to a service station or garagewhere you can get technicalassistance.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKENGINE OIL LEVEL’’ message onthe multi-information display whenthis indicator comes on.The indicator notifies you of low oilpressure and does not measure theoil level. Check your vehicle’s oillevel at each refueling.
1.
2.
3.
4.
90
251
324
On models with navigation system
On models with navigation system
Emergency Towing
Low Oil PressureIndicator
Charging SystemIndicator
Low Oil Pressure Indicator, Charging System Indicator
372
Running the engine with low oilpressure can cause serious mechanicaldamage almost immediately. Turn of fthe engine as soon as you can saf ely getthe vehicle stopped.
12/08/09 16:48:10 31SJC670_379
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
page 381
If this indicator comes onwhile driving, it means one
of the engine’s emissions controlsystems may have a problem. Eventhough you may feel no difference inyour vehicle’s performance, it canreduce your fuel economy and causeincreased emissions. Continuedoperation may cause serious damage.
If you have recently refueled yourvehicle, the indicator coming oncould be due to a loose or missingfuel fill cap. Tighten the cap until itclicks at least once. Tightening thecap will not turn the indicator offimmediately; it can take several daysof normal driving.
If the indicator comes on repeatedly, even though it mayturn off as you continue driving,have your vehicle checked by thedealer as soon as possible.
The indicator may also come on withthe ‘‘D’’ indicator.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKFUEL CAP’’ message on theinformation display.
You will also see a ‘‘TIGHTEN FUELCAP’’ message on the multi-information display.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKEMISSION SYSTEM’’ message onthe multi-information display (seepage ).90
On models without navigation system
On models with navigation system
On models with navigation system
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
373
If you keep driving with themalf unction indicator lamp on, you candamage your vehicle’s emissionscontrols and engine. Those repairs maynot be covered by your vehicle’swarranties.
12/08/09 16:48:17 31SJC670_380
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
Your vehicle has certain ‘‘readinesscodes’’ that are part of the on-boarddiagnostics for the emissionssystems. In some states, part of theemissions testing is to make surethese codes are set. If they are notset, the test cannot be completed.
If the battery in your vehicle hasbeen disconnected or gone dead,these codes may be erased. It cantake several days of driving under various conditions to setthe codes again.
To check if they are set, turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position, without starting the engine.The malfunction indicator lamp willcome on for 20 seconds. If it thengoes off, the readiness codes are set.If it blinks five times, the readinesscodes are not set. If possible, do nottake your vehicle for an emissionstest until the readiness codes are set.Refer to formore information (see page ).
If the brake system indicator comeson while driving, the brake fluid levelis probably low. Press lightly on thebrake pedal to see if it feels normal.If it does, check the brake fluid levelthe next time you stop at a servicestation (see page ).
The brake system indicator normallycomes on when you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position, and asa reminder to check the parkingbrake. It will stay on if you do notfully release the parking brake.
398
331
Readiness Codes
Emissions Testing
Brake SystemIndicator
Malfunction Indicator Lamp, Brake System Indicator
374
U.S. Canada
12/08/09 16:48:23 31SJC670_381
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
However, if the brake pedal does not feel normal, you should takeimmediate action. A problem in onepart of the system’s dual circuitdesign will still give you braking attwo wheels. You will feel the brakepedal go down much farther beforethe vehicle begins to slow down,and you will have to press harderon the pedal.
You will also see a ‘‘BRAKE FLUIDLOW’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
If the fluid level is low, take yourvehicle to a dealer, and have thebrake system inspected for leaks orworn brake pads.
Slow down by shifting to a lowergear, and pull to the side of the roadwhen it is safe. Because of the longdistance needed to stop, it ishazardous to drive the vehicle. Youshould have it towed, and repaired assoon as possible (see
on page ).
If you must drive the vehicle a shortdistance in this condition, driveslowly and carefully.
If the ABS indicator and the VSAsystem indicator come on with the brake system indicator, haveyour vehicle inspected by yourdealer immediately.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK BRAKESYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
90
90
381
On models with navigation system
On models with navigation system
EmergencyTowing
Brake System Indicator
375
12/08/09 16:48:30 31SJC670_382
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
The vehicle’s fuses are contained inthree fuse boxes.
The primary under-hood fuse box ison the passenger’s side. Thesecondary fuse box is next to thebrake fluid reservoir. To open them,push the tabs as shown.
The interior fuse box is on thedriver’s lower left side. To removethe fuse box lid, put your finger inthe notch on the lid, and pull itoutward slightly, then pull it towardyou and take it out of its hinges.
If something electrical in yourvehicle stops working, check for ablown fuse first. Determine from thechart on pages and , or thediagram on the fuse box lid, whichfuse or fuses control that device.Check those fuses first, but check allthe fuses before deciding that ablown fuse is the cause. Replace anyblown fuses, and check if the deviceworks.
379 380
Checking and Replacing Fuses
Fuses
376
UNDER-HOOD (SECONDARY)UNDER-HOOD (PRIMARY)INTERIOR
NOTCH
12/08/09 16:48:37 31SJC670_383
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
Check the smaller fuses in theunder-hood fuse boxes and all thefuses in the interior fuse box bypulling out each one with the fusepuller provided in the primaryunder-hood fuse box.
Turn the ignition switch to theLOCK (0) position. Make sure theheadlights and all otheraccessories are off.
Check each of the large fuses inthe primary under-hood fuse boxby looking through the sidewindow at the wire inside.Removing these fuses requires aPhillips-head screwdriver.Remove the cover from
the fusebox.
4.3.1.
2.
CONTINUED
Fuses
377
BLOWN
FUSE PULLER
BLOWNFUSE
12/08/09 16:48:45 31SJC670_384
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
If the driver’s power window fuse isremoved, the AUTO function of thedriver’s window may be disabled. To reset the AUTO function, seepage .
Look for a blown wire inside thefuse. If it is blown, replace the fusewith one of the spare fuses of thesame rating or lower.
If the replacement fuse of thesame rating blows in a short time,there is probably a seriouselectrical problem in your vehicle.Leave the blown fuse in thatcircuit and have your vehiclechecked by a qualified technician.
If you cannot drive the vehiclewithout fixing the problem, and youdo not have a spare fuse, take a fuseof the same rating or a lower ratingfrom one of the other circuits. Makesure you can do without that circuittemporarily (such as the accessorypower socket or radio).
If you replace the blown fuse with aspare fuse that has a lower rating, itmight blow out again. This does notindicate that anything is wrong.Replace the fuse with one of thecorrect rating as soon as you can.
5.
6.
128
Fuses
378
BLOWN
Replacing a f use with one that has ahigher rating greatly increases thechances of damaging the electricalsystem. If you do not have areplacement f use with the properrating f or the circuit, install one witha lower rating.
12/08/09 16:48:51 31SJC670_385
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
-
-
-
+
*
* If equipped
If equipped
123456789
101112
123456
Back LightVSA FSRVSA MTRVTM-4Front Accessory SocketsElectric Brake
13141516171819202122
23
789
1011
10 A
10 A15 A10 A10 A
7.5 A15 A15 A20 A15 A
7.5 A
(7.5 A)20 A40 A20 A15 A
(20 A)
(20 A)(7.5 A)(20 A)7.5 A(20 A)
20 A20 A40 A15 A40 A20 A30 A30 A40 A40 A
120 A60 A50 A
Horn, StopDefrosterBack Up, ACCHazardOption 1AC InverterCooling FanCondenser FanHeater MotorSeatBattery
B IGI MainPower WindowSpare Fuses
Small LightsStop/Turn LightsChargeTPMSMoonroof
Left Headlight Low BeamNot UsedLeft Headlight High BeamSmall LightsRight Headlight High BeamRight Headlight Low BeamBack UpFI ECU (PCM)DBWFront Fog LightsHeated SeatsMG Clutch
:
:
No.
No. Circuits Protected
No.
No.
Amps.
Amps. Amps.
Amps. Circuits Protected
Circuits Protected
Circuits Protected
24 28
Fuse Locations
379
PRIMARY UNDER-HOOD FUSE BOX
SECONDARY UNDER-HOOD FUSE BOX
12/08/09 16:49:02 31SJC670_386
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
-
-
-
*
*
*
*
No.
No.
No. Amps.Amps.
Amps.
Circuits ProtectedCircuits Protected
Circuits Protected
12345678910
If equipped
1112131415161718192021222324252627282930313233
1 7.5 A7.5 A15 A10 A15 A20 A10 A7.5 A20 A10 A7.5 A
30 A
(10 A)(20 A)
(20 A)
15 A15 A
7.5 A7.5 A10 A
7.5 A20 A20 A20 A20 A20 A
7.5 A10 A
7.5 A7.5 A
(7.5 A)
STSBed LightsIG CoilDaytime Running LightLAFRadioInterior LightsBack UpDoor LockRear Accessory SocketIG OPDS
IG WiperNot UsedDriver’s Power Seat LumbarDriver’s Power Seat SlidingNot UsedDriver’s Power Seat RecliningNot UsedIG ACGIG Fuel PumpIG WasherIG MeterIG SRSIGPLeft Rear WindowRight Rear WindowPassenger’s WindowBack WindowDriver’s WindowVBSOL2IG HACIG VSA/ABSACCNot Used
:
Fuse Locations
380
INTERIOR FUSE BOX UPPER AREAINTERIOR FUSE BOX
Driver’s Side
12/08/09 16:49:11 31SJC670_387
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
CONTINUED
If your vehicle needs to be towed,call a professional towing service ororganization. Never tow yourvehicle with just a rope or chain. Itis very dangerous.
The operator will loadyour vehicle on the back of a truck.Any other method of towing willdamage the drive system. When youcontact the towing agency, informthem a flat-bed is required.
If your vehicle gets stuck in sand,mud, or snow, call a towing service to pull it out (see theprevious column).
For very short distances, such asfreeing the vehicle, you can use thetie down hooks on the lower of thefront and rear bumpers.
Emergency Towing, If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck
The only way you can safely towyour vehicle is with flat-bedequipment.
If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck
381
FRONT
REAR
TIE DOWNHOOK
TIE DOWNHOOK
‘‘Rocking’’ your vehicle betweenf orward and reverse gear or revving upthe engine and allowing the wheels tospin f reely at high speeds can damagethe automatic transmission. Use a towservice to prevent transmission damage.
Towing your vehicle with two tires onthe ground will damage parts of the4WD system. It should be transportedon a f lat-bed truck or trailer.
12/08/09 16:49:20 31SJC670_388
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck
382
To avoid damage to your vehicle, usethe tie down hooks f or straight, f latground towing only. Do not tow at anangle. These hooks should not be usedf or open-road towing.
12/08/09 16:49:23 31SJC670_389
2013 Ridgeline
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
-
The diagrams in this section giveyou the dimensions and capacities ofyour vehicle and the locations of theidentification numbers. It alsoincludes information you shouldknow about your vehicle’s tires andemissions control systems.
................Identification Numbers . 384................................Specifications . 386
DOT Tire Quality Grading......................(U.S. Vehicles) . 388
Uniform Tire Quality..................................Grading . 388.................................Treadwear . 388
......................................Traction . 388.............................Temperature . 389
.................................Tire Labeling . 390Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) Required Federal............................Explanation . 392
.......................Emissions Controls . 395.....................The Clean Air Act . 395
Crankcase Emissions Control....................................System . 395
Evaporative Emissions Control....................................System . 395
Onboard Refueling Vapor................................Recovery . 395
...Exhaust Emissions Controls . 396....................PGM-FI System . 396
Ignition Timing Control................................System . 396
Exhaust Gas Recirculation...................(EGR) System . 396
Three Way Catalytic...........................Converter . 396
....................Replacement Parts . 396..Three Way Catalytic Converter . 397
........................Emissions Testing . 398
Technical Information
383
12/08/09 16:49:27 31SJC670_390
2013 Ridgeline
Your vehicle has several identifyingnumbers in various places.
The vehicle identification number(VIN) is the 17-digit number yourdealer uses to register your vehiclefor warranty purposes. It is alsonecessary for licensing and insuringyour vehicle. The easiest place tofind the VIN is on a plate fastened tothe top of the dashboard. You cansee it by looking through thewindshield on the driver’s side. It isalso on the certification labelattached to the driver’s doorjamb,and is stamped on the enginecompartment bulkhead. The VIN isalso provided in bar code on thecertification label.
Identif ication Numbers
384
CERTIFICATION LABEL
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (VIN)
12/08/09 16:49:31 31SJC670_391
2013 Ridgeline
TechnicalInform
ation
The engine number is stamped intothe engine block. It is on the front.
The transmission number is on alabel on top of the transmission.
Identif ication Numbers
TechnicalInform
ation
385
ENGINE NUMBER
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION NUMBER
12/08/09 16:49:34 31SJC670_392
2013 Ridgeline
- -
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Specifications
386
Air ConditioningDimensions
Capacities
Weights
Seating Capacities
206.9 in (5,255 mm)77.8 in (1,976 mm)70.3 in (1,786 mm)
Refrigerant typeCharge quantityLubricant type
HFC-134a (R-134a)19.4 21.2 oz (550 600 g)
ND-OIL8
1,470 lbs (670 kg)1,520 lbs (690 kg)
10,088 lbs (4,575 kg)
LengthWidthHeight
WheelbaseTrack
66.9 in (1,700 mm)67.1 in (1,705 mm)122.0 in (3,100 mm)
The GCWR must be reduced 2 percent for every 1,000 feet (305meters) of elevation.
Fuel tank
EnginecoolantEngine oil
AutomatictransmissionfluidReardifferentialfluid
22.01 US gal (83.3 )1.64 US gal (6.2 )2.14 US gal (8.1 )
4.2 US qt (4.0 )
4.5 US qt (4.3 )
5.3 US qt (5.0 )3.3 US qt (3.1 )8.5 US qt (8.0 )
2.79 US qt (2.64 )3.01 US qt (2.85 )
Including the coolant in the reserve tank and that remaining in theengineReserve tank capacity:0.180 US gal (0.68 )Excluding the oil remaining in the engine
71.2 in (1,808 mm)
Gross vehicle weight rating
Gross combined weightrating (GCWR)Maximum load limit(Payload)
See the tire information labelattached to the driver’s doorjamb.
325Total
FrontRear
Approx.FrontRear
1 :
2 :
1 :
2 :
3 :
ChangeTotalChange
IncludingfilterWithoutfilter
TotalChangeTotal
ChangeTotal
1 :
2 :On vehicles without moonroofOn vehicles with moonroof
RT, RTS, DX, VP, Canadian Sport models, and Touring modelwithout moonroofRTL, U.S. Sport models, and Touring model with moonroof
1
2
3
1
2
1
2
12/08/09 16:49:52 31SJC670_393
2013 Ridgeline
TechnicalInform
ation
--
--
--------------
--
**
*
*
Specifications
387
Fuses
Engine
Alignment
Lights
Battery
Tires
Capacities
Interior
Under-hood
Type
Bore x StrokeDisplacementCompression ratioSpark plugs
Toe-in
Camber
Caster
3.50 x 3.66 in (89.0 x 93.0 mm)211.8 cu-in (3,471 cm )
10.0 : 1ILZKR7B11SXU22HCR11
0.00 in (0.0 mm)0.00 in (0.0 mm)
0°50’0°50’
1°53’
P245/65R17 105T
Water cooled 4-stroke SOHC VTEC,V6 gasoline engine
0.45 US qt (0.43 )0.48 US qt (0.45 )
4.8 US qt (4.5 )
HeadlightsFront turn signal/parking/hazard lightsDaytime running lightFog lightRear turn signal/hazard lightsBrake/TaillightsBack-up lightsLicense plate lightsHigh-mount brake lightsIndividual map lights
Bed lightsConsole compartment lightGlove box lightVanity mirror lightDoor courtesy lights
12 V 60/55 W (HB2)12 V 28/8 W
12 V 21 W12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V
21/5 W18 W3 CP3 CP8 W5 W3 CP1.4 W3.4 W2 W3.8 W
Capacity
Size
Pressure60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm )
T165/90R17 105M
12 V 55 W12 V 60 W
P245/60R18 104T
TransferassemblyfluidWindshieldwasherreservoir
12 V12 V
60 AH/5 HR72 AH/20 HR
See page 380 or the fuse labelattached to the inside of the fusebox lid under the dashboard.See page 379 or the fuse box lid.
FrontRearFrontRearFront
FrontRear
NGK:DENSO:
High/Low
ChangeTotal
Front/Rear
SpareFront/RearSpare
1 :2 :
(HB3)(H11)
RTL, Touring, and Sport modelsRT, RTS, DX, and VP models
1
2
12/08/09 16:50:19 31SJC670_394
2013 Ridgeline
TechnicalInform
ation
The tires on your vehicle meet allU.S. Federal Safety Requirements.All tires are also graded fortreadwear, traction, and temperatureperformance according toDepartment of Transportation(DOT) standards. The followingexplains these gradings.
The treadwear grade is a compara-tive rating based on the wear rate ofthe tire when tested under controlledconditions on a specified governmenttest course. For example, a tiregraded 150 would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on thegovernment course as a tire graded100. The relative performance oftires depends upon the actual condi-tions of their use, however, and maydepart significantly from the normdue to variations in driving habits,service practices and differences inroad characteristics and climate.
The traction grades, from highest tolowest, are AA, A, B, and C. Thosegrades represent the tire’s ability tostop on wet pavement as measuredunder controlled conditions onspecified government test surfacesof asphalt and concrete. A tiremarked C may have poor tractionperformance.
Warning: The traction gradeassigned to this tire is based onstraight-ahead braking traction tests,and does not include acceleration,cornering, hydroplaning, or peaktraction characteristics.
Quality grades can be found whereapplicable on the tire sidewallbetween tread shoulder andmaximum section width. Forexample:
All passenger car tires must conformto Federal Safety Requirements inaddition to these grades.
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Treadwear Traction
Treadwear 200Traction AATemperature A
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
388
12/08/09 16:50:27 31SJC670_395
2013 Ridgeline
TechnicalInform
ation
Warning: The temperature grade forthis tire is established for a tire thatis properly inflated and notoverloaded. Excessive speed,underinflation, or excessive loading,either separately or in combination,can cause heat buildup and possibletire failure.
The temperature grades are A (thehighest), B, and C, representing thetire’s resistance to the generation ofheat and its ability to dissipate heatwhen tested under controlledconditions on a specified indoorlaboratory test wheel. Sustained hightemperature can cause the materialof the tire to degenerate and reducetire life, and excessive temperaturecan lead to sudden tire failure. Thegrade C corresponds to a level ofperformance which all passenger cartires must meet under the FederalMotor Vehicle Safety Standard No.109. Grades B and A representhigher levels of performance on thelaboratory test wheel than theminimum required by law.
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
Temperature
389
12/08/09 16:50:31 31SJC670_396
2013 Ridgeline
TechnicalInform
ation
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
The tires that came on your vehiclehave a number of markings. Thoseyou should be aware of aredescribed below.
Rim diameter in inches.
Load index (a numerical codeassociated with the maximumload the tire can carry).
Speed symbol (analphabetical code indicatingthe maximum speed rating).
Whenever tires are replaced, theyshould be replaced with tires of thesame size. The following is anexample of tire size with anexplanation of whateach component means.
Vehicle type (P indicatespassenger vehicle).
Tire width in millimeters.
Aspect ratio (the tire’s sectionheight as a percentage of itswidth).
Tire construction code (Rindicates radial).
R
65
245
P
17
105
T
Tire Labeling
Tire Size
390
TIRE LABELING EXAMPLE
(1)(2)(3)(4)
(4) (3) (2)
(1)
(1)
Tire Identification Number (TIN)Tire Size
Maximum Tire PressureMaximum Tire Load
P245/65R17 105T
12/08/09 16:50:42 31SJC670_397
2013 Ridgeline
TechnicalInform
ation
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
The tire identification number(TIN) is a group of numbers and letters that look like the following example. TIN is located on thesidewall of the tire.
WeekYearDate of manufacture.
Tire type code.
Manufacturer’sidentification mark.
This indicates that thetire meets allrequirements of the U.S.Department ofTransportation.
Cold Tire Pressure The tire airpressure when the vehicle has beenparked for at least three hours ordriven less than 1 mile (1.6 km).
Load Rating Means the maximumload that a tire is rated to carry for agiven inflation pressure.
Maximum Inflation Pressure Themaximum tire air pressure that thetire can hold.
Maximum Load Rating Means theload rating for a tire at the maximumpermissible inflation pressure forthat tire.
Recommended Inflation PressureThe cold tire inflation pressurerecommended by the manufacturer.
Treadwear Indicators (TWI)Means the projections within theprincipal grooves designed to give avisual indication of the degrees ofwear of the tread.
DOT
B97R
FW6X
2202
Tire Identif ication Number (TIN)
Tire Labeling
Glossary of Tire Terminology
391
DOT B97R FW6X 2202
12/08/09 16:50:53 31SJC670_398
2013 Ridgeline
TechnicalInform
ation
-
Accordingly, when the low tirepressure telltale illuminates, youshould stop and check your tires assoon as possible, and inflate them tothe proper pressure.
Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire tooverheat and can lead to tire failure.Under-inflation also reduces fuelefficiency and tire tread life, and mayaffect the vehicle’s handling andstopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not asubstitute for proper tiremaintenance, and it is the driver’sresponsibility to maintain correct tirepressure, even if under-inflation hasnot reached the level to triggerillumination of the TPMS low tirepressure telltale.
(If your vehicle has tires of adifferent size than the size indicatedon the vehicle placard or tireinflation pressure label, you shoulddetermine the proper tire inflationpressure for those tires.)
Each tire, including the spare (ifprovided), should be checkedmonthly when cold and inflated tothe inflation pressure recommendedby the vehicle manufacturer on thevehicle placard or tire inflationpressure label.
As an added safetyfeature, your vehiclehas been equipped with a tire pressuremonitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one or moreof your tires is significantlyunder-inflated.
All Models
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Required Federal Explanation
392
12/08/09 16:51:00 31SJC670_399
2013 Ridgeline
TechnicalInform
ation
-
Always check the TPMS malfunctiontelltale after replacing one or moretires or wheels on your vehicle toensure that the replacement oralternate tires and wheels allow
TPMS malfunctions may occur for avariety of reasons, including theinstallation of replacement oralternate tires or wheels on thevehicle that prevent the TPMS fromfunctioning properly.
When the malfunctionindicator is illuminated,the sytem may not beable to detect or signal low tirepressure as intented.
Your vehicle has also been equippedwith a TPMS malfunction indicatorto indicate when the system is notoperating properly. The TPMSmalfunction indicator is provided bya separate telltale, which displays thesymbol ‘‘TPMS’’ when illuminated.
On models without navigation system
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Required Federal Explanation
393
12/08/09 16:51:05 31SJC670_400
2013 Ridgeline
TechnicalInform
ation
function properly.the TPMS to continue to
-
TPMS malfunctions may occur for avariety of reasons, including theinstallation of replacement oralternate tires or wheels on thevehicle that prevent the TPMS fromfunctioning properly.
Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale afterreplacing one or more tires orwheels on your vehicle to ensurethat the replacement or alternatetires and wheels allow theTPMS to continue to function properly.
When the malfunction indicator isilluminated, the system may not beable to detect or signal low tirepressure as intended.
Your vehicle has also been equippedwith a TPMS malfunction indicatorto indicate when the system is notoperating properly. The TPMSmalfunction indicator is combinedwith the low tire pressure telltale.When the system detects amalfunction, the telltale will flash forapproximately one minute and thenremain continuously illuminated.This sequence will continue uponsubsequent vehicle start-ups as longas the malfunction exists.
On models with navigation system
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Required Federal Explanation
394
12/08/09 16:51:09 31SJC670_401
2013 Ridgeline
TechnicalInform
ation
*The burning of gasoline in yourvehicle’s engine produces several by-products. Some of these are carbonmonoxide (CO), oxides of nitrogen(NOx), and hydrocarbons (HC).Gasoline evaporating from the tankalso produces hydrocarbons. Con-trolling the production of NOx, CO,and HC is important to the environ-ment. Under certain conditions ofsunlight and climate, NOx and HCreact to form photochemical ‘‘smog.’’Carbon monoxide does not contri-bute to smog creation, but it is apoisonous gas.
The United States Clean Air Actsets standards for automobileemissions. It also requires thatautomobile manufacturers explain to owners how theiremissions controls work and whatto do to maintain them. This section summarizes how theemissions controls work. Scheduled maintenance is on page .
Your vehicle has a positivecrankcase ventilation system. Thiskeeps gasses that build up in theengine’s crankcase from going intothe atmosphere. The positivecrankcase ventilation valve routesthem from the crankcase back to the
intake manifold. They are thendrawn into the engine and burned.
As gasoline evaporates in the fueltank, an evaporative emissionscontrol canister filled with charcoaladsorbs the vapor. It is stored in thiscanister while the engine is off. Afterthe engine is started and warmed up,the vapor is drawn into the engineand burned during driving.
The onboard refueling vaporrecovery (ORVR) system capturesthe fuel vapors during refueling. Thevapors are adsorbed in a canisterfilled with activated carbon. Whiledriving, the fuel vapors are drawninto the engine and burned off.
322
The Clean Air Act
Crankcase EmissionsControl
Evaporative EmissionsControl System
Onboard RefuelingVapor Recovery
Emissions Controls
395
12/08/09 16:51:17 31SJC670_402
2013 Ridgeline
TechnicalInform
ation
* In Canada, Honda vehicles comply withthe Canadian emission requirements, asspecified in an agreement withEnvironment Canada, at the time theyare manufactured.
System
The exhaust emissions controlsinclude four systems: PGM-FI,ignition timing control, exhaust gasrecirculation, and three waycatalytic converter. These foursystems work together to control the engine’s combustion and minimize the amount of HC, CO,and NOx that come out the tailpipe.The exhaust emissions control systems are separate from thecrankcase and evaporativeemissions control systems.
The PGM-FI system uses sequential multiport fuel injection. It has three subsystems: air intake,engine control, and fuel control.The powertrain control module(PCM) uses various sensors to determine how much air is going into the engine. It then controls how much fuel to inject underall operating conditions.
This system constantly adjusts theignition timing, reducing the amountof HC, CO, and NOx produced.
The exhaust gas recirculation (EGR) system takes some of theexhaust gas and routes it backinto the intake manifold. Adding exhaust gas to the air/fuel mixturereduces the amount of NOxproduced when the fuel is burned.
The three way catalytic converter isin the exhaust system. Throughchemical reactions, it converts HC,CO, and NOx in the engine’s exhaustto carbon dioxide (CO ), nitrogen(N ), and water vapor.
The emissions control systems arecovered by warranties separatefrom the rest of your vehicle.Read your warranty manual formore information.
The emissions control systems aredesigned and certified to work to-gether in reducing emissions tolevels that comply with the Clean AirAct. To make sure the emissionsremain low, you should use only newHonda replacement parts or theirequivalent for repairs. Using lowerquality parts may increase theemissions from your vehicle.
2
2
Exhaust Emissions Controls Replacement Parts
PGM-FI System
Ignition Timing Control System
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)System
Three Way Catalytic Converter
Emissions Controls
396
12/08/09 16:51:26 31SJC670_403
2013 Ridgeline
TechnicalInform
ation
The three way catalytic convertermust operate at a high temperaturefor the chemical reactions to takeplace. It can set on fire anycombustible materials that comenear it. Park your vehicle awayfrom high grass, dry leaves, orother flammables.
The defective three way catalyticconverters contribute to air pollution,and can impair your engine’sperformance. Follow theseguidelines to protect your vehicle’sthree way catalytic converters.
Always use unleaded gasoline.Even a small amount of leadedgasoline can contaminate thecatalyst metals, making the threeway catalytic converter ineffective.
Keep the engine well maintained.
Have your vehicle diagnosed andrepaired if it is misfiring, back-firing, stalling, or otherwise notrunning properly.
The three way catalytic convertercontains precious metals that serveas catalysts, promoting chemicalreactions to convert the exhaustgasses without affecting the metals.The catalytic converter is referred toas a three-way catalyst, since it actson HC, CO, and NOx. A replacementunit must be an original Honda partor its equivalent.
Three Way Catalytic Converter
397
THREE WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTERWARM UP THREE WAY CATALYTICCONVERTERS
12/08/09 16:51:34 31SJC670_404
2013 Ridgeline
TechnicalInform
ation
If you take your vehicle for anemissions test shortly after thebattery has been disconnected orgone dead, it may not pass the test.This is because of certain ‘‘readinesscodes’’ that must be set in the on-board diagnostics for the emissionssystems. These codes are erasedwhen the battery is disconnected,and set again only after several days of driving under a variety of conditions.
If the testing facility determines thatthe readiness codes are not set, youwill be requested to return at a laterdate to complete the test. If you mustget the vehicle retested within thenext two or three days, you cancondition the vehicle for retesting bydoing the following.
Make sure the gas tankis nearly, but not completely,full (around 3/4).
Without touching the acceleratorpedal, start the engine, and let itidle for 20 seconds.
Make sure the vehicle has beenparked with the engine off for 6hours or more.
Make sure the ambienttemperature is between 40° and95°F (4° and 35°C).
Keep the vehicle in Park. Increasethe engine speed to 2,000 rpm, andhold it there until the temperaturegauge rises to at least 1/4 of thescale (about 3 minutes).
Without touching the acceleratorpedal, let the engine idle for 20 seconds.
Select a nearby lightly traveledmajor highway where you canmaintain a speed of 50 to 60 mph(80 to 97 km/h) for at least 20minutes. Drive on the highway inD. Do not use the cruise control.When traffic allows, drive for 90seconds without moving theaccelerator pedal. (Vehicle speedmay vary slightly; this is okay.) Ifyou cannot do this for acontinuous 90 seconds because of traffic conditions, drive for at least 30 seconds, then repeat it two more times (for a total of 90 seconds).
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.Testing of Readiness Codes
Emissions Testing
398
12/08/09 16:51:42 31SJC670_405
2013 Ridgeline
TechnicalInform
ation
Then drive in city/suburbantraffic for at least 10 minutes.When traffic conditions allow, letthe vehicle coast for severalseconds without using theaccelerator pedal or the brakepedal.
Make sure the vehicle has beenparked with the engine off for 30minutes.
If the testing facility determines thereadiness codes are still not set, seeyour dealer.
8.
9.
Emissions Testing
399
12/08/09 16:51:46 31SJC670_406
2013 Ridgeline
TechnicalInform
ation
Audio System
HandsFreeLink
Immobilizer SystemRemote TransmitterTire Pressure MonitoringSystem (TPMS)
Each of the above complies with theappropriate requirements or therequired standards of FCC (FederalCommunications Commission) andIndustry Canada Standard, describedas follows:
The following products and systemson your vehicle emit radio waveswhen in operation.
HomeLink UniversalTransceiver
Bluetooth
As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.
Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-Gen/210/310.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation of the device.
Devices that Emit Radio Waves
400
12/08/09 16:51:54 31SJC670_407
2013 Ridgeline
TechnicalInform
ation
....Customer Service Information . 402....................Warranty Coverages . 403
Reporting Safety Defects..........................(U.S. Vehicles) . 404
.....................Authorized Manuals . 405
Warranty and Customer Relations
401
12/08/09 16:51:57 31SJC670_408
2013 Ridgeline
Honda dealership personnel aretrained professionals. They shouldbe able to answer all your questions.If you encounter a problem that yourdealership does not solve to yoursatisfaction, please discuss it withthe dealership’s management. Theservice manager or general managercan help. Almost all problems aresolved in this way.
If you are dissatisfied with thedecision made by the dealership’smanagement, contact HondaCustomer Service.
U.S. Owners:
Canadian Owners: When you call or write, please giveus this information:
Vehicle identification number (seepage )
Name and address of the dealerwho services your vehicle
Date of purchase
Odometer reading on your vehicle
Your name, address, andtelephone number
A detailed description of the problem
Name of the dealer who sold thevehicle to you
In Puerto Rico and the U.S. Virgin Islands:
384
Customer Service Information
402
American Honda Motor Co., Inc.Automobile Customer ServiceMail Stop 500-2N-7A1919 Torrance BoulevardTorrance, California 90501-2746
Tel: (800) 999-1009
Honda Canada Inc.Customer Relations180 Honda BoulevardMarkham, ONL6C 0H9
Tel: 1-888-9-HONDA-9Fax: 1-877-939-0909E-Mail: [email protected]
Vortex Motor Corp.Bella InternationalP.O. Box 190816San Juan, PR 00919-0816
Tel: (787) 620-7546
Customer Relations
12/08/09 16:52:05 31SJC670_409
2013 Ridgeline
Warranty
andC
ustomer
Relations
-
--
-
-
-
-
-
providescoverage for as long as the
Your new vehicle is covered by these warranties:
provides proratedcoverage for a replacement batterypurchased from your dealer.
a seatbelt that fails to function properly iscovered by a limited warranty.Please read your warranty bookletfor details.
covers all Hondareplacement parts against defects inmaterials and workmanship.
Honda accessories are coveredunder this warranty. Time andmileage limits depend on the typeof accessory and other factors.Please read your warranty bookletfor details.
all exterior body panels arecovered for rust-through from theinside for the specified time periodwith no mileage limit.
covers your new vehicle, except forthe emissions control systems andaccessories, against defects inmaterials and workmanship.
these
emissions control systems.Time, mileage, and coverageare conditional. Pleaseread your warranty booklet forexact information.
Please refer to the 2013 warrantymanual that came with your vehicle.
Restrictions and exclusions apply toall these warranties. Please read the2013 Honda warranty informationbooklet that came with your vehiclefor precise information on warrantycoverages. Your vehicle’s originaltires are covered by theirmanufacturer. Tire warrantyinformation is in a separate booklet.
Warranty Coverages
U.S. Owners
Canadian Owners
Replacement Muffler LifetimeLimited Warranty
Replacement Battery LimitedWarranty
Seat Belt Limited Warranty
Replacement Parts LimitedWarranty
Accessory Limited Warranty
Rust Perforation Limited Warranty
New Vehicle Limited Warranty
Emissions Control Systems DefectsWarranty and EmissionsPerformance Warranty
Warranty
andC
ustomer
Relations
403
12/08/09 16:52:14 31SJC670_410
2013 Ridgeline
two warranties cover your vehicle’s
purchaser of the muffler ownsthe vehicle.
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect whichcould cause a crash or could cause injury or death, youshould immediately inform the National HighwayTraffic Safety Administration (NHTSA), in addition tonotifying American Honda Motor Co., Inc.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open aninvestigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists ina group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedycampaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involvedin individual problems between you, your dealer, orAmerican Honda Motor Co., Inc.
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which couldcause a crash or could cause injury or death, you shouldimmediately inform Honda Canada Inc. and you may alsoinform Transport Canada.
To contact Transport Canada’s Defect Investigations andRecalls Division, you may call 1-800-333-0510. For moreinformation on reporting safety defects or about motorvehicle safety, go to .
If Transport Canada receives similar complaints, it mayopen an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defectexists in a group of vehicles, it may lead to a recall andremedy campaign. However, Transport Canada cannotbecome involved in individual problems between you,your dealer, or Honda Canada Inc.
Reporting Safety Defects
In the US In Canada
404
http://www.tc.gc.ca/roadsaf ety
12/08/09 16:52:20 31SJC670_411
2013 Ridgeline
Warranty
andC
ustomer
Relations
To contact NHTSA, you may:call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at
1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153);go toor write to: Administrator, NHTSA
1200 New Jersey Avenue, SE.,Washington, DC 20590.
You can also obtain other information about motorvehicle safety from .
http://www.saf ercar.gov
http://www.saf ercar.gov
;
The publications shown below can be purchased from HelmIncorporated. You can order by phone or online:
Call Helm Inc. at 1-800-782-4356 (credit card orders only)
Go online at
If you are interested in other years or models, contact Helm Inc.at 1-800-782-4356.
Covers maintenance and recommended procedures forrepair to engine and chassis components. It is writtenfor the journeyman mechanic, but it is simple enoughfor most mechanically inclined owners to understand.
Complements the Service Manual by providing in-depthtroubleshooting information for each electrical circuitin your vehicle.
Describes the procedures involved in the replacementof damaged body parts.
Authorized Manuals
Purchasing Factory Authorized Manuals Service Manual:
Electrical Troubleshooting Manual:
Body Repair Manual:
(U.S. only)
405
Publication
Form Number
61SJC07
61SJC07EL
61SJC30
31SJC670
31SJC860
31SJCQ70
31SJCM70
HON-R
Form Description
2009-2013 Honda Ridgeline Service Manual
2009-2013 Honda Ridgeline
Electrical Troubleshooting Manual
2006 Model Series Ridgeline
Body Repair Manual
2013 Honda Ridgeline Owner’s Manual
2013 Honda Ridgeline Navigation Manual
2013 Honda Ridgeline Technology Reference Guide
2013 Ridgeline Honda Service History
Order Form for Previous Years-Indicate
Year and Model Desired
www.helminc.com
12/09/07 16:43:42 31SJC670_412
2013 Ridgeline
Warranty
andC
ustomer
Relations
CONTINUED
Back Window.......................................Indicator . 75...........................Operation . 128, 129
BatteryCharging System
...........................Indicator . 63, 372............................Jump Starting . 368
..............................Maintenance . 353............................Specifications . 387
Bed Lights.......................................Indicator . 74...................................Operation . 144
..............................Before Driving . 243....................................Belts, Seat . 8, 20
.........................Beverage Holders . 137........HandsFreeLink . 217
..................................Booster Seats . 52Brakes
...........Anti-lock System (ABS) . 287.............Break-in, New Linings . 244
...........................................Fluid . 331............Bulb Replacement . 337, 338
.......................................Parking . 132.................System Indicator . 65, 374........................Wear Indicators . 286
.............................Braking System . 286.................Break-in, New Vehicle . 244
..Brightness Control, Instruments . 98
...Accessories and Modifications . 255ACCESSORY (Ignition Key
.....................................Position) . 102............Accessory Power Sockets . 139
...........................AC Power Outlet . 141................Active Head Restraints . 124
....................Additives, Engine Oil . 325........Adjusting the Steering wheel . 99
...........................Advanced Airbags . 27...............................Airbag (SRS) . 9, 23
..............Air Conditioning System . 146.................................Usage . 147, 153
.......................Air Outlets (Vents) . 157
.......................Air Pressure, Tires . 347......................................Antifreeze . 327
Anti-lock Brakes (ABS)...............................Indicator . 66, 287
...................................Operation . 287..............Anti-theft, Audio System . 205
Anti-theft Steering Column............................................Lock . 102
........................................Armrests . 122................Audio System . 159, 167, 174
...Auto Door Locking/Unlocking . 104
Automatic Heated Wiper..............................Zone . 95, 150, 156
...Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners . 22.............Automatic Speed Control . 210..............Automatic Transmission . 269
..........................Capacity, Fluid . 386...............Checking Fluid Level . 329
.......................................Shifting . 269Shift Lever Position
...............................Indicators . 269................Shift Lever Positions . 270
....................Shift Lock Release . 273......................Auxiliary Input Jack . 205
Bluetooth
A
B
I
12/08/09 16:52:36 31SJC670_414
2013 Ridgeline
Index A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z
Bulb Replacement..........................Back-up Lights . 337
..............................Brake Lights . 337.................................Bed Lights . 340
.........Daytime Running Lights . 336.................................Fog Lights . 336
Front Turn Signal/Parking/.......................Hazard Lights . 335
.................................Headlights . 333.........High-mount Brake Light . 338
.................License Plate Lights . 339Rear Bulbs (Brake/Taillights,
Turn Signal/Hazard Lights,................Back-up Lights) . 337
............................Specifications . 387......................Bulbs, Halogen . 333, 336
...................Capacities Chart . 386, 387.............Carbon Monoxide Hazard . 55
.........................Cargo Hooks . 118, 137.............................Carrying Cargo . 257
.............CAUTION, Explanation of . iv.........................................CD Care . 198
..........................CD Changer . 181, 189
CD Player/Changer Error...................................Messages . 202
.......................................CD Player . 175........................Certification Label . 384
....................................Chains, tire . 351Change Oil
........................................How to . 325......................................When to . 311
....................Changing a Flat Tire . 359...Charging System Indicator . 63, 372
............Checklist, Before Driving . 267................Childproof Door Locks . 104
.....................................Child Safety . 34..............................Booster Seats . 52
...................................Child Seats . 41.....Important Safety Reminders . 34
..........................................Infants . 39..........................Larger Children . 51
.........................................LATCH . 43......................Risks with Airbags . 35
.............................Small Children . 40....................................Tether . 43, 48
.........Where Should a Child Sit? . 35.......................................Child Seats . 41
.........................................LATCH . 43..........Tether Anchorage Points . 48
...............Climate Control System . 152..............................................Clock . 207
....................................Coat Hooks . 138.....................Code, Audio System . 205
..................CO in the Exhaust . 55, 395......................Compact Spare Tire . 358
.................Console Compartment . 136
.................Consumer Information . 402.............Controls, Instruments and . 59
Coolant........................................Adding . 327
....................................Checking . 251.........................Proper Solution . 327
...................Temperature Gauge . 76..............................Courtesy Light . 143
Crankcase Emissions Control........................................System . 395
Cruise Control.......................................Indicator . 67...................................Operation . 210...................................Cup Holders . 137
.........................Customer Service . 402
...............DANGER, Explanation of . iv
C
D
II
12/08/09 16:52:41 31SJC670_415
2013 Ridgeline
Index A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z
*
*
CONTINUED
...................................Dashboard . 3, 60................Daytime Running Lights . 97
.................................Dead Battery . 368.........Defects, Reporting Safety . 404
......Defrosting the Windows . 148, 155................Differential Fluid, Rear . 386
....................................Dimensions . 386...............Dimming the Headlights . 95
Dipstick..........Automatic Transmission . 329
..................................Engine Oil . 251..........................Directional Signals . 95
........Disc Brake Wear Indicators . 286.....................Disposal of Used Oil . 326
.Door and Tailgate Open Monitor . 11Doors
Locking and..............Unlocking . 103, 104, 107
..................Lockout Prevention . 103....................Power Door Locks . 103
........DOT Tire Quality Grading . 388...........Driver and Passenger Safety . 5
...........................................Driving . 265....................................Economy . 252
...................................................D3 . 271
Dual-Action Tailgate...............................Indicator . 11, 115
...................................Operation . 113..................Dust and Pollen Filter . 342
..............................Economy, Fuel . 252..................................Emergencies . 357
.............Battery, Jump Starting . 368...........Brake System Indicator . 374
................Changing a Flat Tire . 359.....Charging System Indicator . 372
..................Checking the Fuses . 376.........Hazard Warning Flashers . 99.....Low Oil Pressure Indicator . 372...Malfunction Indicator Lamp . 373
..................Overheated Engine . 370............................Stuck Vehicle . 381
.......................................Towing . 381.........................Emergency Brake . 132.......................Emissions Controls . 395........................Emissions Testing . 398
Engine....Coolant Temperature Gauge . 76
Malfunction Indicator................................Lamp . 63, 373
.................Oil Life Display . 311, 315........Oil Pressure Indicator . 63, 372..............Oil, What Kind to Use . 324
...............................Overheating . 370............................Specifications . 387............................Speed Limiter . 273
.......................................Starting . 268.................Engine, if it won’t start . 367
Evaporative Emissions Control........................................System . 395
...............................Exhaust Fumes . 55Exhaust Gas Recirculation
........................................System . 396Expectant Mothers, Use of Seat
........................................Belts by . 18
..........................Fan, Interior . 147, 154.........................................Features . 145
....................Filling the Fuel Tank . 246
E
F
III
12/08/09 16:52:46 31SJC670_416
2013 Ridgeline
Index A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z
* : U.S. only
Filters.........................Dust and Pollen . 342
...............................................Oil . 326.............Flashers, Hazard Warning . 99
...................Flat Tire, Changing a . 359.....................................Floor Mats . 342
Fluids..........Automatic Transmission . 329
..........................................Brake . 331..........................Power Steering . 332
.......................Rear Differential . 386...................Transfer Assembly . 387..................Windshield Washer . 328
FM Stereo Radio...................................Reception . 165
.................Folding the Rear Seats . 125........................................Fog Lights . 97
..........................Four-way Flashers . 99..............................Front Seat . 119, 121............................Adjusting . 119, 121
.....................................Airbags . 9, 25
.......................................Heaters . 126.................................................Fuel . 244
......................Fill Door and Cap . 246...........................................Gauge . 76
................Octane Requirement . 244
...............................Oxygenated . 245........................Reserve Indicator . 68
........................Tank, Filling the . 246...............................Fuel Economy . 252
Actual Mileage and EPA FuelEconomy Estimates
.......................Comparison . 252......Calculating Fuel Economy . 254
.............Fuel Economy Factors . 253........Improving Fuel Economy . 253
.....................Fuses, Checking the . 376
...............Gas Mileage, Improving . 252Gasoline
...............Fuel Reserve Indicator . 68...........................................Gauge . 76
................Octane Requirement . 244........................Tank, Filling the . 246
................Gas Station Procedures . 246Gauges
...Engine Coolant Temperature . 76...............................................Fuel . 76
...............................Speedometer . 76.................................Tachometer . 76
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight.......................................Rating) . 292
GCWR (Gross Combined.................Weight Rating) . 292, 386
............Gearshift Lever Positions . 270......................................Glove Box . 138
GVWR (Gross Vehicle.................Weight Rating) . 292, 386
....Halogen Headlight Bulbs . 333, 336...........................HandsFreeLink . 217
..............................HFL Buttons . 217..............Hazard Warning Flashers . 99
G
H
IV
12/08/09 16:52:50 31SJC670_417
2013 Ridgeline
Index A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z
CONTINUED
.................................Headlights . 94, 95........................................Aiming . 333
..............Automatic Lighting Off . 96.................................Control Dial . 95
............Daytime Running Lights . 97..................High Beam Indicator . 67
.....High Beams, Turning on . 94, 95............Low Beams, Turning on . 95
.........................Reminder Chime . 96Replacing Halogen
..............................Bulbs . 333, 336..................................Turning On . 95
............................Head Restraints . 122.............................Heated Mirrors . 134
...............................Heaters, Seats . 126.............Heating and Cooling . 146, 152
.................High-Low Beam Switch . 94HomeLink Universal
................................Transceiver . 213.......................Hood, Opening the . 250
..............................................Horn . 4, 93
...Identification Number, Vehicle . 384
Ignition............................................Keys . 100
.........................................Switch . 102............Timing Control System . 396
......................Immobilizer System . 101.........Important Safety Precautions . 6
...............................In-Bed Trunk . 116..................Emergency Opener . 117
............................Open Indicator . 75.........Indicators, Instrument Panel . 61
...............ABS (Anti-lock Brake) . 66.......................A/T Temperature . 69
....................Back Window Open . 75.............................Bed Lights On . 74
Brake (Parking and Brake....................................System) . 65
........................Charging System . 63.............................Cruise Control . 67
.................................Cruise Main . 67...................................Door Open . 75
DRL (Daytime Running......................................Lights) . 67
...................................High Beam . 67....................In-Bed Trunk Open . 75
........Key (Immobilizer System) . 66Lights On...................................... 69
......................................Low Fuel . 68........................Low Oil Pressure . 63......................Low Tire Pressure . 72
...............Maintenance Minder . 71Malfunction Indicator Lamp
.......................................(MIL) . 63...........................Side Airbag Off . 64
.......................................Seat Belt . 62..........................Security System . 68
...............................................SRS . 64..............................Tailgate Open . 75.......................TPMS System . 72, 73
Turn Signal and Hazard...................................Warning . 66
......................................VSA OFF . 71.................................VSA System . 70
..........................................VTM-4 . 70..............................Washer Level . 67
..................Individual Map Lights . 143...............................Infant Restraint . 39
......................................Infant Seats . 39...................Inflation, Proper Tire . 346 IN
DE
X
I
V
TM
12/08/09 16:52:55 31SJC670_418
2013 Ridgeline
Index A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z
................................................Keys . 100
........................Information Display . 77.........Engine Oil Life Indicator . 311
...........Maintenance Items . 314, 322.................................Inside Mirror . 133
.............................Inspection, Tire . 347............................Instrument Panel . 61
........Instrument Panel Brightness . 98...............................Interior Lights . 142
........................................Introduction . i
................Jacking Up the Vehicle . 361.......................................Jack, Tire . 361
................................Jump Starting . 368
.......................Label, Certification . 384.................Lane Change, Signaling . 95
..................Lap/Shoulder Belts . 16, 21...........................Light Control Dial . 95
Lights....................Bulb Replacement . 333
.......................................Indicator . 69.......................................Interior . 142.........................................Parking . 95
..................................Turn Signal . 95............................Load Limits . 258, 291
....LOCK (Ignition Key Position) . 102Locks
.....Anti-theft Steering Column . 102............................Fuel Fill Door . 246
..................................Glove Box . 138...........................In-Bed Trunk . 116
..................Lockout Prevention . 103...............................Power Door . 103
........................Low Coolant Level . 251.........................Low Fuel Indicator . 68
...Low Oil Pressure Indicator . 63, 372Lubricant Specifications
..................................Chart . 386, 387...........Luggage, Storing (Cargo) . 257
..................................Maintenance . 309................................Minder . 311-322
.........................Minder Indicator . 71Owner’s Maintenance
...................................Checks . 321..........................................Safety . 310
.Malfunction Indicator Lamp . 63, 373............Manual Seat Adjustments . 119
...............................Meters, Gauges . 76........................Mirrors, Adjusting . 134
...............Modifying Your Vehicle . 256.......................................Moonroof . 131
.............Multi-Information Display . 82............Engine Oil Life Display . 315
...........Maintenance Items . 319, 322
...................Neutral Gear Position . 271..................New Vehicle Break-in . 244
...................NOTICE, Explanation of . i...............Numbers, Identification . 384
J
K
L
M
N
VI
12/08/09 16:53:01 31SJC670_419
2013 Ridgeline
Index A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z
*
CONTINUED
...Octane Requirement, Gasoline . 244...................................Odometer . 79, 84
....................Off-Highway Driving . 304...................Off-Road Precautions . 305
Oil........................Change, How to . 325......................Change, When to . 311......................Checking Engine . 251
...........................................Filter . 326..............Pressure Indicator . 63, 372
Selecting Proper Viscosity......................................Chart . 324
.........ON (Ignition Key Position) . 102............................Outside Mirrors . 134
....................Overheating, Engine . 370....Owner’s Maintenance Checks . 321
.........................Oxygenated Fuels . 245
..............Panel Brightness Control . 98........................Park Gear Position . 270
...........................................Parking . 284...............................Parking Brake . 132
.................................Parking Lights . 95..Parking Over Things that Burn . 285
.............................PGM-FI System . 396Pickup Bed
.........................Carrying Cargo . 257.........................................Lights . 144
..............Power Seat Adjustments . 121...............Power Socket Locations . 139
.........Pregnancy, Using Seat Belts . 18
.........Protecting Adults and Teens . 11...Additional Safety Precautions . 19
.....Advice for Pregnant Women . 18........................Protecting Children . 34
.....................General Guidelines . 34.......................Protecting Infants . 39
.......Protecting Larger Children . 51.........Protecting Small Children . 40
Using Child Seats with.....................................Tethers . 48
.............................Using LATCH . 43
...................Radiator Overheating . 370Radio/CD Sound
.......................System . 159, 167, 174
.................Rear Differential Fluid . 386..Rear Lights, Bulb Replacement . 337
...........Rearview Camera Display . 240...........................Rearview Mirror . 133
....................Rear (Back) Window . 129.....Reclining the Seat-Backs . 120, 121
................Remote Audio Controls . 203.....................Remote Transmitter . 110
Replacement Information................Engine Oil and Filter . 325
..........................................Fuses . 376................................Light Bulbs . 333
........................................Minder . 311................................Timing Belt . 333
...........................................Tires . 349.............................Wiper Blades . 343
Replacing Seat Belts After a............................................Crash . 22
..........Reporting Safety Defects . 404...Reserve Tank, Engine Coolant . 251
..................Reverse Gear Position . 270................................Rotation, Tire . 348
P QR
O
VII
12/09/07 16:44:44 31SJC670_420
2013 Ridgeline
Index A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z
* : U.S. only
*
*
..................................Safety Belts . 8, 20.........Safety Defects, Reporting . 404
.................................Safety Features . 7...........................................Airbags . 9
..................................Door Locks . 11..........................Head Restraints . 15
.................................Seat Belts . 8, 20...........Seats and Seat-Backs . 13, 14
.............Safety Labels, Location of . 56..............................Safety Messages . iv
.....................................Seat Belts . 8, 20...............Additional Information . 20
Automatic Seat Belt...............................Tensioners . 22
.....................................Cleaning . 341......................Lap/Shoulder Belt . 21
................................Maintenance . 22Reminder Light and
................................Beeper . 20, 62...................System Components . 20
...............Use During Pregnancy . 18...Wearing a Lap/Shoulder Belt . 16
.........................Seating Capacities . 386
...............................................Seats . 119............Adjusting the Seat . 119, 121
.............Folding the Rear Seats . 125........................Head Restraints . 122
........................................Heater . 126............................Security System . 208
...............................Serial Number . 384...........................Service Intervals . 311
......Service Manual, Purchasing . 405.........Service Station Procedures . 246
Shifting the Automatic.............................Transmission . 269
...Shift Lever Position Indicators . 269........................Shift Lock Release . 273
................................Side Airbags . 9, 28................Side Curtain Airbags . 10, 30
Side Marker (Parking)...Lights, Bulb Replacement in . 335
...............................Signaling Turns . 95.....................................Snow Tires . 350
................Sound System . 159, 167, 174Spare Tire
..............................Inflating . 347, 358............................Specifications . 387
....................Specifications Charts . 386................................Speed Control . 210
...................................Speedometer . 76..........SRS, Additional Information . 23
...Additional Safety Precautions . 33......Airbag System Components . 23
.............................Airbag Service . 32How the Passenger Airbag Off
......................Indicator Works . 31How the Side Airbag Off
......................Indicator Works . 31..How the SRS Indicator Works . 30
How Your Front Airbags.........................................Work . 25
...How Your Side Airbags Work . 28How Your Side Curtain Airbags
.........................................Work . 30.............................SRS Indicator . 30, 64
..START (Ignition Key Position) . 102.......................Starting the Engine . 268
................With a Dead Battery . 368........Steam Coming from Engine . 370
Steering Wheel..................................Adjustment . 99
...........Anti-theft Column Lock . 102...Stereo Sound System . 159, 167, 174....................Storing Your Vehicle . 354
................................Stuck Vehicle . 381
S
VIII
12/08/09 16:53:10 31SJC670_421
2013 Ridgeline
Index A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z
* : U.S. only
*
*
*
CONTINUED
........................................Sun Visor . 140........................Sunglasses Holder . 138
Supplemental Restraint System(SRS)
......................................Servicing . 32.........................SRS Indicator . 30, 64
...................System Components . 23..................................Synthetic Oil . 325
.....................................Tachometer . 76Tailgate, Dual-Action
...............................Indicator . 11, 115...................................Operation . 113
......Taillights, Changing Bulbs in . 337.Taking Care of the Unexpected . 357
Technical Descriptions....DOT Tire Quality Grading . 388.....Emissions Control Systems . 395
Three Way Catalytic...............................Converter . 397
.......................Temperature Gauge . 76...................Tensioners, Seat Belts . 22
............................Theft Protection . 205..Three Way Catalytic Converter . 397
....................................Timing Belt . 333
....................................Tire Chains . 351.........Tire, How to Change a Flat . 359
.................................Tire Labeling . 390Tire Pressure Monitoring
....................System (TPMS) . 276Low Tire Pressure
..................Indicator . 72, 276, 279Required Federal
............................Explanation . 392.....Tire Pressure Monitor . 277, 280
....TPMS Indicator . 72, 73, 277, 279...............................................Tires . 345
..............................Air Pressure . 347.........................Checking Wear . 347..........................Compact Spare . 358
....DOT Tire Quality Grading . 388......................................Inflation . 346
..................................Inspection . 347..............................Maintenance . 348
...................................Replacing . 349......................................Rotating . 348
...........................................Snow . 350....................Specifications . 350, 387
................................Tire Chains . 351...................Tools, Tire Changing . 359
Towing.....................................A Trailer . 294
................Emergency Wrecker . 381.................................Equipment . 299
....Equipment and Accessories . 295.............................Weight Limit . 291
.........................Trailer Loading . 293.................Trailer Towing Tips . 301
.............Transfer Assembly Fluid . 387Transmission
...............Checking Fluid Level . 329...........................Fluid Selection . 330
..............Identification Number . 385.............Shifting the Automatic . 269
.....................................Treadwear . 388
.................................Trip Meter . 79, 84................................Trunk, In-Bed . 116
....................................Turn Signals . 95
Unexpected, Taking Care..........................................of the . 357
..Uniform Tire Quality Grading . 388
U
T
IX
12/08/09 16:53:15 31SJC670_422
2013 Ridgeline
Index A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z
* : U.S. only
*
*
.....................................XM Radio . 167
........................Unleaded Gasoline . 244.......Used Oil, How to Dispose of . 326
............WARNING, Explanation of . iv.........Warning Labels, Location of . 56
..................Warranty Coverages . 403Washer, Windshield
........Checking the Fluid Level . 328............................Level Indicator . 67
.....................................Operation . 94...........................................Wheels . 345
...............Adjusting the Steering . 99......................................Wrench . 362
Windows................Operating the Power . 128
Windshield...........................Defroster . 148, 155
.......................................Washers . 94...Wiper Zone, Heated . 95, 150, 156
Wipers, Windshield.......................Changing Blades . 343
.....................................Operation . 94....................................Worn Tires . 347
.....Wrecker, Emergency Towing . 381
................................Vanity Mirror . 140.........Vehicle Capacity Load . 258, 386
......................Vehicle Dimensions . 386....Vehicle Identification Number . 384
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA ),aka Electronic Stability
....Control (ESC), System . 288.............VSA OFF Indicator . 71, 289
.......................VSA OFF Switch . 290........VSA System Indicator . 70, 289
.............................Vehicle Storage . 354.....................................Ventilation . 149
.................................................VIN . 384..................................Viscosity, Oil . 324
Variable Torque Management4-wheel drive system
...............................(VTM-4 ) . 274................................VTM-4 Lock . 274
: U.S. only
X Y Z
V
W
X
12/08/09 16:53:20 31SJC670_423
2013 Ridgeline
Index A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z
Service Information Summary
Gasoline: Tire Pressure (measured cold):
Fuel Tank Capacity:
Recommended Engine Oil:
Automatic Transmission Fluid:
Power Steering Fluid:
Brake Fluid:
Rear Differential Fluid:
Transfer Assembly Fluid:
32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm )Front/Rear:
Compact Spare Tire:60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )
22.01 US gal (83.3 )
Oil change capacity (includingfilter):
4.5 US qt (4.3 )
Honda Power Steering Fluidpreferred, or another brand ofpower steering fluid as atemporary replacement. Do notuse ATF (see page ).
Honda Heavy Duty Brake FluidDOT 3 preferred, or a DOT 3 orDOT 4 brake fluid as a temporaryreplacement (see page ).
Unleaded gasoline, pump octanenumber of 87 or higher.
Honda ATF DW-1 (automatictransmission fluid) (see page ).
Honda VTM-4 Differential Fluid.
SAE 90 or SAE 80W-90 viscosityhypoid gear oil, API serviceclassified GL4 or GL5 only.
API Premium grade 0W-20detergent oil (see page ).324
330
332
331
12/08/09 16:53:36 31SJC670_425
2013 Ridgeline
This owner’s manual should be considereda permanent part of the vehicle and shouldremain with the vehicle when it is sold.
This owner’s manual covers all models ofthe Ridgeline. You may find descriptions ofequipment and features that are not on yourparticular model.
Images throughout this owner’s manual(including the front cover) representfeatures and equipment that are available onsome, but not all, models. Your particularmodel may not have some of these features.
The information and specifications includedin this publication were in effect at the timeof approval for printing. Honda Motor Co.,Ltd. reserves the right, however, todiscontinue or change specifications ordesign at any time without notice andwithout incurring any obligation whatsoever.
Owner’s Identif ication
POUR CLIENTS CANADIENAVIS IMPORTANT: Si vous avezbesoin d’un Manuel du Conducteuren français, veuillez demander àvotre concessionnaire decommander le numéro de pièce33SJCC70
OWNER
ADDRESS
V. I. N.
DELIVERY DATE
DEALER NAME DEALER NO.
ADDRESS
OWNER’S SIGNATURE
DEALER’S SIGNATURE
STREET
CITY STATE/PROVINCE/TERRITORY ZIP CODE/POSTAL CODE
(Date sold to original retail purchaser)
STREET
CITY STATE/PROVINCE/TERRITORY ZIP CODE/POSTAL CODE
12/08/09 15:58:23 31SJC670_001
2013 Ridgeline